Building Automation
Building Automation
Dwyer Instruments, Inc. produces a broad range of competitively priced precision instruments for measuring, transmitting and controlling pressure, temperature, level and flow. Many of these instruments are widely known by their individual brand names, such as Magnehelic and Spirahelic pressure gages, Photohelic switch/gages, Rate-Master, MiniMaster and Visi-Float flowmeters, Slack Tube and Flex-Tube manometers, and Dwyer pressure switches. Other established Dwyer brands, including Flotect flow and level switches, Hi-Flow valves, Self-Tune temperature controllers and Iso Verter signal converters/isolators, are the products of companies that are now divisions of Dwyer Instruments Mercoid, W. E. Anderson, Proximity Controls and Love Controls. Founded in 1931, Dwyer Instruments, Inc. moved its manufacturing and headquarters from Chicago, Illinois, in 1955, to newly constructed, greatly-expanded facilities in Michigan City, Indiana. The company has since added three more Indiana facilitiesin Wakarusa, Kingsbury and Wolcottas well as manufacturing facilities in Anaheim, California; Fergus Falls, Minnesota; Kansas City, Missouri; and Naguabo, Puerto Rico. In addition to making and selling quality precision instruments, Dwyer Instruments, Inc. is committed to a standard of customer serviceincluding competitive prices and knowledgeable, courteous technical supportthat generates and sustains long-term relationships.
Corporate Headquarters, Dwyer Instruments, Inc. 102 Indiana Highway 212, Michigan City, IN 46361 U.S.A.
Copyright 2008 Dwyer Instruments, Inc. Printed in U.S.A.
10/08
Locations Worldwide
Dwyer Instruments, Incorporated, has presence in over 50 countries. Please contact us for your nearest representative.
Corporate Headquarters Dwyer Instruments, Inc. 102 Indiana Highway 212 P.O. Box 373 Michigan City, IN. 46361 U.S.A. Telephone: 219/879-8000 Fax: 219/872-9057 Houston Office Telephone: 281/446-1146 Fax: 281/446-0696
United Kingdom Dwyer Instruments Limited Unit 16, The Wye Estate, London Road High Wycombe, Bucks HP11 1LH-U.K. Telephone: (+44) (0)1494 461707 Fax: (+44) (0)1494 465102
Australia Dwyer Instruments, Pty. Ltd. Unit 1, 11 Waverley Drive Unanderra, NSW 2526 Australia Telephone: 61 2 4272 2055 Fax: 61 2 4272 4055
How to Order:
To place orders & for Customer Service and Technical Support
PHONE
800/872-9141 219/879-8000
FAX
219/872-9057
View your orders using our new online feature, CHECK ORDER STATUS. Order quantity, model number, schedule/shipment and tracking information is available. View listings of open and closed orders for the past 30 working days.
ONLINE www.dwyer-inst.com
Customer Service
Easy, friendly and fast
Dwyer wants to help you get your job done quickly and easily. Courteous and professional customer service representatives are available via phone or email to process and provide assistance with your order. Dwyer prides itself on being industry leaders in response time.
Technical Support
We provide you with the solutions you need
Dwyer is here to help you with technical and application support. All of our technical staff are degreed engineers trained to be product and industry experts. We will help you get the right product for your application and support the product once you already have it.
Product Delivery
Prompt shipments
Dwyer is committed to get you your order quickly. We maintain inventory for most products at our Michigan City, IN USA location. Our dedicated shipping staff packs and ships your order promptly within 24 hours on most in-stock items.
2
CALL TO ORDER: U.S. Phone 219 879-8000 U.K. Phone (+44) (0)1494-461707 Asia Pacific Phone 61 2 4272-2055
Website
Its all here for you, anytime you need it
We deliver the convenience you want order information, product information and order placement all on the web. Available at anytime.
Order Information
Model numbers and pricing are easy to find Normal inventory availability displayed
Product Information
Catalog pages in PDF format view, print or save to your computer Instruction manuals in PDF format view, print or save to your computer Product dimensions viewable through your web browser Product specifications viewable through your web browser Agency approval certificates CE, FM, UL, CSA and ATEX Application guides Frequently asked questions
Order Online
CALL TO ORDER:
Table of Contents
ROOM CONTROL APPLICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 AIR HANDLER APPLICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7 HEATING AND COOLING APPLICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9
PRESSURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-39
Series MS, Magnesense Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11 Series 605, Magnehelic Differential Pressure Gage with Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12 Series DM-2000, Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13 Series 616OT, One-Touch Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14 Series 616K, Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14 Series 616 & 616C, Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15 Series 616D, DIN Rail Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15 Series 607, Low Range Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16 Series 668, Compact Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16 Series 610, Precision Low Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 Series 626 & 628, Industrial Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-19 Series WWDP, Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 Series 629, Wet/Wet Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21 Series 631B, Wet/Wet Differential Pressure Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 Series 2000, Magnehelic Differential Pressure Gages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 Series 2-5000, Minihelic II Differential Pressure Gages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 Series TRI, Tridicator Gage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25 Series SGD & SGT, 2.5 Stainless Steel Industrial Pressure Gage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26 Series SGX & SGF, 2.5 Stainless Steel Low Pressure Gages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27 Series SGK, 8 & 10 Stainless Steel Pressure Gage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28 Series UGB, 4 Plastic Utility Gage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29 Series 35W, Sprinkler Gage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29 Series DH3, Digihelic Differential Pressure Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 Series DHII, Digihelic II Differential Pressure Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31 Series DH, Digihelic Differential Pressure Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32-33 Series A3000, Photohelic Pressure Switch/Gages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 Series 3000MR/3000MRS, Photohelic Switch/Gages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 Series ADPS, H.V.A.C. Differential Pressure Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36 Series 1900, Compact Low Differential Pressure Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37 Series H3, Explosion-Proof Differential Pressure Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38 Series CXA, Water Pump Pressure Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
FLOW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40-47
Series UXF2, Ultrasonic Flow Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 Series SX3, Ultrasonic Flowmeter Detector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 Series UXF1, Ultrasonic Flowmeter Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 Series SX1, Ultrasonic Flowmeter Detector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43 Series FS-2, Vane Flow Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 Series V10 & V11, Flotect Mini-Size Flow Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45 Series V8, Flotect Vane Operated Flow Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 Series FMS, Flow Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
TEMPERATURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58-68
Series TTE, Explosion-Proof RTD Temperature Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 Series 651, Temperature Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59 Series 659, Push-Button Temperature Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59 Series BTO, Bimetal Thermometer with Transmitter Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60 Series BT, Bimetal Thermometers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61 Series DBT, Digital Solar-Powered Bimetal Thermometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61 Series IT, Industrial Thermometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62 Series IT-W, Industrial Thermometer Thermowells . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62 Series I-1, Immersion Temperature Probes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63 Series I-2, Immersion Sensor Assemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63 Series I-4, Weatherproof Immersion Assemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64 Series S, Surface Mount Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64 Series S-2, Surface Temperature Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65 Series S-4, Weatherproof Surface Temperature Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65 Series AVG, Averaging Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66 Series RTD, Resistance Temperature Detector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66 Series AD, Air/Duct Temperature Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67 Series TSX, Digital Temperature Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67 16L, Limit Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68 TSF, Thermocouple Limit Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
VALVES/ACTUATORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109-119
Series GV1, Globe Control Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109 Series GV2 & GV3, Globe Control Valves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110 Series EVA, Electric Actuator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111 Series BV2MB, Two-Piece Hand Lever Brass Ball Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112 Series BV2L, Low Cost Electric Actuated Ball Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112 Series ABFV, Automatic Butterfly Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113-115 Series BFV, Butterfly Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 Series ZV1, Two-Way Zone Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117 Series 3ZV1, Three-Way Zone Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117 Series DDA & DDC, Non-Spring Return Direct Coupled Actuators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118 Series DDB & DDD, Non-Spring Return Direct Coupled Actuators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
ACCESSORIES/BOOKS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120-128
Model A-464, Flush Mount Kit for Magnehelic Gages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 Model A-465, Flush Mount Space Pressure Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121-124 Series A-2000, Stainless Steel Fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125-126 Techinical Reference Books . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127-128
CALL TO ORDER:
Building Automation
Room Control Example
Buildings are often broken down into zones for better control of the HVAC system. These zones can have Variable Air Volume (VAV) systems with a VAV terminal unit or VAV box. A VAV box controls the air flow into the zone thereby controlling the environment of the zone.
DDA Non Spring Non-Spring Return Coupled A upl p Direct Coupled Actuator Coupled Actuator MS Pressure ssure Transmitter RHT Humidity/Temperature Transmitter Transmitter ransmitte a itt CDW Carbon Dioxide/Temperature C Transmitter Transmitter ransmitte a mitt
TO ZONE
AIR VOLUME CONTROL The amount of air added to the zone is controlled by opening and closing the air duct via a damper with a damper actuator. Product used: DD Damper Actuator.
DUCT AIR FLOW The amount of air flow to the zone is changed according to the demand. An air velocity transmitter is used to monitor the duct air flow. Product used: MS Pressure Transmitter that has square root extraction for air velocity.
ROOM TEMPERATURE AND CARBON DIOXIDE The amount of air flow to a zone is varied based on occupancy in a zone. The occupancy is determined by the concentration of carbon dioxide in the zone. Product used: CDW Carbon Dioide and Temperature Transmitter
ROOM TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY A wall mounted temperature and humidity transmitter is placed in the zone to monitor the zone conditions and determine demand. Product used: RHT-W Humidity and Temperature Transmitter.
WATER FLOW CONTROL VAV systems can include heating coils of hot water that the air flows past. A zone valve is used to change the amount of hot water added to the heating coil. Zone systems can include radiant heating systems. A zone valve is used to change the amount of hot water added to the radiator in the zone. Products used: ZV1 Zone Valves.
CALL TO ORDER:
Building Automation
Air Handler Example
Building automation systems provide the method to give a building a comfortable environment. An air handler is an integral part of the building automation system and provides control of temperature, humidity, pressure, and air exchange. Shown below is an example of a type of air handler using a water based temperature system. On the opposite page is a description of the products that Dwyer provides to use in the system.
AD Air/Duct Temperature perature Sensor sor AVG Temperature Sensor D DD mper Damper uator Actuator
Fan
VFD
N N.O.
NC N.C. Fil Filter Filter C Coil VF FD VFD Fan THIRD FLO FLOOR PLENUM SECOND FLOOR
S LY SUPPLY AIR
MS Pressure Transmitter
CS Current Switch
MS Pressure Transmitter
CALL TO ORDER:
Building Automation
Air Handler Example
DIRTY FILTER ALARM A differential pressure monitor of the pressure loss across the filter. Products used: 1900 or ADPS Pressure Switch
FAN VALIDATION Proving a fan is operating can be done in several ways: 1. Monitor the differential pressure between upstream and downstream of the fan. Products used: 1900 or ADPS Pressure Switch. 2. Monitor the air flow or velocity exiting the fan. Products used: DH, DHII, DH3, MS or 641 transmitter. 3. Monitor the current usage of the fan. Products used: CS Current Switch.
DUCT STATIC PRESSURE A pressure transmitter is used with a static pressure tip to monitor discharge air and mixing air duct static pressure. Products used: MS Pressure Transmitter with A-302 Static Pressure Tip.
DUCT HUMIDITY SENSOR A humidity transmitter is inserted into the duct to monitor the zone discharge humidity. Products used: RHU-D Humidity Transmitter.
DUCT HUMIDITY/TEMPERATURE SENSOR A dual humidity and temperature transmitter is inserted into the duct to monitor the exhaust air humidity and temperature. Products used: RHT-D Humidity/Temperature Transmitter.
DUCT TEMPERATURE SENSOR A temperature sensor is inserted into the duct to monitor the supply air, mix air, and exhaust air temperature. Products used: AD Air/Duct Temperature Sensor, AVG Averaging Temperature Sensor.
FROZEN COIL ALARM A differential pressure monitor of the pressure loss across the coils in the duct can indicate frozen coils. Products used: 1900 or ADPS Pressure Switch.
CALL TO ORDER:
Building Automation
Heating and Cooling System Example
There are several ways to heat and cool the air in an air handler. In the example shown below this is accomplished through a hot/chilled water system. The system provides water to an air handler to heat or cool the air temperature as needed. On the opposite page is a description of the products that Dwyer provides to use in the system.
SYSTEM SUPPLY
Condenser Water Return Mixing Valve GV & EVA Condenser Water Supply CHILLER
Current Switch CS Mixing Valve GV & EVA 629 Differential Pressure Transmitter I-2 Temperature Sensor
CALL TO ORDER:
Building Automation
Heating and Cooling System Example
WATER MIXING VALVE Three-way valves are used to mix return and supply water and chilled and hot together. Products used: GV Globe Valve with EVA Electric Actuator, or 3ABV Ball Valve with Electric Actuator.
WATER TEMPERATURE MONITOR A temperature sensor is inserted into the water pipeline to monitor the system supply, system return, condenser return, condenser supply, and boiler supply water temperature. Products used: I-2 or I-4 RTD Temperature Sensor with thermowell.
OUTSIDE AIR SENSOR A dual humidity and temperature transmitter is outside the building to monitor the outdoor air humidity and temperature. Products used: RHT-O Humidity/Temperature Transmitter.
PUMP VALIDATION/FLOW PROVING Proving a pump is operating can be done in several ways: 1.Monitor the differential pressure between upstream and downstream of the pump. Products used: H3 Pressure Switch. 2. Monitor the water flow exiting the pump. Products used: FS-2, V8, or V10 Flow Switch. 3. Monitor the current usage of the pump. Products used: CS Current Switch. 4. Ensure proper differential pressure is created from sufficient flow through chiller Products used: 629 Differential Pressure Transmitter
CALL TO ORDER:
PRESSURE
Series MS
1/2 (12.70)
2-9/16 (65.09)
35/84 (13.87)
8-1/8 (206.38)
The Series MS Magnesense Differential Pressure Transmitter is an extremely versatile transmitter for monitoring pressure and air velocity. This compact package is loaded with features such as: Field Selectable English or Metric Ranges Field Upgradeable LCD Display Adjustable Dampening of Output Signal (with Optional Display) Ability to Select a Square Root Output for Use with Pitot Tubes and Other Similar Flow Sensors Along with these features, the patented magnetic sensing technology provides exceptional long term performance and enables the Magnesense Differential Pressure Transmitter to be the single solution for your pressure and flow applications.
Model Number MS-121* MS-321* MS-111* MS-311* MS-131 MS-141 MS-151 MS-331 MS-341 MS-351 MS-021 MS-221
Output 4-20 mA 0-10 V 4-20 mA 0-10 V 4-20 mA 4-20 mA 4-20 mA 0-10 V 0-10 V 0-10 V 4-20 mA 0-10 V
Selectable Ranges 0.1, 0.25, 0.5 (25, 50, 100 Pa) 0.1, 0.25, 0.5 (25, 50, 100 Pa) 1, 2, 5 (250, 500, 1250 Pa) 1, 2, 5 (250, 500, 1250 Pa) 10 w.c. (2 KPa) 15 w.c. (3 KPa) 25 w.c. (5 KPa) 10 w.c. (2 KPa) 15 w.c. (3 KPa) 25 w.c. (5 KPa) 0.1, 0.25,0.5 w.c. (25, 50, 100 Pa) 0.1, 0.25,0.5 w.c. (25, 50, 100 Pa)
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Accuracy: 1% for 0.25 (50 Pa), 0.5 (100 Pa), 2 (500 Pa), 5 (1250 Pa), 10 (2 kPa), 15 (3 kPa), 25 (5 kPa) 2% for 0.1 (25 Pa), 1 (250 Pa) and all bi-directional ranges. Stability: 1% / year F.S.O. Temperature Limits: 0 to 150F (-18 to 66C). Pressure Limits: 1 psi maximum, operation; 10 psi, burst. Power Requirements: 10 to 35 VDC (2-wire); 17 to 36 VDC or isolated 21.6 to 33 VAC (3-wire). Output Signals: 4 to 20 mA (2-wire); 0 to 5 V, 0 to 10 V (3-wire). Response Time: Adjustable 0.5 to 15 sec. time constant. Provides a 95% response time of 1.5 to 45 seconds. Zero & Span Adjustments: Digital push button. Loop Resistance: Current Output: 0-1250 max; Voltage Output: min. load resistance 1 k. Current Consumption: 40 mA max. Display (optional): 4 digit LCD. Electrical Connections: 4-20 mA, 2-Wire: European Style Terminal Block for 16 to 26 AWG. 0-10 V, 3-Wire: European Style Terminal Block for 16 to 22 AWG. Electrical Entry: 1/2 NPS Thread Accessory (A-151): Cable Gland for 5 to 10 mm diameter cable. Process Connections: 3/16 ID tubing (5 mm ID). Maximum OD 9 mm. Enclosure Rating: NEMA 4X (IP65). Mounting Orientation: Diaphragm in vertical position. Weight: 8.0 oz (230 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
NOTE: Add -LCD to end of model for units with display. *Models available with duct mount static pressure probe. Change last digit from 1 to 2. Ex. MS-122
10
CALL TO ORDER:
PRESSURE
Digital Push Button Zero and Span. Reduces calibration time significantly over other transmitters that utilize potentiometers. Lowers maintenance time and costs.
Field Selectable Air Velocity Mode for fan and blower applications. Unit provides square root output that accurately tracks fpm or m/s flow rate. No need for a smart programmable indicator or PLC to convert pressure to air flow. Reduces components and installation time lowering overall costs.
Adjustable Digital Dampening smooths out unstable pressure fluctuations common in air flow applications.
APPLICATIONS Duct pressures Building pressures Room-to-room differential pressures Air velocity pressures from fans and air handlers
Fan Velocity
Duct Pressure
Building Pressure
CALL TO ORDER:
11
PRESSURE
Series 605
2 [50.80]
3/16 [4.76]
The Series 605 Magnehelic Indicating Transmitter provides for both visual monitoring and electronic control of very low differential pressure. The Series 605 is ideal for control applications in building HVAC systems where local indication is desired during routine maintenance checks or necessary when trouble shooting the system. The easily read dial gage is complimented by the two-wire, 4-20 mA control signal utilizing the time-proven Dwyer Magnehelic gage mechanical design and Series 600 transmitter technology. The 2-wire design with terminal strip on the rear simplifies connection in any 4-20 mA control loop powered by a 10-35 VDC supply. APPLICATIONS Monitor pressures in ducts, rooms, or total building pressures Filter monitoring Local indication of clean room pressures with process signal sent to control room
SPECIFICATIONS GAGE SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Accuracy: See chart. Stability: 1% F.S./yr. Pressure Limits: See chart. Temperature Limits: 20 to 120F (-6.67 to 48.9C). Process Connections: 1/8 female NPT. Size: 4 (101.6 mm) dial face, 5 (127 mm) O.D. x 2-11/16 (68.3 mm). Weight: 1 lb, 12.6 oz (811 g). Agency Approvals: CE. TRANSMITTER SPECIFICATIONS Accuracy: See chart (includes linearity, hysteresis, repeatability). Temperature Limits: 20 to 120F (-6.67 to 48.9C). Compensated Temperature Range: 32 to 120F (0 to 48.9C). Thermal Effect: 0.025% F.S./F (0.045% F.S./C). Power Requirements: 10-35 VDC (2-wire). Output Signal: 4 to 20 mA. Zero and Span Adjustments: Protected potentiometers. Loop Resistance: DC; 0-1250 ohms maximum. Current Consumption: DC; 38 mA maximum. Electrical Connections: Screw terminal block. Mounting Orientation: Diaphragm in vertical position. Consult factory for other position orientations.
ACCESSORIES A-298 Flat Aluminum Bracket, for flush mounting A-370 Mounting Bracket, flush mount Series 605 Transmitter in bracket. Bracket is then surface mounted.Steel with gray hammertone epoxy finish
Model Number 605-00N 605-11 605-0 605-1 605-2 605-3 605-6 605-10
Range in w.c. .05-0-.20 .25-0-.25 0-.50 0-1.0 0-2.0 0-3.0 0-6.0 0-10
Maximum Pressure 25 psi (1.7 bar) 25 psi (1.7 bar) 25 psi (1.7 bar) 25 psi (1.7 bar) 2 psi (13.79 kPa) 2 psi (13.79 kPa) 2 psi (13.79 kPa) 2 psi (13.79 kPa)
Range in w.c. 0-20.0 0-30 0-50 Range in Pa 0-60 0-125 0-250 0-500
Maximum Pressure 20 psi (1.4 bar) 20 psi (1.4 bar) 20 psi (1.4 bar) 25 psi (1.7 bar) 25 psi (1.7 bar) 25 psi (1.7 bar) 5 psi (34.5 kPa)
12
CALL TO ORDER:
Series DM-2000
Differential Pressure Transmitter Same Size as Standard Magnehelic Differential Pressure Gage
HIGH PRESSURE PORT 1-1/4 [31.75] LOW PRESSURE PORT 7/16 [11.11] 17/32 [13.50] 1-11/16 [42.86] 5/32 [3.97]
PRESSURE
4-3/4 [120.65]
The Dwyer Series DM-2000 Differential Pressure Transmitter senses the pressure of air and compatible gases and sends a standard 4-20 mA output signal. The DM-2000 housing is specifically designed to mount in the same diameter cutout as a standard Magnehelic gage. A wide range of models are available factory calibrated to specific ranges. Pressure connections are inherent to the glass filled plastic molded housing making installation quick and easy. Digital push-button zero simplifies calibration over typical turn-potentiometers. An optional 3.5 digit LCD shows process and engineering units. A single push button allows field selection of 4 to 6 engineering units depending on range LCD models. APPLICATIONS Filter monitoring Fan pressure indication Duct static pressures Bi-directional ranges ideal for sensing fluctuating building pressure ACCESSORIES A-299, Surface Mounting Bracket A-300, Flat Flush Mounting Bracket
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult Factory. Accuracy: 1% F.S. at 70F. Stability: 1% F.S./yr. Temperature Limits: 20 to 120F (-6.67 to 48.9C). Pressure Limits: 10 psig (0.69 bar). Thermal Effect: 0.055% F.S./F (0.099% F.S./C). Power Requirements: 10-35 VDC (2 wire). Output Signal: 4 to 20 mA. Zero and Span Adjustments: Digital push-button zero and span. Loop Resistance: DC: 0-1250 ohms maximum. Current Consumption: DC: 38 mA maximum. Electrical Connections: Screw-type terminal block. Display: 3.5 digit LCD, 0.7 height. Process Connections: 1/8 I.D. tubing. Mounting Orientation: Vertical. Weight: 4.8 oz (136 g).
Model Number DM-2001-LCD DM-2002-LCD DM-2003-LCD DM-2004-LCD DM-2005-LCD DM-2006-LCD DM-2007-LCD DM-2012-LCD DM-2013-LCD
Range .100 in wc .250 in wc .500 in wc 1.000 in wc 2.00 in wc 3.00 in wc 5.00 in wc .250-0-.250 in wc .500-0-.500 in wc
mBar .249 .622 1.243 2.49 4.97 7.46 12.43 .622-0-.622 1.243-0-1.243
kPa
psi
.108 .180
Note: Remove -LCD from the end of the model number if not needing the display.
CALL TO ORDER:
13
PRESSURE
Series 616OT
One-TouchReduces Installation andPressure Transmitter Differential Calibration Time One Button Calibration
3-19/64 [83.74] 2x 3/16 [4.76]
Series 616OT One-Touch Transmitter One Touch Button for quick setting of zero & span
3-7/8 [98.43]
4-3/8 [111.13]
1-1/8 [28.58]
1/8 [3.175]
The Series 616OT One-Touch Differential Pressure Transmitter is designed for simplicity making it the ideal choice for installers and maintenance professionals. The Series 616OT One-Touch Differential Pressure Transmitter is a cost-effective, compact transmitter that reduces up front costs as well as expenses over the life of the product. The 616OT One-Touch Transmitter not only alleviates cumbersome turn pots typically found in most transmitters, but eliminates entirely the need to span the instrument during calibration. With a single digital push button, both ZERO AND SPAN are calibrated properly, nothing else is required. No additional reference pressure sources and separate calibration devices are necessary; no need to remove from service and send to the lab. All the installer or user needs to do is let the unit sit at zero reference pressure, and then push a button. That is it! The transmitter is now ready for operation. Time savings are enormous over the life of the product compared to traditional transmitters which require time to annually remove the product from service as well as the extensive time to actually perform a full span calibration. Mounting is simple with back mounting tabs that are inherent to the molded housing. Wiring the transmitter is quick and convenient with a removable terminal block that allows the installer to wire externally, then snap the wired block back onto the board inside the housing. Model Number 616OT-10 616OT-15 616OT-20 616OT-2 KPA 616OT-3 KPA 616OT-5 KPA Range 10 w.c. 15 w.c. 20 w.c. 2 kPa 3 kPa 5 kPa
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Accuracy: 1%. Thermal Effect: 0.05%/F (0.03%/C). Stability: 1% F.S. / year. Temperature Limits: 0 to 140F (-18 to 60C). Pressure Limits: 1 psi maximum operation; 10 psi burst. Power Requirements: 2-wire, 10 to 35 VDC. Output Signal: 2-wire, 4 to 20 mA. Response Time: 300 ms. Pressure Calibration: One digital push button sets both zero & span simultaneously. APPLICATION Air Handlers
Loop Resistance: Current output: 1250 Ohm max. Current Consumption: 40 mA max. Electrical Connections: Removable European Style Terminal Block for 16 to 26 AWG. Electrical Entry: Cable gland for 0.114 to 0.250 (2.9 to 6.4 mm) diameter cable. Process Connections: Barbed, dual size to fit 1/8 (3 mm) and 3/16 (5 mm) I.D. rubber or vinyl tubing. Enclosure Rating: NEMA 4X (IP65). Weight: 4.0 oz (115 g). Agency Approval: CE pending.
Series 616K
Differential PressureDigital Push-Button Calibration with Transmitter Cost Effective for B.A.S. Applications,
One-Touch Transmitter Technology
5/16 (7.94)
Recessed Digital Push Button One push sets both zero & span
2-13/32 (61.12) 5/32 (3.97) MOUNTING HOLE 2 PLACES 1-1/2 (38.10) 1/2 (12.70) 3-21/64 (84.53) 1/2 (12.70) 2-1/4 (57.15)
7/8 (22.23)
The Series 616K Differential Pressure Transmitter with One-Touch Transmitter Technology is a cost-effective, compact transmitter that reduces up front costs as well as expenses over the life of the product. The Series 616K Differential Pressure Transmitter is ideal for building automation applications such as air handlers, duct pressure, variable air volume and filter monitoring. The 616K not only alleviates cumbersome turn pots typically found in most transmitters, but eliminates entirely the need to span the instrument during calibration. With a single digital push button both ZERO AND SPAN are calibrated properly, nothing else is required. No additional reference pressure sources and separate calibration devices are necessary; no need to remove from service and send to the lab. All the installer or user needs to do is let the unit sit at zero reference pressure, and then push a button. That is it! The transmitter is now ready for operation. Time savings are enormous over the life of the product compared to traditional transmitters which require time to annually remove the product from service as well as the extensive time to actually perform a full span calibration. Available models include ranges from 1 w.c. to 10 w.c. Model Number 616K-00 616K-01 616K-02 616K-03 616K-04 Range 0-1 w.c. 0-2 w.c. 0-3 w.c. 0-5 w.c. 0-10 w.c. Model Number 616K-10 616K-11 616K-12 616K-13 616K-14
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Accuracy: 2.0% F.S. Stability: 1% F.S./yr. Temperature Limits: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Pressure Limits: 2 PSI (13.8 kPa). Thermal Effect on Span: 0.11% F.S./F (+0.19% F.S./C) typ. Thermal Effect on Zero: 616K-X0: 0.6%/F (1%/C); 616K-X1: 0.3%/F (0.5%/C); 616K-X2: 0.2%/F (0.33%/C); 616K-X3: 0.12%/F (0.2%/C); 616K-X4: 0.06%/F (0.1%/C) F.S. max. Power Requirements: 16-35 VDC (2 or 3 wire); 20-28 VAC (3 wire).
Output Signal: 4 to 20 mA. Zero and Span Adjustments: Pushbutton. Loop Resistance: DC: 1000 ohms maximum. AC: 1200 ohms maximum. Current Consumption: 21 mA maximum. Electrical Connections: Screw-type terminal block. Process Connections: Barbed, dual size to fit 1/8 and 3/16 (3.12 mm and 4.76 mm) I.D. rubber or vinyl tubing. Mounting Orientation: Position insensitive. Weight: 1.8 oz (51 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
14
CALL TO ORDER:
PRESSURE
5/32 [3.97] MOUNTING HOLE TYP 2 PLACES 1/2 [12.7] 1-1/2 [38.1] 2-1/4 [57.15]
Series 616 & 616C Transmitters feature exceptional 0.25% and 1% accuracies in several factory calibrated ranges. Choose the one just right for your application. Span and Zero controls included for fine tuning and minor re-calibration in the field. APPLICATIONS Compact housing makes unit ideal for variable air volume systems
Model No. 616-00 616-0 616-1 616-2 616-3 616-4 616-5 616-6 616-7
Range 0-1 in. w.c. 0-2 in. w.c. 0-3 in. w.c. 0-6 in. w.c. 0-10 in. w.c. 0-20 in. w.c. 0-40 in. w.c. 0-100 in. w.c. 0-200 in. w.c.
Max. Press. 5 psig 5 psig 5 psig 5 psig 5 psig 11 psig 11 psig 29 psig 29 psig
Model No. 616-8 616-9 616-10 616-11 616-12 616-3B 616-6B 616-10B 616-20B
Range 0-10 psid 0-20 psid 0-30 psid 0-50 psid 0-100 psid 1.5-0-1.5 in. w.c. 3-0-3 in. w.c. 5-0-5 in. w.c. 10-0-10 in. w.c.
Max. Press. 58 psig 58 psig 58 psig 150 psig 150 psig 5 psig 5 psig 5 psig 11 psig
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Accuracy: 616: 0.25% F.S.; 616C 1% F.S. Stability: 1% F.S./yr. Temperature Limits: 0 to 140F (-17.8 to 60C). Compensated Temperature Limits: 20 to 120F (-6.67 to 48.9C). Pressure Limits: See Chart. Thermal Effect: 0.02% F.S./F (0.0012% F.S./C). Power Requirements: 10-35 VDC (2-wire).
Output Signal: 4 to 20 mA. Zero and Span Adjustments: Potentiometers for zero and span. Loop Resistance: DC; 0-1250 ohms maximum. Current Consumption: DC; 38 mA maximum. Electrical Connections: Screw-type terminal block. Process Connections: Barbed, dual size to fit 1/8 and 3/16 (3.12 mm and 4.76 mm) I.D. rubber or vinyl tubing. Weight: 1.8 oz (51 g). Agency Approvals: CE on 616 only.
Note: For 1% models add C after 616. 616C not available with 1 or 2 w.c. ranges.
Series 616D
1-1/2 [38.10]
3/4 [19.05]
The Series 616D Differential Pressure Transmitter senses the pressure of air and compatible gases and sends a standard 4-20 mA output signal. The 616D housing is specifically designed to mount on a 35 mm DIN rail in a panel. This mounting style allows for several units to be mounted closely together reducing required space. A wide range of models are available factory calibrated to specific ranges as listed in the chart below. The span and zero controls are for use when checking calibration. They are not intended for re-ranging to a significantly different span. Versatile circuit design enables operation in 2-wire current loops. APPLICATIONS Compact, DIN rail housing allows unit to be easily mounted in HVAC control panel
Model No. 616D-1 616D-2 616D-3 616D-4 616D-5 616D-6 616D-7 616D-8 616D-9
Range 0-3 in. w.c. 0-6 in. w.c. 0-10 in. w.c. 0-20 in. w.c. 0-40 in. w.c. 0-100 in. w.c. 0-200 in. w.c. 0-10 psid 0-20 psid
Max. Press. 5 psig 5 psig 5 psig 11 psig 11 psig 29 psig 29 psig 58 psig 58 psig
Model No. 616D-10 616D-11 616D-12 616D-13 616D-14 616D-3B 616D-6B 616D-10B 616D-20B
Range 0-30 psid 0-50 psid 0-100 psid 0-12 ft w.c. 0-20 ft w.c. 1.5-0-1.5 in. w.c. 3-0-3 in. w.c. 5-0-5 in. w.c. 10-0-10 in. w.c.
Max. Press. 58 psig 150 psig 150 psig 29 psig 58 psig 5 psig 5 psig 5 psig 11 psig
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult Factory. Accuracy: 0.25% F.S. at 70F. Stability: 1% F.S./yr. Temperature Limits: 20 to 120F (-6.67 to 48.9C). Pressure Limits: See chart. Thermal Effect: 0.02% F.S./F (0.0012% F.S./C). Power Requirements: 10-35 VDC (2-wire). Output Signal: 4 to 20 mA. Zero and Span Adjustments: Potentiometers for zero and span. Loop Resistance: DC: 0-1250 ohms max. Current Consumption: DC: 38 mA max. Electrical Connections: Screw-type terminal block. Process Connections: 1/8 female NPT. Accessories included are 2 barbed fittings for 1/8 (3.12 mm) and 3/16 (4.77 mm) I.D. rubber or vinyl tubing. Mounting Orientation: Vertical, on a 1.378 (35 mm) DIN rail. Weight: 4.8 oz (136 g).
CALL TO ORDER:
15
PRESSURE
Series 607
Series 607 Differential Pressure Transmitter combines very low ranges with exceptional stability, reliability and either 0.25% or 0.5% accuracy for the most demanding applications. Ranges from 0-0.1 to 0-25 w.c. Ultra thin glass clad silicon diaphragm design resists shock and vibration, practically eliminates drift. Certification to NIST standards is included with each unit. Tough stainless steel housing is NEMA-2 rated to protect against moisture and dirt. Use with air and other compatible gases. APPLICATIONS Leak Detection Clean Room Control Lab and fume hood pressure control Model No. 607-0 607-01* 607-1 607-11* 607-2 607-21* 607-3 607-4 607-7 Range (in w.c.) 0-.10 0-.10 0-.25 0-.25 0-.50 0-.50 0-1.0 0-2.0 0-5.0 Model Range No. (in w.c.) 607-71* 0-5.0 607-8 0-10 607-0B .10-0-.10 607-1B .25-0-.25 607-2B .50-0-.50 607-9 0-25 607-3B 1.0-0-1.0 607-4B 2.0-0-2.0 607-7B 5.0-0-5.0 * Models have a 0.25% F.S. accuracy.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and nonconductive, noncorrosive gases. Wetted Materials: Contact factory. Accuracy: 0.5% or 0.25% F.S. Stability: 0.5% F.S.O./yr. Temperature Limits: 20 to 160F (29 to 71C), 10 to 95% RH. Pressure Limits: 10 psig (0.69 bar). Compensated Temp. Range: 35 to 135F (2 to 57C). Thermal Effects: 0.015% FS/F (zero and span). Power Requirements: 12-36 VDC.
Output Signal: 4 to 20 mA DC, 2-wire. Zero & Span Adjustments: Externally accessible potentiometers, non-interactive, 10% F.S. adjustment. Response Time: 250 msec max. Loop Resistance: 0 to 1045 ohms Vmin=12V+[(.22A)(R L )]. Current Consumption: 3.6 mA (min). Electrical Connection: Screw terminals. Process Connection: Barbed stainless steel for 3/16 I.D. tubing. Housing: 300 Series SS (NEMA 2). Weight: 1.04 lb (472 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
Series 668
3-5/32 [80.16]
LOW
+ EXC
1-41/64 [41.67]
3/8 [9.53]
1-7/8 [47.63]
Our low cost Series 668 Differential Pressure Transmitter is capable of measuring low pressures with a 1% accuracy ideally suited for proper building pressurization and air flow control. Transmitters can withstand up to 10 psig overpressure with no damage to the unit. Variable capacitance sensor design provides excellent sensitivity and long-term stability. Compact, lightweight design makes installation simple and easy. Units also feature reverse-polarity protection. APPLICATIONS Compact housing ideal for variable air volume systems Bi-directional ranges suited to measure building pressures
SPECIFICATIONS
Service: Air and non-conductive gases. Accuracy: 1% of full scale (RSS) (includes non-linearity, hysteresis, and non-repeatability). Temperature Limits: Operating: 0 to 150F (-18 to 65C), Storage: -40 to 185F (-40 to 85C). Pressure Limits: 10 psig (0.69 bar). Compensated Temperature Range: 0 to 150F (-18 to 65C). Thermal Effects: 0.033% FS/F (0.018% FS/C).
Supply Voltage: 12-30 VDC. Output: 4 to 20 mA, 2-wire. Zero and Span Adjust: 1 mA, non-interactive. Response Time: <60 msec. Loop Resistance: 0-800 ohms. Electrical Connection: Terminal strip. Pressure Connection: 3/16 O.D. fitting for 1/4 I.D. tubing. Housing: Fire retardant glass filled polyester. Weight: 3 oz (85 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
Range 0 to 0.25 in. w.c. 0 to 0.5 in. w.c. 0 to 1 in. w.c. 0 to 2.5 in. w.c.
Range 0 to 5.0 in. w.c. 0 to 10 in. w.c. 0 to 25 in. w.c. 0 to 50 in. w.c. 0 to 100 in. w.c.
Bi-Directional
Model Number* 668-10 668-11 668-12 668-13 Range 0 to 0.1 in. w.c. 0 to 0.25 in. w.c. 0 to 0.5 in. w.c. 0 to 1 in. w.c. Model Number* 668-14 668-15 668-16 668-17 668-18 Range 0 to 2.5 in. w.c. 0 to 5 in. w.c. 0 to 10 in. w.c. 0 to 25 in. w.c. 0 to 50 in. w.c.
*Also available with optional conduit cover. To order add C to part number, i.e. 668C-1. Consult factory for additional information.
16
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 610
Precision Low Differential Pressure Transmitter Ideal for Clean Rooms, Easy to Field Calibrate with Security Key
CALIBRATION KEY A-165 31/64 [12.3] CALIBRATION KEY A-165 31/64 [12.3] 3/4 [19.05] 3/4 [19.05]
PRESSURE
5-41/64 [143.27]
3-29/32 [99.22]
3-29/32 [99.22]
2-29/32 [73.82]
2-29/32 [73.82] 3-13/32 [86.52] FOR 35mm DIN RAIL MOUNTING DIN RAIL MOUNT
The Series 610 Low Differential Pressure Transmitters are capable of measuring the pressures and flow of air or non-conducting gases at high resolutions. Designed specifically for clean rooms, isolation rooms, and other critical environments, the Series 610 uses an improved all stainless steel micro-tig welded sensor to detect differential pressure and convert this pressure into a linear DC electrical signal by a unique electrical circuit. This unit is ideal for situations when accurate and reliable pressure monitoring is essential. Easy access pressure ports and electrical connections, removable process heads, and detachable terminal blocks make for fast and easy installation. The Series 610 transmitters are available for air pressure ranges as low as 0.1 W.C. full scale. Standard accuracy is 0.25% full scale (terminal-based) in normal ambient temperature environments. The tensioned sensor allows up to 2 psi overpressure in either direction with absolutely no damage to the unit. The Series 610 transmitters can be ordered as either a base mount or a din rail mount and the option of a digital read out display. In addition, a calibration key can be ordered that allows the user to set zero and span. One key will work on multiple transmitters. FEATURES Ranges down to 0.1 w.c. with 0.25% or 0.5% F.S. accuracy Removeable process head for simplified installation Secure operation ensured with calibration only possible via separate calibration key
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air or similar non-conducting gases. Accuracy: 0.25% or 0.5% F.S. Stability: 0.5%/yr. Temperature Limits: -20 to 160F (-29 to 71C). Pressure Limits: 100 psi (6.8 bar). Thermal Effect: 0.5% FS. Power Requirements: 13.5 to 30 VDC. Output: 4 to 20 mA. Loop Resistance: 800 ohms max. Current Consumption: 25 mA. Zero and Span Adjustments: External security key pendant. Response Time: 0.02 to 0.04 seconds. Electrical Connections: Detachable screw terminal connector. Process Connections: 3/16 O.D. barbed brass fittings on removeable process head. Enclosure Rating: Fire retardant ABS. Mounting Orientation: Vertical. Weight: 9 oz (255 g). Agency Approvals: CE. ACCESSORIES A-165, Security Key A-616, Process Head without display A-617, Process Head with LCD display
0.5% Accuracy With Display Model 610-01D-BDE 610-25D-BDE 610-05D-BDE 610-01A-BDE 610-25A-BDE 610-05A-BDE 610-10A-BDE 610-01C-BDE 610-25C-BDE
0.25% Accuracy With Display Model 610-01D-BDV 610-25D-BDV 610-05D-BDV 610-01A-BDV 610-25A-BDV 610-05A-BDV 610-10A-BDV 610-01C-BDV 610-25C-BDV
Range 0-.1 0-.25 0-.5 0-1 0-2.5 0-5 0-10 0-.1 0-.25
Without Display Model 610-01D-BNV 610-25D-BNV 610-05D-BNV 610-01A-BNV 610-25A-BNV 610-05A-BNV 610-10A-BNV 610-01C-BNV 610-25C-BNV
Range 0-.1 0-.25 0-.5 0-1 0-2.5 0-5 0-10 0-.1 0-.25
Range 0-.1 0-.25 0-.5 0-1 0-2.5 0-5 0-10 0-.1 0-.25
Without Display Model 610-01D-BNE 610-25D-BNE 610-05D-BNE 610-01A-BNE 610-25A-BNE 610-05A-BNE 610-10A-BNE 610-01C-BNE 610-25C-BNE
Range 0-.1 0-.25 0-.5 0-1 0-2.5 0-5 0-10 0-.1 0-.25
CALL TO ORDER:
17
PRESSURE
5-1/2 (139.70)
The Series 626 Pressure Transmitters possess a highly precise 0.25% piezo-resistive sensor contained in a compact, rugged, NEMA 4X stainless steel general purpose housing or cast aluminum conduit housing. The Series 628 Pressure Transmitters are ideal for OEMs with 1% full scale accuracy sensors. The transmitter is also available in the general purpose stainless steel housing and the cast aluminum conduit housing. The highly corrosive resistant 316L stainless steel wetted parts allow the Series 626 and 628 transmitters to measure the pressure in a multitude of processes from hydraulic oils to chemicals. The Series 626 and 628 are available in ranges of vacuum, compound to 5000 psi with a variety of optional outputs, process connections and electrical terminations to allow you to select the right transmitter for your application. APPLICATIONS Compressors Pumping systems Irrigation system pressure Fire pump control pressures Refrigerant line pressures on air handlers when used with optional refrigerant valve depressor Trash compaction equipment
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases and liquids. Wetted Materials: Type 316 SS, 316L SS. Accuracy: 626: 0.25% full scale. 628: 1% full scale (includes linearity, hysteresis, and repeatability). Temperature Limit: 0 to 200F (-18 to 93C). Compensated Temperature Range: 0 to 175F (-18 to 79C). Thermal Effect: 626: 0.02% FS/F. 628: 0.04% FS/F (includes zero and span). Pressure Limits: See table. Power Requirements: 13 to 30 VDC. Output Signal: 4 to 20 mA. Optional 0-5, 1-5, 0-10, 1-6 or 2-10. Response Time: 50 msec. Loop Resistance: 0 - 1300 ohms maximum for current. For voltage outputs, minimum load resistance: 2000 ohms. Current Consumption: 38 mA (maximum). Electrical Connections: Conduit Housing (-CH): terminal block, 1/2 female NPT conduit. General Purpose Housing (-GH): cable, DIN connector or 4 pin M-12. Process Connection: 1/4 male or female NPT and BSPT. Enclosure Rating: NEMA 4X (IP66). Mounting Orientation: Mount in any position. Weight: 10 oz (283 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
PRESSURE LIMITS
Range Number 00 30 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 Pressure Range (psig) 30 Hg-0 0-30 Hg 30-0-15 30-0-30 30-0-45 30-0-60 30-0-100 0-5 0-15 0-30 0-50 0-100 Maximum Pressure (psig) 30 30 30 60 100 200 200 10 30 60 100 200 Over Range Pressure (psig) Number 150 11 150 12 150 13 300 14 300 15 500 16 500 17 50 18 150 19 300 26 300 500 Pressure Range (psig) 0-150 0-200 0-300 0-500 0-1000 0-1500 0-2000 0-3000 0-5000 0-8000 Maximum Pressure (psig) 300 400 600 1000 2000 3000 4000 6000 7500 10000 Over Pressure (psig) 750 1000 1500 2500 5000 5000 5000 7500 10000 12000
18
CALL TO ORDER:
ORDERING CHART Accuracy 626 628 -30 -00 -01 -02 -03 -04 -05 -06 -07 -08 -09 -10 -11 -12 -13 -14 -15 -16 -17 -18 -19 -26 -CH -GH -P1 -P2 -P3 -P4 -P5 -E1 -E2 -E3 -E4 -E5 -E6 -S1 -S2 -S3 -S4 -S5 -S6 -AT -NIST -LED 0.25% Full Scale Accuracy 1.0% Full Scale Accuracy 0-30 Hg Vacuum 30 Hg Vacuum - 0 psi 30-0-15 psi 30-0-30 psi 30-0-45 psi 30-0-60 psi 30-0-100 psi 0-5 psi 0-15 psi 0-30 psi 0-50 psi 0-100 psi 0-150 psi 0-200 psi 0-300 psi 0-500 psi 0-1000 psi 0-1500 psi 0-2000 psi 0-3000 psi 0-5000 psi 0-8000 psi Conduit Housing General Purpose Housing 1/4 male NPT 1/4 female NPT 1/4 male BSPT 1/4 female BSPT 1/4 female SAE with Refrigerant Valve Depressor Cable Gland with 3 of Prewired Cable Cable Gland with 6 of Prewired Cable Cable Gland with 9 of Prewired Cable DIN Connector Available with -GH Housing Only 1/2 female NPT Conduit Available with -CH Housing Only M-12 4 Pin Connector 4-20 mA 1-5 Volt 2-10 Volt 0-5 Volt 0-10 Volt 1-6 Volt Aluminum Tag NIST Traceable Certificate Bright Red LED display. Available with -CH housing only Optional -E4 DIN Connector (GH housing only)
PRESSURE
Range
Housing
Process Connection
Electrical Connection
Signal Output
Options
CALL TO ORDER:
19
PRESSURE
Series WWDP
11/32 [8.73]
61/64 [24.21]
The Series WWDP Wet-to-Wet Differential Pressure Transmitter offers everything in one package by having 30 field selectable variations in just 3 models. The WWDP provides field selectable unidirectional and bidirectional pressure ranges, configurable 05, 1-5, 0-10 VDC, and 4 to 20 mA output. It also provides an auto-zero capability. The field selectable port swap feature eliminates costly replumbing if the unit is improperly installed or if the tranmitter is simply replaced. An optional LCD display is available for on-sight indication of line and differential pressure. The all cast aluminum housing is rated NEMA 4 (IP66). These features make the WWDP transmitter an ideal instrument for measuring the flow of various liquids and gases, pressure drop across filters, measurement of liquid level or pressurized vessels, and for use in energy management and process control systems. APPLICATIONS Monitor differential pressure of a chiller
Description Selectable 5,10,25,50 psid Selectable 10,20,50,100 psid Selectable 25,50,125,250 psid
Description Selectable 5,10,25,50 psid Selectable 10,20,50,100 psid Selectable 25,50,125,250 psid
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Gases or liquids compatible with 17-4 PH stainless steel. Accuracy: All pressure ranges have 1% full scale accuracy except the lowest selectable range of each unit is 2% full scale. Stability: 0.5% per year. Temperature Limits: Compensated temperature range: 32 to 130F (0 to 54C); Operating temperature range: -4 to 185F (-20 to 85C). Pressure Limits: Max working pressure: WWDP-1: 50 psi; WWDP-2: 100 psi; WWDP-3: 250 psi; Proof pressure: 2.2X of full scale; Burst pressure: 40X of full scale. Thermal Effect: 2% FS/100F (50C) includes zero and span. Power Requirements: 12 to 30 VDC/18 to 28 VAC (Reverse Excitation Protected). NOTE: 4-20 mA output cannot be powered with AC voltage. Output Signal: Selectable 0-5, 0-10 and 1-5 VDC; 4 to 20 mA. Zero & Span: Digital re zero button (should be used when changing ranges). Span can be adjusted by changing between field selectable ranges. Response Time: 1 to 5 sec (selectable). Loop Resistance: 1000 ohms. Current Consumption: VDC power: 0-5, 1-5 VDC output 4 mA (typ); 0-10 VDC output 5 mA (typ); 4-20 mA output 20 mA max. Current consumption will equal the transmitter output in current mode. VAC power: 0-5, 1-5, 0-10 VDC output 40 mA (typ). Electrical Connections: 1/2 conduit. Process Connections: 1/8 female NPT internal. Enclosure Rating: Designed to meet NEMA 4 (IP66). Mounting Orientation: Vertical; mount the pressure ports down (keeps debris from building up inside the pressure port). Size: 4 x 6 x 2 in (102 x 152 x 51 mm). Weight: 1.5 lb (680.4 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
20
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 629
PRESSURE
[34.13] 3-9/32 [83.34] LIQUID TIGHT FITTING CORD DIAMETER RANGE: .200 TO .350 [5.06 TO 8.89] 1/4 NPT TYP
1-5/8 [41.28] 5-25/32 [146.84] 1/4 NPT FEMALE FITTING 6-59/64 [175.82] OPTIONAL 1/4 NPT MALE FITTING
The Series 629 Differential Pressure Transmitter monitors differential pressure of air and compatible gases and liquids with 0.5% accuracy. The design employs dual pressure sensors converting pressure changes into a standard 4-20 mA output signal for two wire circuits. Small internal volume and minimum moving parts result in exceptional response and reliability. Terminal block, zero and span adjustments are easily accessed under the top cover. The Series 629 Differential Pressure Transmitter is designed to meet NEMA4X (IP66) construction. APPLICATIONS Monitor Differential Pressures Across: Flow elements Heat exchangers Filters Pumps Coils Compressors
Standard Range (psid) 10 25 50 100 Pressure Limits Working* Over Pressure (psid) Pressure (psi) 20 100 50 250 100 250 200 500
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases & liquids. Wetted Materials: Types 316, 316L SS. Additional with 3-way valve option: Buna-N, Silicone Grease, PTFE, Brass 360, Copper, reinforced acetal copolymer. Accuracy: 0.5% F.S. (includes linearity, hysteresis & repeatability). Temperature Limits: 0 to 200F (-18 to 93C). Compensated Temperature Limits: 0 to 175F (-18 to 79C). Pressure Limits: See chart. Thermal Effect: 0.02%/F (0.036%/C) includes zero & span. Power Requirements: 13-30 VDC (2-wire). Output Signal: 4 to 20 mA. Optional 0-5, 0-10 VDC. Response Time: 50 msec. Loop Resistance: 0-1300 ohms maximum for current output. For voltage outputs, minimum load resistance: 2000 ohms. Electrical Connections: Terminal block; 1/2 female NPT conduit. Process Connections: 1/4 female NPT. Enclosure Rating: Designed to meet NEMA 4X (IP66). Mounting Orientation: Not position sensitive. Weight: 10.1 oz (286 g). Agency Approvals: CE. OPTIONS -LED, 4.5 Digit LED Display ACCESSORIES A-228, Stainless steel flex hose, 12 (30.48 cm) long, 1/8 male NPT connections. A-229, Stainless steel flex hose, 18 (45.72 cm) long, 1/8 male NPT connections. A-332, Brass adapter, 1/8 female NPT to 1/4 male NPT. 3-way valve package with bleed screw
* Pressures exceeding the working pressure limit may cause a calibration shift of up to 3% of full scale.
3-Way Valve Manifold Pressure Limits Working* Range Pressure Over Pressure (psi) Model Number (psid) (psid) 100 20 629-02-CH-P2-E5-S1-3V 10 100 50 629-03-CH-P2-E5-S1-3V 25 100 100 629-04-CH-P2-E5-S1-3V 50 100 100 629-05-CH-P2-E5-S1-3V 100
Bleed Screw
CALL TO ORDER:
21
PRESSURE
Series 631B
Wet/Wet 0.5 w.c. with 500 psiPressureRating Differential Static Pressure Transmitter Ranges Down to
3/4 [19.05] 1/4 FEMALE NPT HIGH PRESSURE CONNECTION (AIR OR GAS) 4-45/64 [119.46] 1/4 FEMALE NPT LOW PRESSURE CONNECTION (AIR OR GAS) 35 TYP
3-13/32 [86.52]
3/16 [4.76]
5 [127.00]
(4) #6-32 X 3/8 (9.53) DP HOLE ON A 4-11/32 [110.33] BOLT CIRCLE 1/4 FEMALE NPT HIGH PRESSURE CONNECTION (LIQUID) 1/4 FEMALE NPT LOW PRESSURE CONNECTION (LIQUID)
The Series 631B Differential Pressure Transmitter monitors differential pressure of air and compatible gases and liquids with accuracy. The design employs converting pressure changes into a standard 4-20 mA output signal for two wire circuits. Digital push-button, zero and span adjustments are easily accessed on the front cover. The Series 631B Differential Pressure Transmitter is designed to meet NEMA 4X (IP66) construction. Robust housing offers 500 psi static pressure rating on ranges down to 0.5 w.c.
Range 0-0.5 w.c. 0-1 w.c. 0-2 w.c. 0-5 w.c. 0-25 w.c.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases & liquids. Wetted Materials: Brass, silicone, 300 SS. Accuracy: Transmitter Output: 2% F.S. (includes linearity, hysteresis and repeatability). Gage: 3% of full scale at 70F (21.1C). Stability: 1% F.S./yr. Temperature Limits: 20 to 120F (-6.67 to 48.9C). Pressure Limits: -20 Hg to 500 psig (-0.677 bar to 34.4 bar). Thermal Effect: 0.025%/F (0.045%/C) includes zero & span. Power Requirements: 10-35 VDC. Output Signal: 4 to 20 mA. Response Time: 50 msec. Loop Resistance: 0-1250 ohms maximum. Electrical Connections: M-12 circular 4 pin connector. Process Connections: 1/4 female NPT high and low pressure taps, duplicated - one pair top for air and gas, and one pair bottom for liquids. Enclosure Rating: Designed to meet NEMA 4X (IP66). Mounting Orientation: Diaphragm in vertical position. Consult factory for other position orientations. Weight: 8 lb, 4 oz (3.74 kg). Agency Approvals: CE.
APPLICATIONS Refrigeration equipment Energy and water management Liquid level in water storage tanks
22
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 2000
PRESSURE
1/8 LOW PRESSURE 11/16 [17.46] 7/16 [11.11] 1-11/16 [42.86] 1/2 [12.70] 4-3/4 [120.65]
Dimensions, Standard Series 2000 Magnehelic Pressure Gages. (Slightly different on medium and high pressure models)
Select the Dwyer Magnehelic gage for high accuracy guaranteed within 2% of full scale and for the wide choice of 81 models available to suit your needs precisely. Using Dwyer's simple, frictionless Magnehelic gage movement, it quickly indicates low air or non-corrosive gas pressures either positive, negative (vacuum) or differential. The design resists shock, vibration and over-pressures. No manometer fluid to evaporate, freeze or cause toxic or leveling problems. It's inexpensive, too. Note: May be used with Hydrogen when ordering a Buna-N diaphragm. Pressures must be less than 35 psi. APPLICATIONS Filter monitoring Air velocity with Dwyer Pitot tube Blower vacuum monitoring Fan pressure indication Duct, room or building pressures Clean room positive pressure indication SERIES 2000 MAGNEHELIC GAGE MODELS AND RANGES
The models below will fulfill most requirements. Special models built for OEM customers are also available. For special scales furnished in ounces per square inch, inches of mercury, metric units, etc., contact the factory.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. (Natural Gas option available.) Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Housing: Die cast aluminum case and bezel, with acrylic cover. Exterior finish is coated gray to withstand 168 hour salt spray corrosion test. Accuracy: 2% of full scale (3% on - 0, -100 PA, -125 PA, 10MM and 4% on - 00, -60PA, -6MM ranges), throughout range at 70F (21.1C). Pressure Limits: -20 Hg to 15 psig. (-0.677 bar to 1.034 bar); MP option: 35 psig (2.41 bar), HP option: 80 psig (5.52 bar). Overpressure: Relief plug opens at approximately 25 psig (1.72 bar), standard gages only. Temperature Limits: 20 to 140F.* (-6.67 to 60C). Size: 4 (101.6 mm) Diameter dial face. Mounting Orientation: Diaphragm in vertical position. Consult factory for other position orientations. Process Connections: 1/8 female NPT duplicate high and low pressure taps - one pair side and one pair back. Weight: 1 lb 2 oz (510 g). Standard Accessories: Two 1/8 NPT plugs for duplicate pressure taps, two 1/8 pipe thread to rubber tubing adapter and three flush mounting adapters with screws. *Low temperature models available as special option. For applications with high cycle rate within gage total pressure rating, next higher rating is recommended. See Medium and High pressure options at lower left. Note: Scales available in any pressure units. Air Velocity and volumetric scales also can be specified.
Range Model Inches Number of Water 2000-00 0-.25 2000-0 0-.50 2001 0-1.0 2002 0-2.0 2003 0-3.0 2004 0-4.0 2005 0-5.0 2006 0-6.0 2008 0-8.0 2010 0-10 2015 0-15 2020 0-20 2025 0-25
Range Zero Center Model Inches of Number Water 2300-0 .25-0-.25 2301 .5-0-.5 2302 1-0-1 2304 2-0-2 2310 5-0-5 2320 10-0-10 15-0-15 2330
Dual Scale Air Velocity Units Model Number 2000-00AV 2000-0AV 2001AV 2002AV 2010AV Range in W.C. Velocity, F.P.M. 0-.25/300-2000 0-.50/500-2800 0-1.0/500-4000 0-2.0/1000-5600 0-10/2000-12500 Model Number 2000-60PA 2000-100PA 2000-125PA 2000-250PA 2000-300PA 2000-500PA 2000-750PA Range, Pascals 0-60 0-100 0-125 0-250 0-300 0-500 0-750
Dual Scale English/Metric Models Model Number 2000-OD 2001D 2002D 2003D 2004D 2006D 2008D 2010D Range, In. W.C. 0-0.5 0-1.0 0-2.0 0-3.0 0-4.0 0-6.0 0-8.0 0-10 Range, Pa or kPa 0-125 Pa 0-250 Pa 0-500 Pa 0-750 Pa 0-1.0 kPa 0-1.5 kPa 0-2.0 kPa 0-2.5 kPa
Zero Center Ranges 125-0-125 2300-250PA 250-0-250 2300-500PA 30-0-30 2300-60PA 50-0-50 2300-100PA 60-0-60 2300-1200PA
These ranges calibrated for vertical scale position. Accuracy +/-3%. Accuracy +/-4%
CALL TO ORDER:
23
PRESSURE
Series 2-5000
19/64 [7.54]
Combining clean design, small size and low cost with enough accuracy for all but the most demanding applications our Minihelic II gage offers the latest in design features for a dial type differential pressure gage. It is our most compact gage but is easy to read and can safely operate at total pressures up to 30 psig. The Minihelic II gage is designed for panel mounting in a single 2 5/8" diameter hole. Standard pressure connections are barbed fittings for 3/16" I.D. tubing; optional 1/8" male NPT connections are also available. Over-pressure protection is built into the Minihelic II gage by means of a blow-out membrane molded in conjunction with the diaphragm. Accidental overranging up to the rated total pressure will not damage the gage. With removable lens and rear housing, the gage may be easily serviced at minimum cost. With the housing molded from mineral and glass filled nylon and the lens molded from polycarbonate, the gage will withstand rough use and exposure as well as high total pressure. The 5% accuracy and low cost of the Minihelic II gage make it well-suited for a wide variety of OEM and user applications. OEM applications include cabinet air purging, medical respiratory therapy equipment, air samplers, laminar flow hoods, and electronic air cooling systems. As an air filter gage, the Minihelic II gage finds many end use applications on large stationary engines, compressors, ventilators, and air handling units. The Minihelic II gage is suitable for many of the same applications as the Magnehelic gage where the greater accuracy, sensitivity, and higher and lower differential pressure ranges of the Magnehelic gage are not required. APPLICATIONS Room positive pressure sensing Local indication on filter status Face velocity on fume hood Duct pressures
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Housing: Glass filled nylon; polycarbonate lens. Accuracy: 5% of full scale at 70F (21.1C). Pressure Limits: 30 psig (2.067 bar) continuous to either pressure connection. Temperature Limits: 20 to 120F (-6.67 to 48.9C). Size: 2-1/16 (52.39 mm) diameter dial face. Mounting Orientation: Diaphragm in vertical position. Consult factory for other position orientations. Process Connections: Barbed, for 3/16 I.D. tubing (standard); 1/8 male NPT (optional). Weight: 6 oz (170.1g). CAUTION: FOR USE ONLY WITH AIR OR COMPATIBLE GASES.
Model Number 2-5000-0 2-5001 2-5002 2-5003 2-5005 2-5010 2-5020 2-5040 2-5060 2-5100
Range, Inches of Water 0-0.5 0-1.0 0-2.0 0-3.0 0-5.0 0-10 0-20 0-40 0-60 0-100
Model Number 2-5000-25MM 2-5000-50MM 2-5000-100MM Model Number 2-5000-125Pa 2-5000-250Pa 2-5000-500Pa Model Number 2-5000-1 kPa 2-5000-3 kPa
Range, MM of Water 0-25 0-50 0-100 Range, Pascals 0-125 0-250 0-500 Range, kPa 0-1 0-3
ACCESSORIES A-434 Portable Kit A-497 Surface Mtg. Brkt. A-609 Air Filter Kit
*THIS RANGE EMPLOYS SPIRALLY WOUND BERYLLIUM COPPER BOURDON TUBE POINTER DRIVE MECHANISM. NOTE: CONSULT FACTORY REGARDING AVAILABILITY OF ADDITIONAL RANGES.
For optional 18" male NPT connections, add suffix -NPT to model numbers listed above. Example: 2-5001-NPT. No extra charge. Allow additional lead time.
24
CALL TO ORDER:
Series TRI
Tridicator Gage
Combination Pressure/Temperature Gage
MODEL NO. TRI-60-25E TRI-75-25E TRI-100-25E TRI-200-25E TRI-60-50 TRI-75-50 TRI-100-50 TRI-200-5 TRI-60-50L TRI-75-50L TRI-100-50L TRI-200-50L A 4-1/2 [114.3] B 1-21/64 [33.74] C 1 [25.4]
PRESSURE
5-15/64 [132.95]
3 [76.2]
2-39/64 [66.78]
The Series TRI combines the value of an individual pressure gage and thermometer in one instrument. These tridicators simplify installation which reduces time and saves money. The moveable dial with blue pressure markings and red temperature markings make the instrument easy to read. Pressure is indicated in both psi and kPa, while temperature is measured in both Fahrenheit and Celsius. Series TRI comes in three different connection options including lower mount, center back mount, and center back mount with extension shank. APPLICATIONS Boiler Monitoring
Model Number TRI-60-25E TRI-75-25E TRI-100-25E TRI-200-25E TRI-60-50 TRI-75-50 TRI-100-50 TRI-200-50 TRI-60-50L TRI-75-50L TRI-100-50L TRI-200-50L
Range 0-60 psi (0-400 kPa) 0-75 psi (0-500 kPa) 0-100 psi (0-700 kPa) 0-200 psi (0-1400 kPa) 0-60 psi (0-400 kPa) 0-75 psi (0-500 kPa) 0-100 psi (0-700 kPa) 0-200 psi (0-1400 kPa) 0-60 psi (0-400 kPa) 0-75 psi (0-500 kPa) 0-100 psi (0-700 kPa) 0-200 psi (0-1400 kPa)
Connection 1/4 NPT CBM (ext. shank) 1/4 NPT CBM (ext. shank) 1/4 NPT CBM (ext. shank) 1/4 NPT CBM (ext. shank) 1/2 NPT CBM 1/2 NPT CBM 1/2 NPT CBM 1/2 NPT CBM 1/2 NPT LM 1/2 NPT LM 1/2 NPT LM 1/2 NPT LM
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases and liquids. Wetted Materials: Brass connection and phosphor bronze Bourdon tube. Housing: Drawn Steel, black finish. Accuracy: Pressure 3-2-3%; Temperature 1 scale division. Temperature Range: All models: 80 to 290F (30 to 140C). Temperature Limits: Ambient: -40 to 250F (-40 to 120C); Process: 80 to 290F (30 to 140C). Pressure Limits: Full scale range. Size: 3 (76 mm). Process Connections: 1/2 male NPT back or bottom, 1/4 male NPT back connection. Weight: 12.3 oz (348.7 g).
CALL TO ORDER:
25
PRESSURE
2-7/16 [61.9]
SGD
SGT
1/4 NPT
The Series SGD/SGT Gages have dual English/metric scales with 1.6% full scale accuracy. The Series SGD/SGT gages are designed with 304 SS housings and 316 SS or brass wetted parts for excellent chemical compatibility. These gages cover a wide variety of ranges from full vacuum to 15,000 psi. Series SGD/SGT gages may be easily liquid filled in the field without the need for a seperate kit.
APPLICATIONS Positive pressure in compressed air lines Water pressure in hot and cold lines
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases and liquids. Wetted Materials: SGD: 316 SS; SGT: Brass. Housing: 304 SS. Lens: Plexi-glass. Accuracy: 1.6% full scale. Pressure Limit: 130% full scale for ranges <6000 psi, 115% for 6000 psi and greater.
Temperature Limits: SGD: Ambient: -4 to 149F (-25 to 65C), Process: 518F max. (270C max.); SGT: Ambient: -4 to 140F (-20 to 60C), Process: 248F max. (120C max.). Size: 2.5 (63 mm). Process Connections: 1/4 male NPT. Enclosure Rating: NEMA 3 (IP55). Weight: 4.6 oz (0.13 kg).
316SS Gages Model Model Number Number SGD-D0122N SGD-D0122N SGD-D0222N SGD-D0222N SGD-D0322N SGD-D0322N SGD-D0422N SGD-D0422N SGD-D0522N SGD-D0522N SGD-D0622N SGD-D0622N SGD-D0722N SGD-D0722N SGD-D0822N SGD-D0822N SGD-D0922N SGD-D0922N SGD-D1022N SGD-D1022N SGD-D1122N SGD-D1122N SGD-D1222N SGD-D1222N SGD-D1322N SGD-D1322N SGD-D1422N SGD-D1422N SGD-D1522N SGD-D1522N SGD-D1622N SGD-D1622N SGD-D1722N SGD-D1722N SGD-D1822N SGD-D1822N SGD-D2122N SGD-D2122N SGD-D2222N SGD-D2222N SGD-D2322N SGD-D2322N SGD-D2422N SGD-D2422N SGD-D2522N SGD-D2522N SGD-D2622N SGD-D2622N SGD-D2722N SGD-D2722N
Range Range 30 Hg-0 (-100-0 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0 (-100-0 0-150-15(0-100 kPa)kPa) psi psi (0-100 0-300-30(0-200 kPa)kPa) psi psi (0-200 0-600-60(0-400 kPa)kPa) psi psi (0-400 0-100 psi (0-700 kPa)kPa) 0-100 psi (0-700 0-150 psi (0-1000 kPa)kPa) 0-150 psi (0-1000 0-200 psi (0-1400 kPa)kPa) 0-200 psi (0-1400 0-300 psi (0-2000 kPa)kPa) 0-300 psi (0-2000 0-400 psi (0-2800 kPa)kPa) 0-400 psi (0-2800 0-500 psi (0-3400 kPa)kPa) 0-500 psi (0-3400 0-600 psi (0-4000 kPa)kPa) 0-600 psi (0-4000 0-1000 psi (0-7000 kPa)kPa) 0-1000 psi (0-7000 0-1500 psi (0-10 MPa) 0-1500 psi (0-10 MPa) 0-2000 psi (0-14 MPa) 0-2000 psi (0-14 MPa) 0-3000 psi (0-20 MPa) 0-3000 psi (0-20 MPa) 0-4000 psi (0-28 MPa) 0-4000 psi (0-28 MPa) 0-5000 psi (0-34 MPa) 0-5000 psi (0-34 MPa) 0-6000 psi (0-40 MPa) 0-6000 psi (0-40 MPa) 30 Hg-0-15 psi (-100-0-100 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-15 psi (-100-0-100 30 Hg-0-30 psi (-100-0-200 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-30 psi (-100-0-200 30 Hg-0-60 psi (-100-0-400 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-60 psi (-100-0-400 30 Hg-0-100 psi (-100-0-700 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-100 psi (-100-0-700 30 Hg-0-150 psi (-100-0-1000 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-150 psi (-100-0-1000 30 Hg-0-200 psi (-100-0-1400 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-200 psi (-100-0-1400 30 Hg-0-300 psi (-100-0-2000 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-300 psi (-100-0-2000
Brass Gages Model Model Number Number SGT-D0122N SGT-D0122N SGT-D0222N SGT-D0222N SGT-D0322N SGT-D0322N SGT-D0422N SGT-D0422N SGT-D0522N SGT-D0522N SGT-D0622N SGT-D0622N SGT-D0722N SGT-D0722N SGT-D0822N SGT-D0822N SGT-D0922N SGT-D0922N SGT-D1022N SGT-D1022N SGT-D1122N SGT-D1122N SGT-D1222N SGT-D1222N SGT-D1322N SGT-D1322N SGT-D1422N SGT-D1422N SGT-D1522N SGT-D1522N SGT-D1622N SGT-D1622N SGT-D1722N SGT-D1722N SGT-D1822N SGT-D1822N SGT-D2122N SGT-D2122N SGT-D2222N SGT-D2222N SGT-D2322N SGT-D2322N SGT-D2422N SGT-D2422N SGT-D2522N SGT-D2522N SGT-D2622N SGT-D2622N SGT-D2722N SGT-D2722N
Range Range 30 Hg-0 (-100-0 30 Hg-0 (-100-0 kPa)kPa) 0-150-15(0-100 kPa)kPa) psi psi (0-100 0-300-30(0-200 kPa)kPa) psi psi (0-200 0-600-60(0-400 kPa)kPa) psi psi (0-400 0-100 psi (0-700 0-100 psi (0-700 kPa)kPa) 0-150 psi (0-1000 0-150 psi (0-1000 kPa)kPa) 0-200 psi (0-1400 0-200 psi (0-1400 kPa)kPa) 0-300 psi (0-2000 0-300 psi (0-2000 kPa)kPa) 0-400 psi (0-2800 0-400 psi (0-2800 kPa)kPa) 0-500 psi (0-3400 0-500 psi (0-3400 kPa)kPa) 0-600 psi (0-4000 0-600 psi (0-4000 kPa)kPa) 0-1000 psi (0-7000 0-1000 psi (0-7000 kPa)kPa) 0-1500 psi (0-10 MPa) 0-1500 psi (0-10 MPa) 0-2000 psi (0-14 MPa) 0-2000 psi (0-14 MPa) 0-3000 psi (0-20 MPa) 0-3000 psi (0-20 MPa) 0-4000 psi (0-28 MPa) 0-4000 psi (0-28 MPa) 0-5000 psi (0-34 MPa) 0-5000 psi (0-34 MPa) 0-6000 psi (0-40 MPa) 0-6000 psi (0-40 MPa) 30 Hg-0-15 psi (-100-0-100 30 Hg-0-15 psi (-100-0-100 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-30 psi (-100-0-200 30 Hg-0-30 psi (-100-0-200 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-60 psi (-100-0-400 30 Hg-0-60 psi (-100-0-400 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-100 psi (-100-0-700 30 Hg-0-100 psi (-100-0-700 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-150 psi (-100-0-1000 30 Hg-0-150 psi (-100-0-1000 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-200 psi (-100-0-1400 30 Hg-0-200 psi (-100-0-1400 kPa)kPa) 30 Hg-0-300 psi (-100-0-2000 30 Hg-0-300 psi (-100-0-2000 kPa)kPa)
Note: To order with glycerin fill add -PY to the end of the model.
26
CALL TO ORDER:
PRESSURE
2-27/64 [61.52]
1/4 NPT
SGX
SGF
13/32 [10.32]
The Series SGX/SGF Gages have dual English/metric scales with 1.6% full scale accuracy. The Series SGX/SGF gages are designed with 304 SS housing and brass or 316 SS wetted parts. Units can withstand ambient temperatures up to 149F (65C) and process temperatures up to 212F (100C). Ranges of vacuum, compound and pressures to 235 inches w.c. are available. Included on the dial is a convenient zero adjustment screw which allows the user to easily re-zero the needle.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases & liquids. Wetted Materials: SGX: Brass; SGF: 316/316L-SS. Housing: 304 SS. Lens: Glass. Accuracy: 1.6% full scale on positive pressure ranges 15 w.c. and greater. 2.5% full scale on all other ranges. Pressure Limit: Full scale value. Temperature Limits: Ambient: -13 to 149F (-25 to 65C); Process: 212F max. (100C max.). Size: 2.5 (63 mm). Process Connections: 1/4 male NPT. Enclosure Rating: NEMA 3 (IP55). Weight: 4.6 oz (0.13 kg).
Brass Gages
Model Number SGX-D7122N SGX-D7222N SGX-D7322N SGX-D7422N SGX-D7522N SGX-D7622N SGX-D7722N SGX-D7822N SGX-D7922N SGX-D8022N SGX-D8122N SGX-D8222N SGX-D8322N SGX-D8422N SGX-D8522N SGX-D8722N SGX-D8822N SGX-D8922N SGX-D9022N SGX-D9122N SGX-D9222N SGX-D9322N SGX-D9422N SGX-D9522N SGX-D9622N SGX-D9722N Range -10-0 in. w.c. (-250-0 mm) -15-0 in. w.c. (-400-0 mm) -25-0 in. w.c. (-600-0 mm) -40-0 in. w.c. (-1000-0 mm) -60-0 in. w.c. (-1600-0 mm) -80-0 in. w.c. (-2000-0 mm) -100-0 in. w.c. (-2500-0 mm) -160-0 in. w.c. (-4000-0 mm) -235-0 in. w.c. (-6000-0 mm) 0-10 in. w.c. (0-250 mm) 0-15 in. w.c. (0-400 mm) 0-25 in. w.c. (0-600 mm) 0-40 in. w.c. (0-1000 mm) 0-60 in. w.c. (0-1600 mm) 0-80 in. w.c. (0-2500 mm) 0-160 in. w.c. (0-4000 mm) 0-235 in. w.c. (0-6000 mm) -4-0-6 in. w.c. (-100-0-150 mm) -6-0-10 in. w.c. (-150-0-250 mm) -8-0-16 in. w.c. (-200-0-400 mm) -16-0-24 in. w.c. (-400-0-600 mm) -24-0-40 in. w.c. (-600-0-1000 mm) -30-0-50 in. w.c. (-800-0-1200 mm) -40-0-60 in. w.c. (-1000-0-1500 mm) -60-0-100 in. w.c. (-1500-0-2500 mm) -80-0-160 in. w.c. (-2000-0-4000 mm)
316SS Gages
Model Number SGF-D7122N SGF-D7222N SGF-D7322N SGF-D7422N SGF-D7522N SGF-D7622N SGF-D7722N SGF-D7822N SGF-D7922N SGF-D8022N SGF-D8122N SGF-D8222N SGF-D8322N SGF-D8422N SGF-D8622N SGF-D8722N SGF-D8822N SGF-D8922N SGF-D9022N SGF-D9122N SGF-D9222N SGF-D9322N SGF-D9422N SGF-D9522N SGF-D9622N SGF-D9722N Range -10-0 in. w.c. (-250-0 mm) -15-0 in. w.c. (-400-0 mm) -25-0 in. w.c. (-600-0 mm) -40-0 in. w.c. (-1000-0 mm) -60-0 in. w.c. (-1600-0 mm) -80-0 in. w.c. (-2000-0 mm) -100-0 in. w.c. (-2500-0 mm) -160-0 in. w.c. (-4000-0 mm) -235-0 in. w.c. (-6000-0 mm) 0-10 in. w.c. (0-250 mm) 0-15 in. w.c. (0-400 mm) 0-25 in. w.c. (0-600 mm) 0-40 in. w.c. (0-1000 mm) 0-60 in. w.c. (0-1600 mm) 0-100 in. w.c. (0-2500 mm) 0-160 in. w.c. (0-4000 mm) 0-235 in. w.c. (0-6000 mm) -4-0-6 in. w.c. (-100-0-150 mm) -6-0-10 in. w.c. (-150-0-250 mm) -8-0-16 in. w.c. (-200-0-400 mm) -16-0-24 in. w.c. (-400-0-600 mm) -24-0-40 in. w.c. (-600-0-1000 mm) -30-0-50 in. w.c. (-800-0-1200 mm) -40-0-60 in. w.c. (-1000-0-1500 mm) -60-0-100 in. w.c. (-1500-0-2500 mm) -80-0-160 in. w.c. (-2000-0-4000 mm)
CALL TO ORDER:
27
PRESSURE
Series SGK
The Series SGK Gages have dual English/metric scales with 1% full scale accuracy. Series SGK gages are designed with 304 SS housings and 316L SS wetted parts. Units can withstand ambient temperatures up to 149F (65C) and process temperatures up to 518F (270C). SGK-I models have 8 dial faces while the SGK-J models have large 10 dial faces. A wide selection of ranges are available from full vacuum, compound to 15,000 psi. APPLICATIONS Boiler pressures Pumps Diesel engine power generators
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases and liquids. Wetted Materials: 316L SS. Housing: 304 SS. Lens: Glass. Accuracy: 1% full scale, ANSI B40.1 Grade 1A. Pressure Limit: 130% full scale for ranges <10,000 psi; 115% for 10,000 psi and greater. Temperature Limit: Ambient: -4 to 149F (-20 to 65C); Process: 518F max. (270C max.). Size: 8 (200 mm); 10 (250 mm). Process Connection: 1/2 male NPT. Enclosure Rating: NEMA 3 (IP55). Weight: 8: 3.1 lb (1.42 kg); 10: 4.7 lb (2.12 kg).
Model Number* SGK-I0124N SGK-I0224N SGK-I0324N SGK-I0424N SGK-I0524N SGK-I0624N SGK-I0724N SGK-I0824N
Range 30 Hg-0 (-100-0 kPa) 0-15 psi (0-100 kPa) 0-30 psi (0-200 kPa) 0-60 psi (0-400 kPa) 0-100 psi (0-700 kPa) 0-150 psi (0-1000 kPa) 0-200 psi (0-1400 kPa) 0-300 psi (0-2000 kPa)
Model Number* SGK-I0924N SGK-I1024N SGK-I1124N SGK-I1224N SGK-I1324N SGK-I1424N SGK-I1524N SGK-I1624N
Range 0-400 psi (0-2800 kPa) 0-500 psi (0-3400 kPa) 0-600 psi (0-4000 kPa) 0-1000 psi (0-7000 kPa) 0-1500 psi (0-10 MPa) 0-2000 psi (0-14 MPa) 0-3000 psi (0-20 MPa) 0-4000 psi (0-28 MPa)
Model Number SGK-I1724N SGK-I1824N SGK-I1924N SGK-I2324N SGK-I2424N SGK-I2524N SGK-I2624N SGK-I2724N
Range 0-5000 psi (0-34 MPa) 0-6000 psi (0-40 MPa) 0-10000 psi (0-70 MPa) 30 Hg-0-60 psi (-100-0-400 kPa) 30 Hg-0-100 psi (-100-0-700 kPa) 30 Hg-0-150 psi (-100-0-1000 kPa) 30 Hg-0-200 psi (-100-0-1400 kPa) 30 Hg-0-300 psi (-100-0-2000 kPa)
28
CALL TO ORDER:
Series UGB
PRESSURE
9/16 SQ
The economical Series UGB gages are ideal for air and chilled water usage typically found in refrigeration and HVAC applications. The UGB gages are enclosed in a plastic case that will not corrode or rust and contains brass wetted parts. UGB gages have dual English/metric scales with a 2.5% accuracy. A wide variety of ranges are available from full vacuum, compound to 15,000 psi. APPLICATION Perfect for air, water, refrigeration & HVAC applications
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases & liquids. Wetted Materials: Brass. Housing: Plastic. Lens: Glass. Accuracy: 2.5% between 10 to 90% of span.
Pressure Limits: Full scale range. Temperature Limits: Ambient: -4 to 140F (-20 to 60C); Process: Maximum 248F (120C). Size: 4 (100 mm). Process Connection: 1/4 male NPT. Weight: 9.6 oz (272 g).
Model Number UGB-F0122N UGB-F0222N UGB-F0322N UGB-F0422N UGB-F0522N UGB-F0622N UGB-F0722N UGB-F0822N UGB-F0922N UGB-F1022N UGB-F1122N UGB-F1222N UGB-F1322N
Range 30 Hg-0 (-100-0 kPa) 0-15 psi (0-100 kPa) 0-30 psi (0-200 kPa) 0-60 psi (0-400 kPa) 0-100 psi (0-700 kPa) 0-150 psi (0-1000 kPa) 0-200 psi (0-1400 kPa) 0-300 psi (0-2000 kPa) 0-400 psi (0-2800 kPa) 0-500 psi (0-3400 kPa) 0-600 psi (0-4000 kPa) 0-1000 psi (0-7000 kPa) 0-1500 psi (0-10 MPa)
Model Number UGB-F1422N UGB-F1522N UGB-F1622N UGB-F1722N UGB-F1822N UGB-F2122N UGB-F2222N UGB-F2322N UGB-F2422N UGB-F2522N UGB-F2622N UGB-F2722N
Range 0-2000 psi (0-14 MPa) 0-3000 psi (0-20 MPa) 0-4000 psi (0-28 MPa) 0-5000 psi (0-34 MPa) 0-6000 psi (0-40 MPa) 30 Hg-0-15 psi (-100-0-100 kPa) 30 Hg-0-30 psi (-100-0-200 kPa) 30 Hg-0-60 psi (-100-0-400 kPa) 30 Hg-0-100 psi (-100-0-700 kPa) 30 Hg-0-150 psi (-100-0-1000 kPa) 30 Hg-0-200 psi (-100-0-1400 kPa) 30 Hg-0-300 psi (-100-0-2000 kPa)
Series 35W
Sprinkler Gage
UL and FM Approved for Fire Protection Systems
1-7/32 [30.94] 3-43/64 [93.22]
7/8 [22.23]
35W1005PH02LXUL100
35W1005PH02LXUL300
35W1005PH02LXUL100
1/4-18 NPT
Series 35W Fire Protection, Sprinkler Service Gage is Underwriters Laboratory listed and Factory Mutual approved for fire protection sprinkler service. This gage features a corrosion-resistant ABS case and heat-resistant polycarbonate push-in window. In addition, it also features a movement that is designed to provide shock and vibration resistance that results in superior performance and extended gauge life. The 0-300 psi pressure range is used on wet systems where water is available to the sprinkler heads. The 0-80 retard to 250 psi pressure range is used on dry systems where the lines are filled with air pressure until system activation. Model Number 35W1005PH02LXUL100 35W1005PH02LXUL300 CALL TO ORDER: ASME B 40.1 Grade B (3-2-3% of span) Range 80 psi 300 psi U.S. Phone 219 879-8000
SPECIFICATIONS Service: The 0-300 psi pressure range is used on wet systems where water is available to the sprinkler heads. The 0-80 retard to 250 psi pressure range is used on dry systems where the lines are filled with air pressure until system activation. Wetted Material: Brass socket and C shaped bronze Bourdon tube. Housing: Black-painted ABS case with clear polycarbonate window.
Accuracy: ASME B 40.1 Grade B (3-2-3% of span). Pressure Limit: Max pressure for 0/300 psi: 300 psi. Max pressure for 80 psi: 80 psi with overload protection to 250 psi. Temperature Limit: -40 to 150F (-40 to 65.5C). Size: 3-1/2 Dial face. Process Connections: 1/4 NPT male. Weight: 6.8 oz (192.78 g). Agency Approval: UL, FM.
29
PRESSURE
Series DH3
1-1/4 (31.75)
1-9/32 (32.54)
1/8 FEMALE NPT LOW PRESSURE CONNECTION 1/8 FEMALE NPT LOW PRESSURE CONNECTION (3) 3/16 (4.77) HOLES EQUALLY SPACED ON A 4-1/8 (104.78) B.C. SURFACE MOUNTING
11/16 (17.46)
The Series DH3 Digihelic Differential Pressure Controller is a 3 in 1 instrument possessing a digital display gage, control relay switches, and a transmitter with current output all packed in the popular Photohelic gage style housing. Combining these 3 features allows the reduction of several instruments with one product, saving inventory, installation time and money. The Digihelic controller is the ideal instrument for pressure, velocity and flow applications, achieving a 1% full scale accuracy on ranges down to the extremely low 0.25 w.c. to 2.5 w.c. full scale. Ranges of 5 w.c. and greater maintain 0.5% F.S. accuracy. Bi-directional ranges are also available. The Series DH3 Digihelic controller allows the selection of pressure, velocity or volumetric flow operation in several commonly used engineering units. 2 SPDT control relays with adjustable deadbands are provided along with a scalable 4-20 mA process output. Programming is easy using the menu key to access 5 simplified menus which provide access to: security level; selection of pressure, velocity or flow operation; selection of engineering units; K-factor for use with flow sensors; rectangular or circular duct for inputting area in flow applications; set point control or set point and alarm operation; alarm operation as a high, low or high/low alarm; automatic or manual alarm reset; alarm delay; view peak and valley process reading; digital damping for smoothing erratic process applications; scaling the 4-20 mA process output to fit your applications range and field calibration. See applications below for some popular uses. APPLICATIONS SCFM flow in ducts Filter status Static pressures in ducts or buildings Damper control Fan control
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Housing Material: Die cast aluminum case and bezel. Accuracy: < 5 w.c. (except 2.5 w.c.) : 1%; All other ranges: 0.5% at 77F (25C) including hysteresis and repeatability (after 1 hour warm-up). Stability: < 1% per year. Pressure Limits: Ranges 2.5 w.c.: 25 psi; 2.5, 5 w.c.: 5 psi; 10 w.c.: 5 psi; 25 w.c.: 5 psi; 50 w.c.: 5 psi; 100 w.c.: 9 psi. Temperature Limits: 32 to 140F (0 to 60C). Compensated Temperature Limits: 32 to 140F (0 to 60C). Thermal Effects: 0.020%/F (0.036/C) from 77F (25C). Power Requirements: 12-24 VAC/VDC. Power Consumption: 3 VA max. Output Signal: 4-20 mA DC into 900 ohms max. Zero & Span Adjustments: Accessible via menus.
Response Time: 250 ms (damping set to 1). Display: Backlit 4 digit LCD 0.4 height LED indicators for set point and alarm status. Electrical Connections: 15 pin male high density D-Sub connection. 18 (46 cm) cable with 10 conductors included. Process Connections: 1/8 female NPT. Side or back connections. Mounting Orientation: Mount unit in vertical plane. Size: 5 (127 mm) O.D. x 3-1/8 (79.38 mm). Weight: 1.75 lbs. (794 g). Agency Approvals: CE. SWITCH SPECIFICATIONS Switch Type: 2 SPDT relays. Electrical Rating: 1 amp @ 30 VAC/VDC. Set Point Adjustment: Adjustable via keypad on face.
Model DH3-002 DH3-003 DH3-004 DH3-005 DH3-006 DH3-007 DH3-009 DH3-010 DH3-011 DH3-013 DH3-014 DH3-015 DH3-016 DH3-017 DH3-018
Ranges 0-0.25 w.c. 0-0.5 w.c. 0-1 w.c. 0-2.5 w.c. 0-5 w.c. 0-10 w.c. 0-25 w.c. 0-50 w.c. 0-100 w.c. 0.25-0-0.25 w.c. 0.5-0-0.5 w.c. 1-0-1 w.c. 2.5-0-2.5 w.c. 5-0-5 w.c. 10-0-10 w.c.
ACCESSORIES A-298 Flat Aluminum Bracket, for flush mounting. A-370 Mounting Bracket, flush mount bracket. Bracket is then surface mounted. Steel with gray hammertone epoxy finish.
30
CALL TO ORDER:
Series DHII
PRESSURE
4-23/32 [120] 1-45/64 [43.18] 2-23/64 [59.94] 1-5/16 [33] 1-17/32 [38.61] 45/64 [17.78] 1-45/64 [43.18] 4X 3/16 [4.76] CLEARANCE HOLES FOR MOUNTING
3-17/64 [83]
4-1/8 [105]
The Digihelic II Controller just got better with the New Series DHII Differential Pressure Controller. The DHII takes all the fabulous features of the standard Digihelic Pressure Controller and packages them in a robust NEMA 4 (IP66) housing. The Digihelic II Pressure Controller combines the 2 SPDT control relays, 4-20 mA process output and Modbus communications with a large, brightly backlit 4 digit LCD display that can easily be seen from long distances. The electrical wiring has also been enhanced in the DHII with its detachable terminal blocks. The removable terminals allow the installer to easily wire the terminal block outside the housing and then attach to the circuit board, reducing wiring difficulties and installation time in the process. The Digihelic II Differential Pressure Control in the new NEMA 4 (IP66) enclosure enables this product to be the perfect choice when mounting pressure controls outdoors in such applications as rooftop air handlers. This housing also makes it the ideal solution for surface mounting in clean rooms or facilities where water or a cleaning solution is utilized in maintaining plant cleanliness. APPLICATIONS Air handlers Clean rooms
ACCESSORIES 351-9, Mother Node silver RS-232 to RS-485 Converter with DB9F Connector. Includes 120 VAC to 12 VDC adapter MN-1, Mini-Node USB/RS-485 converter A-438, Surface Mounting Brackets Digihelic Links Communications Software
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Housing Material: Aluminum, glass. Accuracy: 0.5% at 77F (25C) including hysteresis and repeatability (after 1 hour warm-up). Stability: < 1% per year. Pressure Limits: Ranges 2.5 in. w.c. = 2 psi 5: 5 psi; 10: 5 psi; 25: 5 psi; 50: 5 psi, 100: 9 psi. Temperature Limits: 32 to 140F (0 to 60C). Compensated Temperature Limits: 32 to 140F (0 to 60C). Thermal Effects: 0.020%/F (0.036/C) from 77F (25C). Power Requirements: High Voltage Power = 100 to 240 VAC, 50 to 400 Hz or 132 to 240 VDC. Low Voltage Power = 24 VDC 20%. Power Consumption: Low Voltage Power = 24 VDC 130 mA max. High Voltage Power = 100 to 240 VAC, 132 to 240 VDC - 7VA max. Output Signal: 4-20 mA DC into 900 ohms max.
Zero & Span Adjustments: Accessible via menus. Response Time: 250 ms (dampening set to 1). Display: 4 digit backlit LCD 0.6 height. LED indicators for set point and alarm status. Electrical Connections: Euro type removable terminal blocks with watertight conduit fittings for 1/2 watertight conduit. Process Connections: 1/8 female NPT. Enclosure Rating: Designed to meet NEMA 4 (IP66). Mounting Orientation: Mount unit in horizontal plane. Size: 4.73 x 4.73 x 3.43 (120 mm x 120 mm x 87.1 mm). Weight: 2 lb 10 oz (1.19 kg). Serial Communications: Modbus RTU, RS485, 9600 Baud. Agency Approvals: CE, UL. SWITCH SPECIFICATIONS Switch Type: 2 SPDT relays. Electrical Rating: 8 Amps at 240 VAC resistive. Set Point Adjustment: Adjustable via keypad on face.
Available Pressure Engineering Units Model No. DHII-002 DHII-004 DHII-006 DHII-007 DHII-008 DHII-009* DHII-010* in. wc .2500 1.000 5.000 10.00 25.00 50.00 100.0 ft. wc mm wc 6.350 25.40 127.0 254.0 635.0 1270 2540 cm wc 0.635 2.540 12.70 25.40 63.50 127.0 254.0 psi in. Hg mm Hg 0.467 1.868 9.342 18.68 46.71 93.42 186.8 mbar 0.623 2.491 12.45 24.91 62.27 124.5 249.1 Pa 62.28 249.1 1245 2491 6227 kPa 0.249 1.245 2.491 6.227 12.45 24.91 hPa 0.623 2.491 12.45 24.91 62.27 124.5 249.1 oz. in2. 0.114 0.578 2.890 5.780 14.45 28.90 57.80
Bi-Directional* Ranges also available: DHII-012 Range: 0.25 - 0 - 0.25 w.c. DHII-014 Range: 1.0 - 0 - 1.0 w.c. DHII-015 Range: 2.5 - 0 - 2.5 w.c. DHII-016 Range: 5 - 0 - 5 w.c. DHII-017 Range: 10 - 0 - 10 w.c. *Velocity and volumetric flow not available on bi-directional range units and models DHII-009 & DHII-010. CALL TO ORDER: U.S. Phone 219 879-8000 U.K. Phone (+44) (0)1494-461707 Asia Pacific Phone 61 2 4272-2055
31
PRESSURE
Series DH
1-3/4 [44.45]
The Series DH Digihelic Differential Pressure Controller is a 3-in-1 instrument possessing a digital display gage, control relay switches, and a transmitter with current output. Combining these three features allows the reduction of several instruments with one product, saving inventory, installation time and money. The Digihelic Controller is the ideal instrument for pressure, velocity and flow applications, achieving a 0.5% full scale accuracy on ranges from 5 to 100 in. w.c. The Digihelic Controller allows the selection of pressure, velocity or volumetric flow operation in several commonly used engineering units. Two SPDT control relays with adjustable dead bands are provided along with a scalable 4-20 mA process output. The Series DH provides extreme flexibility in power usage by allowing 120/220 VAC and also 24 VDC power which is often used in control panels. Programming is easy using the menu key to access five simplified menus which provide access to: security level; selection of pressure, velocity or flow operation; selection of engineering units; K-factor for use with flow sensors; rectangular or circular duct for inputting area in flow applications; set point control or set point and alarm operation; alarm operation as a high, low or high/low alarm; automatic or manual alarm reset; alarm delay; view peak and valley process readings; digital damping for smoothing erratic process applications; scaling the 4-20mA process output to fit your applications range; Modbus communications; and field calibration. With all this packed into one product it is easy to see why the Digihelic Controller is the only instrument you will need for all your pressure applications. APPLICATIONS SCFM flow In ducts Filter status Clean room pressure Fume hood Air Flow Medical room pressures Static pressures in ducts or buildings Damper control Fan control
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Housing Material: ABS plastic, UL approved 94-V-0. Accuracy: 0.5% at 77F (25C) including hysteresis and repeatability. Stability: < 1% per year. Pressure Limits: Ranges 2.5 in. w.c. = 2 psi 5: 5 psi; 10: 5 psi; 25: 5 psi; 50: 5 psi, 100: 9 psi. Temperature Limits: 32 to 140F (0 to 60C). Compensated Temperature Limits: 32 to 140F (0 to 60C). Thermal Effects: 0.020%/F (0.036/C) from 77F (25C). Power Requirements: High Voltage Power = 100 to 240 VAC, 50 to 400 Hz or 132 to 240 VDC. Low Voltage Power = 24 VDC 20%. Power Consumption: Low Voltage Power = 24 VDC - 130 mA max. High Voltage Power = 100 to 240 VAC, 132 to 240 VDC - 7VA max. Output Signal: 4-20 mA DC into 900 ohms max. Zero & Span Adjustments: Accessible via menus. Response Time: 250 ms. Display: 4 digit LCD 0.4 height. LED indicators for set point and alarm status. Electrical Connections: Screw terminals. Process Connections: Compression fitting for use with 1/8 ID X 1/4 OD tubing (3.175 mm ID x 6.35 mm OD). Enclosure Rating: Face designed to meet NEMA 4X (IP66). Mounting Orientation: Mount unit in horizontal plane. Size: 1/8 DIN. Panel Cutout: 1.772 x 3.620 in (45 x 92 mm). Weight: 14.4 oz. (408 g). Serial Communications: Modbus RTU, RS485, 9600 Baud. Agency Approvals: CE, UL. SWITCH SPECIFICATIONS Switch Type: 2 SPDT relays. Electrical Rating: 8 Amps at 240 VAC resistive. Set Point Adjustment: Adjustable via keypad on face.
Modbus is a registered trademark of Schnieder Automation.
32
CALL TO ORDER:
PRESSURE
Set point 2 or alarm output (SPDT). Selectable direct acting control relay with adjustable deadband or high, low or high low alarm. 4-20 mA process output. View process remotely or send signal to PLC. Alleviates purchase of a separate transmitter.
120-240 VAC power supply. Reduce inventory and eliminate lead times with universal power supply. Set point 1 output (SPDT). Direct or reverse acting control relay with adjustable deadband. Durable compression fittings for 1/4 O.D. x 1/8 I.D. plastic tubing. Secures tubing in harsh applications where vibration & temperature fluctuations occur. RS-485 serial communications View, record, and adjust control settings remotely from a computer with Modbus protocol. Remote reset switch for alarm. Acknowledge alarm from remote location. For users that need quick alarm reset from a distance.
24 VDC power supply. Universal power supply eliminates options, inventory and ordering mistakes.
Available Pressure Engineering Units Model No. DH-002 DH-004 DH-006 DH-007 DH-008 DH-009* DH-010* in. wc .2500 1.000 5.000 10.00 25.00 50.00 100.0 ft. wc mm wc 6.350 25.40 127.0 254.0 635.0 1270 2540 cm wc 0.635 2.540 12.70 25.4 63.50 127.0 254.0 psi in. Hg mm Hg 0.467 1.868 9.342 18.68 46.71 93.42 186.8 mbar 0.623 2.491 12.45 24.91 62.27 124.5 249.1 Pa 62.28 249.1 1245 2491 6227 kPa 0.249 1.245 2.491 6.227 12.45 24.91 hPa 0.623 2.491 12.45 24.91 62.27 124.5 249.1 oz./in.2 0.144 0.578 2.890 5.780 14.45 28.90 57.80
Bi-Directional* Ranges also available: DH-012 Range: 0.25 - 0 - 0.25 w.c. DH-014 Range: 1.0 - 0 - 1.0 w.c. DH-015 Range: 2.5 - 0 - 2.5 w.c. DH-016 Range: 5 - 0 - 5 w.c. DH-017 Range: 10 - 0 - 10 w.c. *Velocity and volumetric flow not available on bi-directional range units and models DH-009 & DH-010. ACCESSORIES The Mother Node and Mini-Node converters are an easy solution for utilizing the Digihelic Controllers RS-485 serial communication and connecting to virtually any PC. MN-1, Mini-Node USB/RS-485 converter 351-9, Mother Node silver RS-232 to RS-485 Converter with DB9F Connector. Includes 120 VAC to 12 VDC adapter A-266, Digihelic surface mounting bracket A-203, 1/8 I.D. x 1/4 O.D. PVC tubing Digihelic Links, Communication Software CALL TO ORDER: U.S. Phone 219 879-8000 U.K. Phone (+44) (0)1494-461707 Asia Pacific Phone 61 2 4272-2055
33
PRESSURE
Series A3000
1-1/4 [31.75]
4-47/64 [120.25] 5 [127.00] 4 [101.60] FACE 5-1/2 [139.70] O.D. MOUNTING RING
Photohelic Switch/Gages function as versatile, highly repeatable pressure switches combined with a precise pressure gage employing the time-proven Magnehelic gage design. The Photohelic gage measures and controls positive, negative or differential pressures of air and compatible gases. Standard models are rated to 25 psig (1.7 bar) with options to 35 (2.4) or 80 (5.5 bar) psig. Single pressure 36000S models measure to 6000 psig (413 bar) with a 9000 psig (620 bar) rating. Two phototransistor actuated, DPDT relays are included for low/high limit control. Easy to adjust setpoint indicators are controlled by knobs located on the gage face. Individual setpoint deadband is one pointer width less than 1% of full scale. Setpoints can be interlocked to provide variable deadband ideal for control of fans, dampers, etc. Gage reading is continuous and unaffected by switch operation, even during loss of electrical power. Choose from full scale pressure ranges from a low 0-.25" (0-6 mm) w.c. up to 30 psi (21 bar); single positive pressure to 6000 psig (413 bar). APPLICATIONS Air Conditioner Systems Clean Rooms Fume Exhaust Systems
SPECIFICATIONS GAGE SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Accuracy: 2% of full scale at 70F (21.1C). 3% on -0 and 4% on -00 models. Pressure Limits: -20" Hg. to 25 psig (-0.677 to 1.72 bar). MP option; 35 psig (2.41 bar), HP option; 80 psig (5.52 bar). 36003S 36010S; 150 psig (10.34 bar). 36020S and higher;1.2 x full scale pressure. Temperature Limits: 20 to 120F. (-6.67 to 48.9C) Low temperature option available. Process Connections: 1/8 female NPT. Size: 4 (101.6 mm) dial face, 5 (127 mm) O.D. x 8-1/4 (209.55 mm). Weight: 4 lb (1.81 kg).
SWITCH SPECIFICATIONS Switch Type: Each setpoint has 2 Form C relays (DPDT). Repeatability: 1% of full scale. Electrical Rating: 10A @ 28 VDC, 10A @ 120, 240 VAC. Electrical Connections: Screw terminals. Use 167F (75C) copper conductors only. Power Requirements: 120 VAC, 50/60 Hz; 240 VAC & 24 VAC Power optional. Mounting Orientation: Diaphragm in vertical position. Consult factory for other position orientations. Set Point Adjustment: Adjustable knobs on face. Agency Approvals: UL, CSA, CE.
Model Number A3000-00 A3000-0 A3001 A3002 A3003 A3004 A3005 A3006 A3008 A3010 A3015 A3020 A3025 A3030 A3040 A3050 A3060 A3080 A3100 A3150
Range, In W.C. 0-.25 0-.50 0-1.0 0-2.0 0-3.0 0-4.0 0-5.0 0-6.0 0-8.0 0-10 0-15 0-20 0-25 0-30 0-40 0-50 0-60 0-80 0-100 0-150
Model Number A3201 A3202 A3203 A3204 A3205 A3210** A3215** A3220** A3230***
Range, PSI 0-1 0-2 0-3 0-4 0-5 0-10 0-15 0-20 0-30
Model Number A3000-6MM A3000-10MM A3000-25MM A3000-50MM A3000-80MM A3000-100MM A3300-20MM A3300-30MM Model Number A3000-15CM A3000 20CM A3000-25CM A3000-50CM A3000-80CM A3000-100CM A3000-150CM A3000-200CM A3000-250CM A3000-300CM
Range, MM W.C. 0-6 0-10 0-25 0-50 0-80 0-100 10-0-10 15-0-15 Range, CM W.C. 0-15 0-20 0-25 0-50 0-80 0-100 0-150 0-200 0-250 0-300 2-0-2 5-0-5 15-0-15
Zero Center Ranges A3300-250PA A3300-500PA Model Number 125-0-125 250-0-250 Range, Kilopascals
Photohelic Single Pressure 0-30 A36003S 0-60 A36006S 0-100 A36010S 0-200 A36020S 0 300 A36030S 0-600 A36060S 0-1000 A36100S 0-3000 A36300S 0-5000 A36500S
Zero Center Ranges Zero Center Ranges A3300-0 A3301 A3302 A3304 A3310 A3320 A3330 .25-0-.25 .5-0-.5 1-0-1 2-0-2 5-0-5 10-0-10 15-0-15 Range In W.C./ Air Velocity, F.P.M. 0-.25/300-2000 0-.50/500-2800 0-1.0/500-4000 0-2.0/1000-5600 0-10/2000-12500 A3300-4CM A3300-10CM A3300-30CM
0-1 A3000-1kPA 0-1.5 A3000-1.5kPA 0-2 A3000-2kPA 0-3 A3000-3kPA 0-4 A3000-4kPA 0-5 A3000-5kPA 0-8 A3000-8kPA 0-10 A3000-10kPA 0-15 A3000-15kPA 0-20 A3000-20kPA 0-25 A3000-25kPA 0-30 A3000-30kPA Zero Center Ranges .5-0- .5 A3300-1kPA 1.5-0-1.5 A3300-3kPA
Options and Accessories Add options as a suffix. Example: A3001-LT -SRH, Single Relay Activates on Increase -MP, Medium pressure -SRL, Single Relay Activates on Decrease -HP, High pressure -OLS, OEM model -LT, Low temperature (-20F) -RMR, Remote mounted relay A-298 Flat Flush Mounting Bracket -TAMP, Tamper proof knobs A-601, Manual reset switch
34
CALL TO ORDER:
Photohelic Switch/Gages
Combines Differential Pressure Gage with Low/High Set-points
1/8 FEMALE NPT HIGH PRESSURE CONNECTION 1/8 FEMALE NPT HIGH PRESSURE CONNECTION 2-1/61 [52.39] 2 [50.80] (4) 6-32 HOLES EQUALLY SPACED ON A 5-1/8 [130.18] B.C.
INCHES OF WATER
PRESSURE
1-1/4 [31.75]
.2O O
.4O
.60
.80 1.0
5/8 [15.88] 5/8 [15.88] PANEL MAX 2-1/2 [63.50] 3/16 [4.76]
Using solid state technology, the Series 3000MR and 3000MRS Photohelic switch/gages combine the functions of a precise, highly repeatable differential pressure switch with a large easy-to-read analog pressure gage employing the durable, time-proven Magnehelic gage design. Switch setting is easy to adjust with large external knobs on the gage face. Gage reading is unaffected by switch operation will indicate accurately even if power is interrupted. Solid state design now results in greatly reduced size and weight. Units can be flush mounted in 4-13/16 (122 mm) hole or surface mounted with hardware supplied. 3000MR models employ versatile electromechanical relays with gold over silver contacts ideal for dry circuits. For applications requiring high cycle rates, choose 3000MRS models with SPST (N.O.) solid state relays. All models provide both low and high limit control and include 18-inch (45 cm) cable assemblies for electrical connections. Gage accuracy is 2% of full scale and switch repeatability is 1%. Switch deadband is one pointer width less than 1% of full scale. Compatible with air and other non-combustible, non-corrosive gases, they can be used in systems with pressures to 25 psig (1.725 bar). Optional construction is available for use to either 35 psig (2.42 bar) or 80 psig (5.51 bar). APPLICATIONS Fan control Damper control Environmental pollution control
Included Accessories Mounting ring, snap ring 18 (45 cm) cable assembly (2) 3/16 tubing to 1/8 NPT adapters (2) 1/8 NPT pipe plugs
SPECIFICATIONS
GAGE SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Accuracy: 2% of full scale (3000-0 3% of full scale). (300000 4% of full scale). Pressure Limit: -20 Hg. to 25 psig (-0.677 bar to 1.72 bar). MP option; 35 psig (2.41 bar), HP option; 80 psig (5.52 bar). Temperature Limits: 20 to 120F. (-6.67 to 48.9C). Process Connections: 1/8 female NPT (duplicated side and back). Size: 4 (101.6 mm) dial face, 5 (127 mm) O.D. x 3-1/8 (79.38 mm). Weight: 1.8 Ib (816 g). SWITCH SPECIFICATIONS 3000MR Switch Type: Each setpoint has 1 Form C relays (SPDT). Relay Contacts: (resistive load) 1 Form C rated 1.0A @ 30 VDC, 0.3A @ 110 VDC or 0.5A @ 125 VAC. Gold over clad silver - suitable for dry circuits. Electrical Connections: 18 (46 cm) cable assembly with 8 conductors. Optional lengths to 100
(30.5 m). Power Requirements: 24 VDC, regulated 10%. Mounting Orientation: Diaphragm in vertical position. Consult factory for other position orientations. Set Point Adjustment: Adjustable knobs on face. Agency Approvals: CE. SWITCH SPECIFICATIONS 3000MRS Switch Type: Each setpoint has a solid state relay. Switching Voltage: 20-280 VAC (47 - 63 Hz). Switching Current: 1.0 amp (AC) max., 0.01 mA (AC) min., (2) SPST N.O. Electrical Connections: 18 (46 cm) cable assembly with 6 conductors, Optional lengths to 100 (30.5 m). Power Requirements: 24 VDC, regulated 10%. Mounting Orientation: Diaphragm in vertical position. Consult factory for other position orientations. Set Point Adjustment: Adjustable knobs on face. Agency Approvals: CE.
(4) 6-32 x 1-1/4 RH machine screws (panel mounting) (3) 6-32 x 5/16 RH machine screws (surface mounting)
OPTIONS ACCESSORIES
Tamper-proof Knobs, require spanner type key (supplied) to change setpoints. Add suffix -TAMP Low Temperature Option for use under 20F (-6.7C). Add suffix -LT Medium Pressure increases maximum rated pressure to 35 psig (2.41 bar). Add suffix -MP High Pressure increases maximum rated pressure to 80 psig (5.5 bar). Add suffix -HP A-298 Flat Aluminum Bracket, for flush mounting 3000MR/MRS A-370 Mounting Bracket, flush mount 3000MR/MRS bracket. Bracket is then surface mounted.Steel with gray hammertone epoxy finish A-600 R/C Snubber: Recommended for inductive loads like a solenoid or contactor
When ordering, select either MR or MRS suffix to Series 3000 number. Examples: 3001MR or 3001MRS
CALL TO ORDER:
35
PRESSURE
Series ADPS
H.V.A.C.Differential Pressure Switch With Dual Scale Field Adjustable Set Point Knob
2-17/64 [57.5] 11/64 [4.5] 21/64 [8.5] 7/8 [22] 2-9/16 [65] 1-31/32 [50]
2-21/64 [59]
19/64 [7.5]
15/64 [6]
The Series ADPS Adjustable Differential Pressure Switch is designed for pressure, vacuum, and differential pressures. The dual scaled adjustment knob in inches water column and pascals allows changes to the switching pressure to be made without a pressure gage. The ADPS is available with settings from 0.08 w.c. (20 Pa) up to 16 w.c. (4000 Pa). The silicone diaphragm and PA 6.6 body make the series ADPS ideal for use with air and other noncombustible gases. The compact size, adjustment knob and low cost make the ADPS the perfect choice for H.V.A.C. applications. Typical Applications Include: Monitoring air filters and ventilators. Monitoring industrial cooling-air circuits. Overheating protection for fan heaters. Monitoring flows in ventilation ducts. Controlling air and fire-protection dampers. Frost protection for heat exchanges.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and noncombustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Diaphragm Material: Silicone. Housing Material: switch body: PA 6.6; Cover: Polystyrene. Temperature Limits: Process ambient temperature from -4 to 185F (-20 to 85C). Pressure Limits: Max. Operating Pressure: 40 W.C. (10 kPa) for all pressure ranges. Switch Type: Single-pole double-throw (SPDT). Electrical Rating: Standard: Max., 1.5A/250 VAC, max. switching rate: 6 cycles/min.; Gold Contact Option: 0.4 A/ 250 VAC. Electrical Connections: Push-on screw terminals. M20x1.5 with cable strain relief or optional 1/2 NPT connection. Process Connections: 5/16 (7.94 mm) outside diameter tubing, 1/4 (6.0 mm) inside diameter tubing. Mounting Orientation: Vertically, with pressure connections pointing downwards. Mechanical Working Life: Over 106 switching operations. Weight: 5.6 oz (160 g). Enclosure Rating: NEMA 13, IP54. Agency Approvals: CE.
Model No.
Set Point Range IN W.C. (Pa) 0.08 0.12 0.20 0.80 2.00 4.00 to to to to to to 0.80 (20-200) 1.60 (30-400) 2.00 (50-500) 4.00 (200-1000) 10.00 (500-2500) 16.00 (1000-4000)
Approx. Dead Band @ Min Set Point IN W.C. (Pa) 0.04 (10) 0.06 (15) 0.08 (20) 0.4 (100) 0.6 (150) 1.0 (250)
Approx. Dead Band @ Max Set Point IN W.C. (Pa) 0.05 (12) 0.09 (22) 0.09 (23) 0.5 (130) 0.8 (200) 1.4 (350)
ACCESSORIES A-288, L type metal mounting bracket with screws A-289, S type metal mounting bracket with screws
36
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 1900
CompactLowDifferentialPressureSwitches
Set Points from 0.07" to 20" W.C. Repetitive Accuracy within 3%
1/8 FEMALE NPT HIGH PRESS. CONNECTION 3 [76.20] 1-5/16 3-1/2 [33.32] [88.90] TYP 60 TYP (2) 3/16 [4.76] MOUNTING HOLES ON A 4-3/16 [106.36] B.C. 1/8 FEMALE NPT LOW PRESSURE CONNECTION 1-7/8 [47.63] 2-9/32 [57.94] 2-7/16 [61.90]
PRESSURE
41/64 [16.27]
Series 1910 pressure switch. All pressure and electrical connections and set point adjustments are on one side for easy installation.
Series 1910 switch with conduit enclosure off. Shows electric switch and set point adjustment screw.
7/8 [22.23] CONDUIT CONNECTION 1-3/4 [44.45] CLEARANCE FOR COVER REMOVAL
51/64 [20.24]
The Dwyer-engineered force-motion amplifier increases the leverage of diaphragm movement and results in a switch with excellent sensitivity and repeatability.
Our most popular series combines advanced design and precision construction to make these switches able to perform many of the tasks of larger, costlier units. Designed for air conditioning service, they also serve many fluidics, refrigeration, oven and dryer applications. For air and non combustible compatible gases, Series 1900 switches have set points from 0.07 to 20 (1.8 to 508 mm) w.c. Set point adjustment is easy with range screw located inside conduit enclosure. Internal location helps prevent tampering. UL, CE, CSA listed, and FM approved. APPLICATIONS Air conditioning refrigeration coil icing detection; defrost cycle initiation Clogged filter detection Variable air volume controller SPECIAL MODELS AND ACCESSORIES MANUAL RESET MODEL 1900 MR includes special snap switch which latches on pressure increase above the setpoint. Switch must be manually reset after pressure drops below the setpoint. To order, change base model to 1900 and add MR suffix after range number. Example: 1900-10-MR. Available on -1, -5,-10 or -20 ranges only. Option is not UL, CSA or FM listed Note: Manual Reset (MR) Option for use only in single positive pressure applications. A-399 Duct Pressure Monitor Kit For use with standard or manual reset model switches. Includes mounting flange, tubing and adapters. A-329 Street Ell Brass adapter for applications requiring right angle connections. Two required for differential pressures.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult Factory. Temperature Limits: -30 to 180F (-34 to 82.2C). Pressure Limits: 45 w.c. (11.2 kPa) continuous, 10 psig (68.95 kPa) surge. Switch Type: Single-pole double-throw (SPDT). Repeatability: 3%. Electrical Rating: 15 A @ 120-480 VAC, 60 Hz. Resistive 1/8 HP @125 VAC, 1/4 HP @ 250 VAC, 60 Hz. Derate to 10 A for operation at high cycle rates. Electrical Connections: 3 screw type, common, normally open and normally closed. Process Connections: 1/8 female NPT. Mounting Orientation: Diaphragm in vertical position. Consult factory for other position orientations. Set Point Adjustment: Screw type inside conduit enclosure. Weight: 1lb, 4.5 oz (581 g). Agency Approvals: CE , UL. CSA, and FM. Optional-EXPL Explosion-proof
enclosure does not possess any agency approvals.
CALL TO ORDER:
37
PRESSURE
Series H3
Explosion-proof, heavy duty, industrial unit has a unique new design which provides sensitivity to differential pressures as low as 10 inches of water (254 mm w.c.), yet handles total pressure of 1500 psi (103 bar). Unlike common differential pressure switches that use a piston-type motion transfer, the Series H3 utilizes a rotary motion transfer shaft that prevents a change in total pressure from causing a setpoint shift. Unit yields deadbands approximately 5% of range, with zero setpoint shift due to variation in working pressures. Friction is minimized and repeatability increased by allowing range spring to act directly on diaphragm plate. Rolling diaphragm design maintains constant effective area to further reduce friction. Diaphragm is allowed to seat, allowing application of full rated pressure, up to 1500 psi (103 bar), on either high or low pressure port, without damage. Special overtravel feature prevents overtightening of range adjust screw. Choose optional 316SS chamber for water and water-based fluids or harsher applications. APPLICATIONS Water flow proving with an orifice plate Differential pressure across chiller Liquid filter status Perfect for monitoring differential water pressure on filters, chiller coils, and flow elements.
SPECIFICATIONS Wetted Materials: See pressure chamber and diaphragm material in model chart. Temperature Limit: -4 to 220F (-20 to 104C), ATEX: -20 to 90C (-4 to 194F). Pressure Limit: 1500 psig (103 bar). Enclosure Rating: Standard meets NEMA 4X (IP56), Drain option meets NEMA 3 (IP54). For hazardous use see the Hazardous Location Ratings chart. Switch Type: SPDT or DPDT snap switch. Electrical Rating: 5A @ 125/250 VAC, 30 VDC. Electrical Connections: See model chart. Conduit Connection: 3/4 female NPT. Process Connection: 1/8 female NPT. Mounting Orientation: Vertical. Set Point Adjustment: Internal screw. Weight: 4 lb, 2 oz (2 kg). Deadband: Approximately 5% of range. Agency Approvals: UL, CSA, CE, and ATEX see ratings chart.
H3 _ _ _ C
0344 II 2 G EEx d IIB -20C T amb 75C T6 EC-Type Certificate No. KEMA 03ATEX 2584
H3 S
2 S C
MV
H3 _ _ _ L H3 _ _ _ T
CI. I, Gr.B, C & D CI. I, Gr.B, C & D CI. II, Gr.E, F & G CI. II, Gr.E, F & G 0344 II 2 G EEx d IIB -20C T amb 75C T6 EC-Type Certificate No. KEMA 03ATEX 2584
Construction Pressure Chamber & Diaphragm Material (Wetted) Adjustable Operating Range
H3 A S 1 2 3
H3S-2SC-MV Differential Pressure Control; 316 SS pressure chamber and Fluoroelastomer diaphragm; weatherproof and ATEX; SPDT snap action switch with gold contacts; fixed deadband, automatic reset; adjustable range 0.5-15 psid Series desgnator, weatherproof and explosion-proof Aluminum chamber with Nitrile diaphragm 316 SS chamber with Fluoroelastomer diaphragm
H3 _ _ _ C-DR
Adjustable range 10-180 in. w.c. (2.48-44.78 kPa) Adjustable range 0.5-15 psid (0.03-1 bar) Adjustable range 5-70 psid (.34-4.8 bar) Adjustable range 10-200 psid (.7-13.8 bar) Maximum pressure for all ranges is 1500 psi (103 bar)
Internal terminal blocks for conductors up to 18 gauge are optional. Optional NEMA 3 (lP 54) housing includes explosion-proof drain. Standard NEMA 4X (IP 56) version is without drain. External Ground Connection Standard Internal ground connection also standard use either one.
S D L T C
SPDT snap action switch rated 5A @ 125/250 VAC, 30 VDC DPDT snap action switch rated 5A @ 125/250 VAC, 30 VDC 18 AWG x 18 inch lead wires UL, CSA approved internal terminal block ATEX approved internal terminal block
MV VIT
Gold contacts on snap switch for dry circuits rated 1A @ 125 VAC, 1A resistive or 0.5 A inductive @ 30 VDC Fluoroelastomer diaphragm option where not standard
38
CALL TO ORDER:
Series CXA
PRESSURE
3-3/8 (85.5)
2-17/64 (57.6)
The Series CXA Water Pump Pressure Switches have been proven reliable for controlling automatic water systems. These switches are very popular for use on water pumping systems. The set point and deadband are both easily adjustable via screws inside the cover. For ease of installation, the switches come with a 1/4 female NPT process connection and can be mounted in any orientation. The series CXAs simple design makes it a great switch for an installer at any skill level. APPLICATIONS Pump Control for water systems.
Switch Type NC NC NC NO NO NO
Range psig (bar) 15-80 (1.0-5.5) 30-100 (2.1-6.9) 35-150 (2.4-10.3) 15-80 (1.0-5.5) 30-100 (2.1-6.9) 35-150 (2.4-10.3)
Approx. Adjustable Deadband psig (bar) 15-30 (1.0-2.1) 20-35 (1.4-2.4) 30-40 (2.1-2.8) 15-30 (1.0-2.1) 20-35 (1.4-2.4) 30-40 (2.1-2.8)
Max. Pressure psig (bar) 129 (8.9) 179 (12.3) 204 (14.1) 129 (8.9) 179 (12.3) 204 (14.1)
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible liquids and gases. Wetted Materials: Silicone, steel, and SS. Temperature Limits: 140F (60C). Pressure Limits: See model chart. Enclosure Rating: General purpose. Repeatability: 5 psig (0.3 bar). Switch Type: SPST snap action (see model chart). Electrical Ratings: 20A @ 120 VAC, 12A @ 240 VAC, 9.6A @ 240 VAC (3 phase), 8.6A @ 32 VDC, 3.1A @ 120 VDC, 1.6A @ 240 VDC. Electrical Connections: Screw terminal. Conduit Connection: 7/8 hole for 1/2 conduit hub (2 places). Process Connection: 1/4 female NPT. Mounting Orientation: Switch can be installed in any position. Setpoint Adjustment: Internal screws. Weight: 0.75 lb (0.34 kg). Deadband: See model chart. Agency Approvals: CE, UL pending.
FEATURES Designed for electrically driven water pumps. Suitable for all types of pumps: jets, submersible, reciprocating, etc. Direct acting (NC) or reverse acting (NO) available depending on switch type and model number.
CALL TO ORDER:
39
Series UXF2
FLOW
(M8) U BOLT
CABLE GLAND
5-13/32 [137] EARTH TERMINAL 3-5/16 [84]
Series UXF2 Ultrasonic Flow Converters are paired with Series SX3 detectors in order to utilize the transit-time measuring method. Two ultrasonic sensors are mounted on the pipe exterior, and each transmits an ultrasonic pulse to the opposite sensor. The difference in the transit times of the two waves is used to calculate the flow velocity. This meter is a clamp-on type ultrasonic flowmeter for permanent use and is ideal for clean liquids containing no air bubbles such as pure water. The easyto-use compact and lightweight design is intended for integration into mechanical devices. The adoption of a sound velocity measurement system, which calculates sound velocity from the transit time, keeps the flowmeter unaffected by the temperature and the pressure of the fluid to be measured. Additionally, with the use of a high-speed transit time processor, the system cycle is 0.2 seconds and applicable to short batch processes. Series UXF2 Ultrasonic Flowmeter Converter: Compact and lightweight Easy operation by external keypads Plastic housing with IP65 Communication and Synchronization options available
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Clean liquids that pass ultrasound and do not contain air bubbles (such as pure water and chemical solution). Input: BNC connector, coaxial cable from sensor. Range: 0 to 32.8 fps (0 to 10 m/s). Display: 2-color LED (Normal: green, Abnormal: red), LCD with 2 lines of 16 characters and back light, Languages: English, Japanese, French, German, or Spanish. Accuracy: See SX3. Power Requirement: 100 to 120 VAC 10% 50/60 Hz, or 200 to 240 VAC 10% 50/60 Hz, or 20 to 30 VDC.
Power Consumption: 15 VA or less for AC power supply, 5W or less for DC power supply. Temperature Limits: Ambient 122F (50C). Outputs: Analog: 4 to 20 mA DC, 1 point. Digital: Open Collector: 1 point, Relay contact: 1 point. Serial Communications: RS232C or RS-485. Enclosure Rating: IP65. Materials: Plastic ABS. Electrical Connections: Screw terminals. Mounting: Wall or 2B pipe mount. Weight: 1.8 lb (0.8 kg).
Model Number UXF2-11P1 UXF2-21P1 UXF2-31P1 UXF2-12P1 UXF2-22P1 UXF2-32P1 UXF2-13P1 UXF2-23P1 UXF2-33P1 UXF2-14P1 UXF2-24P1 UXF2-34P1
Power Supply 100 to 120 VAC 200 to 240 VAC 20 to 30 VDC 100 to 120 VAC 200 to 240 VAC 20 to 30 VDC 100 to 120 VAC 200 to 240 VAC 20 to 30 VDC 100 to 120 VAC 200 to 240 VAC 20 to 30 VDC
Communication None None None RS-232 RS-232 RS-232 RS-485 RS-485 RS-485 Sync Sync Sync
APPLICATIONS Monitor flow rate of heating and cooling water. Monitor flow rate as part of BTV calculations.
40
CALL TO ORDER:
Series SX3
1-7/64 [28]
1-11/32 [34]
(1-21/32) [50]
SENSOR
TYPE PIPE SIZE 3/4~3-1/2 SX3-A [25~100] 2~8 SX3-B [50~225] L 8-31/32 [288] 13-45/64 [348] H 1-7/32 [31] 1-3/16 [30] SPACING 53/64~4-47/64 [21~120] 53/64~9-29/64 [21~240] UNITS INCHES [mm] INCHES [mm]
32)
4-31/64 [114]
Series SX3 Ultrasonic Flowmeter Detectors are paired with Series UXF2 converters and employ a clamp-on type design for permanent use based on transit time measuring method. These detectors are ideal for clean liquids containing no air bubbles such as pure water. The easy-to-use compact and lightweight design is intended for integration into mechanical devices. It is applicable for small to medium size pipes of diameter range from 25 mm to 600 mm and provides superior cost performance. Series SX3 Ultrasonic Flowmeter Detectors: Helps ensure pumping efficiency Provides accurate leak detection Not influenced by fluids temperature or pressure
Flow Pipe Size in (mm) 0.98 to 3.94 (25 to 100) 1.97 to 8.86 (50 to 225) 1.97 to 11.81 (50 to 300) 11.81 to 23.62 (300 to 600)
Description Silicone-based grease acoustic couplant, 3 oz tube Silicone RTV acoustic couplant, 4 oz tube Silicone-free acoustic couplant, 4 oz tube
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Clean liquids that pass ultrasound and do not contain air bubbles (such as pure water and chemical solution). Turbidity: 10000 deg (mg/L) or less. Type of Flow: Well-developed turbulent or laminar flow in a fluid-filled pipe. Permissible Air Volume Rate: Up to 2% at 1 m/s (inversely proportional to velocity). Range: 0 to 32.8 fps (0 to 10 m/s). Flow Pipe Sizes: SX3A: 0.98 to 3.94 in (25 to 100 mm) for plastic piping 1.97 to 3.94 in (50 to 100 mm) for metal piping; SX3B: 1.97 to 8.86 in (50 to 225 mm); SX3C: 1.97 to 11.81 in (50 to 300 mm); SX3D: 11.81 to 23.62 in (300 to 600 mm). Accuracy: 1.5 to 2% of rate. Response Time: System cycle: 0.2 s, Dead time: 0.2 s or less, Time constant: 0.1s. Temperature Limits: Ambient -4 to 140F (-20 to 60C). Fluid Temperature: SX3A/SX3B: -4 to 212F (-20 to 100C); SX3C/SX3D w/ silicone rubber for acoustic couplant: -4 to 176F (-20 to 80C), w/ silicone free grease for acoustic couplant: 32 to 140F (0 to 60C). Enclosure Rating: SX3A and SX3B: IP65 (Jetproof) when using waterproof BNC connector. SX3C and SX3D: IP67 (Immersion-proof) when the terminal block is filled with silicone rubber after wiring. Materials: For SX3A and SX3B: Plastic PBT for sensor housing, 304SS for guide frame. For SX3C and SX3D: Plastic PBT for sensor housing, 304SS for sensor cover, 304SS and PBT for guide rail. Electrical Connection: Coaxial cable up to 98.4 ft (30 m) and thermal stability of 212F (100C). Mounting: Clamped on pipe surface. Weight: SX3A: 10.6 oz (0.3 kg), SX3B: 14.1 oz (0.4 kg), SX3C: 2.2 lb (1 kg), SX3D: 14.1 oz (0.4 kg).
with waterproof BNC connector for SX3-A and SX3-B with waterproof BNC connector for SX3-A and SX3-B for SX3-C and SX3-D for SX3-C and SX3-D
Cable Length ft (m) 16.4 (5) 32.8 (10) 16.4 (5) 32.8 (10)
CALL TO ORDER:
41
Series UXF1
FLOW
1/8 [3.2]
3-3/4 [95]
9/16 [14]
1-17/32 [39] 1-37/64 1-37/64 [40] 1-37/64 [40] 1-37/64 [40] [40]
Series UXF1 Ultrasonic Flowmeter Converters are paired with Series SX1 or SX2 sensors in order to utilize the transit-time measuring method. Thanks to microprocessor based electronics, the flowmeter can easily be configured from the front keypad to specific applications. The flowmeter is suitable for liquid flow measurements for pipes from 1/2 inch to 19.5 feet diameter. This flowmeter is a compact and lightweight instrument incorporating the latest electronics and high speed digital signal processing technologies (32 bit MPU), realizing high performance and easy operation. Series UXF1 Ultrasonic Flowmeter Converters: Compact and lightweight High accuracy Excellent resistance against aerated flow Quick response with high-speed microprocessor Multilingual display (English, Japanese, German, and French) Large LCD and function keys APPLICATIONS Monitor flow rate of heating and cooling water. Monitor flow rate as part of BTV calculations. Model No. Description UXF1-A Outdoor Converter UXF1-B Outdoor Converter
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Liquid flow through which ultrasonic signal can be transmitted (water, sea water, oil, and fluid of unknown velocity). Input: Sensor cable radio frequency coaxial cable RG58A/U.2. Range: 0 to 105 fps (0 to 32 m/s) (bidirectional flow). Display: LCD with backlight, 16 letters 2 lines. Accuracy: See SX1. Power Requirement: 100 to 240 VAC 10% 50/60Hz, or 20 to 30 VDC. Power Consumption: Approx. 20 VA. Temperature Limits: Ambient 14 to 140F (-10 to 60C). Outputs: Analog: One 4 to 20 mA DC current output; Digital: Two transistor outputs available, Open collector output: 30V DC, 0.1A. Serial Communications: RS232-C equivalent. Enclosure Rating: IP65. Materials: Aluminum alloy. Electrical Connections: Screw terminals. Mounting: Wall or pipe mount. Weight: 10 lb (4.5 kg).
42
CALL TO ORDER:
Series SX1
3-21/32 [93] DETECTOR WIRE ROPE MOUN 2-7/16 [62] 3-5/32 [80] 2-3/8 [60]
PIPE
Series SX1 Ultrasonic Flowmeter Detectors are paired with Series UXF1 converters in order to utilize the transit-time measuring method. Two ultrasonic sensors are mounted on the pipe exterior, and each transmits an ultrasonic pulse to the opposite sensor. The difference in the transit times of the two waves is used to calculate the flow velocity. Series SX1 Ultrasonic Flowmeter Detector: Easy installation, no pipe work required Simple maintenance, no moving parts Free from pressure loss, choking, and leakage Clamp-on features allow for reduction of total ownership cost
Model Number SX1-A SX1-B SX1-C
Description Standard Detector, Small Sensor Standard Detector, Medium Sensor Standard Detector, Large Sensor
Description 16.4 ft (5 m) cable for SX1 32.8 ft (10 m) cable for SX1 Silicone-based grease acoustic couplant, 3 oz tube Silicone RTV acoustic couplant, 4 oz tube Silicone-free acoustic couplant, 4 oz tube
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Liquid flow through which ultrasonic signal can be transmitted (water, sea water, oil, and fluid of unknown velocity). Turbidity: 10000 deg (mg/L) or less. Type of Flow: Well-developed turbulent or laminar flow in a full-filled pipe. Range: 0 to 32 m/s (bidirectional flow). Flow Pipe Sizes: SX1-A: 1.97 to 15.75 in (50 to 400 mm), SX1-B: 1.97 to 47.24 in (50 to 1200 mm), SX1-C: 7.87 to 236.2 in (200 to 6000 mm). Accuracy: Pipe Size: 0.51 in (13 mm) to under 1.99 in (50 mm) 0.03 m/s for flow rate: under 2 m/s 0.75% to 1.5% of rate for flow rate: 2 m/s to 32 m/s Pipe Size: 1.99 in (50 mm) to under 11.8 in (300 mm) 0.02 m/s for flow rate: under 2 m/s 0.5% to 1.0% of rate for flow rate: 1 m/s to 32 m/s. Pipe Size: 11.8 in (300 mm) up to 19.69 ft (6000 mm) 0.01 m/s for flow rate: under 1 m/s 0.5% to 1.0% of rate for flow rate 1 m/s to 32 m/s. Response Time: 0.5s or less. Temperature Limits: Ambient 176F (80C). Fluid Temperature: -40 to 176F (-40 to 80C) for SX1-A, SX1-B, SX1-C. Enclosure Rating: IP67 Materials: SX1A: Plastic case and 304 Stainless Steel and plastic guide rail; SX1B and SX1C: Plastic case; Silicone rubber couplers on all models. Sensor Cable: Radio frequency coaxial cable (RG-58A/U), see accessories table for specific lengths. Electrical Connection: Screw terminals. Mounting: Clamped on pipe wall. Weight: SX1-A: 2.2 lb (1 kg), SX1-B: 0.88 lb (0.4 kg), SX1-C: 3.1 lb (1.4 kg).
CALL TO ORDER:
43
Series FS-2
FLOW
3-1/32 [77]
5-49/64 [146.5]
5-1/8 [130.2]
The Series FS-2 Vane Flow Switch offers an economical flow proving solution. Custom set points tailored for the application are enabled by field adjustable vane layers and a set point adjustment screw. The FS-2 features an aluminum weatherproof housing for outdoor installation. Paddles are adjustable to fit 1 to 8 size pipe. FS2 is ideal for use in flow or no flow applications in cold and hot water systems. Perfect for proving flow in boilers, hot water heaters, and chillers. APPLICATION Perfect for proving flow in boilers, hot water heaters, and chillers. FEATURES Field adjustable paddle Field adjustable set point Weatherproof construction
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible liquids. Wetted Materials: Bellow: Tin-bronze. Vane: Stainless Steel. Body: Forged brass. Temperature Limit: 230F (110C). Pressure Limit: 145 psig (10 bar). Enclosure Rating: NEMA 4 (IP64). Switch Type: SPDT snap switch. Electrical Rating: 10A res, 3A ind @ 250 VAC. Electrical Connection: Cable gland with attached wire leads or optional conduit connection. Process Connection: 1 male NPT or BSPT. Mounting Orientation: Switch must be installed vertically on horizontal pipe runs. Set Point Adjustment: Four vane combinations and an adjustment screw. Enclosure: Die-cast aluminum alloy. Weight: 28.22 oz (0.8 kg). Agency Approvals: CE.
Series FS-2 Paddle Flow Switch OPTIONS: BSPT Process Connection, To order add suffix -BSPT. Example: FS-2-BSPT Conduit Connection, 1 NPT female conduit connection with no wire leads. To order add suffix -CND. Example: FS-2-CND
44
CALL TO ORDER:
FLOW
7/8 HEX [22.23] 3/16 LOWER BODY [4.76] 2 CON 22 AWG WIRE 1/2 NPT
2-13/16 [71.44]
V10
Designed to provide an inexpensive, reliable unit to monitor the presence or absence of flow in a system. The V10 and V11 flow switches are used to monitor unattended equipment and protect it from costly damage. The V10 flow switch utilizes a rugged, hermetically sealed reed switch which is encapsulated in a polypropylene switch housing that fits into a standard heavy duty leak proof brass body or optional 303 SS body. The switch adjustment allows the user to change the switch to Normally Open (NO) or Normally Closed (NC) in the field merely by loosening two screws. The switch housing is located outside the process media, making switch change-over or maintenance easy without interruption of process flow. The V11 Flotect flow switch takes our very popular V10 design and adds rugged, integral electrical wiring. The one-piece PBT switch housing snaps onto the body and the wiring is epoxy sealed making the switch weatherproof, meeting NEMA 4 standards. The 22 AWG cable used is UV resistant, flame retardant, and comes standard 6 feet in length. This unique design eliminates the need for running conduit between the switch and panel, lowering installation costs. A full size, trimmable stainless steel vane is provided with a removable laminated template. This template is calibrated for brass or ductile iron reducing tees and forged steel straight tee/bushing combinations. Allows for field installation in pipelines from 1/2 to 2 diameter. A table with approximate actuation and deactivation values is provided below. APPLICATION Perfect for proving flow in boilers, hot water heaters, and chillers
Cold Water Flow Rates Approximate actuation/deactuation GPM upper, LPM lower N.C. N.O. Pipe Trim 2.6/2.5 2.6/2.3 1 2 L 9.8/9.5 9.8/8.7
3
V11
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases or liquids. Wetted Materials: Vane: 301 SS. Body: Brass or 303 SS. Pin and Spring: 301 SS, 302 SS, and 316 SS. Magnet: Ceramic 8. Temperature Limit: V10: 200F (93C), V11: 190F (88C) maximum. Pressure Limit: Brass body: 1000 psig (69 bar), 303 SS body: 2000 psig (138 bar). Switch Type: SPST hermetically sealed reed switch. V10: Field adjustable for normally open or normally closed. Electrical Rating: 0.5A @ 30VAC, 1.5A @ 24VDC. Electrical Connections: V10: 22 AWG, 18 (460 mm) long, V11: 22 AWG, 6 (1.83 m) long. Rated 392F (200C). 300V. Flame retardant extruded FEP insulation and overall shield. Conduit Connection: V10: 1/8 male NPT. Process Connection: 1/2 male NPT standard. Contact factory for other options. Mounting Orientation: Switch can be installed in any position but the actuation/deactuation flow rates are based on horizontal pipe runs and are nominal values. Set Point Adjustment: Vane is trimmable. Weight: V10: 4.5 oz (0.13 kg), V11: 5.8 oz (0.165 kg). Agency Approvals: V10: CE, UL and CSA; V11: UL. Switch Enclosure: V10: Polypropylene, V11: Polybutylene terephthalate (PBT).
Air Flow Rates Approximate actuation/deactuation SCFM upper, LPM lower N.C. N.O. Pipe Trim 10.2/9.2 10.3/8.8 1 2 L 291.7/250 288/260
3
J H E C Full
1 114 1 2
1
3.1/2.7 11.7/10.2 4.8/4.5 18.2/17 6.2/5.6 23.5/21.2 8.2/7.7 31/29.1 9.5/9.1 36/34.4
3.1/2.8 11.7/10.6 4.8/4.4 18.2/16.7 6.1/5.6 23.1/21.2 8.2/7.7 31/29.1 9.5/9 36/34.1
J H E C Full
1 114 1 2
1
13/11.6 368.3/328 19.2/17.6 543.3/498 24.8/22.2 701.7/628 33.4/31.2 946.7/883 50.2/48.4 1422/1370
12.9/11.6 365/328 18.9/17.6 535/498 24.5/22.5 693/637 33/30.6 935/867 50.2/47.7 1422/1352
Switch Configuration Normally Open Normally Closed Normally Open Normally Closed Normally Open or Closed Normally Open or Closed
CALL TO ORDER:
45
Series V8
FLOW
1/2 NPTM 3-1/16 [77.79] 12-11/64 [309.17] 1-21/32 [41.31] 1-5/16 OCTAGON [33.34] 1 NPTM
5-1/4 [133.35]
V8
V8 Flotect Flow Switch Protects Equipment: Operation is simple and dependable. In most applications, the switch is normally off while there is sufficient flow of liquid or air. When flow stops, the vane spring moves the vane, actuating a single pole double throw switch rated 5A @ 120/250 VAC to start or stop motor, pump, engine, etc. Operate a damper or valve; shut down a burner or actuate an alarm or signal, protecting unattended equipment from damage or loss of production. The V8 Flotect Flow Switch has a leak proof body and vane constructed of tough durable polyphenylene sulfide which has excellent chemical resistance. The full size trimmable vane is provided with molded-in graduations allowing for installation in a 1 inch through 6 inch pipe. Operating pressures are up to 150 psig (10 bar) and temperatures to 212F (100C). The V8 flow switch can be used in various chemical processes, industrial systems and similar applications where process conditions are compatible with polyphenylene sulfide, ceramic 8 and 316SS. The V8 Flotect flow switch is UL recognized as an industrial motor controller per UL standard 508, suitable for mounting in a protected environment. APPLICATIONS HVAC and building automation systems that incorporate components that located outside of the building and exposed to the building and exposed to the elements are ideal applications Perfect for proving flow in boilers, hot water heaters, and chillers
Cold Water Flow Rates Approximate actuation/deactuation GPM upper, LPM lower Pipe Size 10.8/9.1 1" 40.9/34.6 9.8/8.3 1 1 4" 37.2/31.4 8.6/6.8 112" 32.4/25.7 10.9/8.8 2" 41.2/33.4 12.9/8.9 3" 48.8/33.5 21.1/13.8 4" 79.7/52.2 45/33 6" 170.2/124.7 Air Flow Rates Approximate actuation/deactuation SCFM upper, LPM lower Pipe Size 39/32.6 1" 1105/923 37.5/32.2 1 1 4" 1062/912 33.4/26.7 112" 945/757 43/36.8 2" 1218/1042 52.7/38.9 3" 1493/1100 87.6/63.6 4" 2482/1802 168.6/137.4 6" 4775/3890
V8-WP2
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases or liquids. Wetted Materials: Vane and Body: Polyphenylene Sulfide (PPS). Pin and Spring: 316 SS or Inconel. Magnet: Ceramic 8. Temperature Limit: 212F (100C). Pressure Limit: 150 psig (10.34 bar). Enclosure Rating: General purpose, WP/WP2 option is weatherproof. Switch Type: SPDT snap switch, MV option: SPDT gold contact snap switch. Electrical Rating: 5A @ 125/250 VAC, 5A resistive, 3A inductive @ 30 VDC. MV option: 1A @ 125 VAC, 1A resistive, 0.5A inductive @ 30 VDC. Electrical Connections: 18 AWG, 18 (460 mm) long. Conduit Connection: 1/2 male NPT, 1/2 female NPT on WP and WP2. Process Connection: 1 male NPT. Mounting Orientation: Switch can be installed in any position but the actuation/deactuation flow rates are based on horizontal pipe runs and are nominal values. Set Point Adjustment: Vane is trimmable. Weight: 4.5 oz (0.13 kg). Agency Approvals: CE, UL 508 for US and Canada.
V8 Flow Switch OPTIONS: Gold Plated Contacts, for dry circuits. Rated 1A @ 125 VAC; 1A resistive, 0.5A inductive @ 30 VDC. To order add suffix -MV. Example: V8-MV Inconel Alloy Option. Inconel Alloy replaces standard 316 SS wetted parts. Wetted parts are Inconel Alloy, ceramic 8, and Polyphenylene Sulfide. To order add suffix -INC. Example: V8-INC Weatherproof Enclosure. Optional housing is phenylpolioxide and provides weatherproof protection for electrical wiring. To order add suffix -WP. (Not UL approved) Example: V8-WP Weatherproof Enclosure. Optional housing is aluminum and provides weatherproof protection for electrical wiring. To order add suffix -WP2. (Not UL approved) Example: V8-WP2
46
CALL TO ORDER:
Series FMS
Flow Sensor
For Water and Water Based Liquids/Oil and Oil-Based Liquids
FLOW
brown n/c blue black load VDC
1-11/32 [34]
3-3/16 [80.88]
1/2 [12.7]
1-31/32 [49.8]
21/32 [16.51]
1/2-14 NPT
FMS Series Flow Sensor Automatic scaling and set-point No moving parts Learn function for flow rate Push-button re-scaling if needed Easy to install Series FMS Flow Sensor FMS-1 is for applications requiring RELATIVE measurement and set-point of flow rate. This means that the actual velocity of the flow or the quantitative measurement in GPM is not known and is not important. What is important is that the set-point can be set as a percentage of or relative to the full flow rate. No other flow sensor could do it this simply or effectively. HOW IT OPERATES The model FMS uses a set of flashing LEDs to indicate flow. All 7 of the LEDs will remain lit to show 100% flow rate. The flow OK light will also be lit showing that the established full flow rate is what is flowing in the pipe. When you initially set the flow rate, it will mark that as your 100% mark. If your flow reduces below the 50% mark, you will get an alarm from the sensor. If flow increases beyond the initially established flow rate, the Overflow LED light will come on. It is then the operators decisions as to whether to ignore it if too much flow is not a problem and may actually choose this flow rate to be the new normal flow rate. This can be done by just depressing the set button until all LEDs flash. The FMS has now recalibrated itself to the new flow rate. The flow ok LED will again light and the set-point will automatically be re-set at the 50% of flow point.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Water and water based liquids/oil and oil-based liquids. Wetted Materials: Sensor Head: 303 SS. Low Flow Set Point: Auto set @ 50% / Adjustable via set push button. Set Point Range: 5.0 ft/sec (0-150 cm/sec.) Repeatability: < 0.5%. Hysteresis: 10% of set-point value typical. Medium Temperature Limits: -4 to 176F (-20 to 80C.) Pressure: 450 psi (30 bar). Response Time: 25 seconds (typical). Supply Voltage: 20-30 VDC (short circuit protected). Switching Current: < 200 mA. Power Consumption: 6 W max. Electical Connection: M12 male socket 4pin. Comes with 6.5 ft (2 m) cable with M12 connector and pigtail. Process Connection: 1/2 Male NPT Thread. Enclosure Rating: IP 65 (NEMA 4). Initial Operation: After 15 seconds. Switch Type: PNP N.O. (switch closed with flow), PNP N.C. (switch open with flow). Weight: .55 lb. (.25 kg).
APPLICATIONS Perfect for proving flow in boilers, hot water heaters, and chillers.
FMS-1 Flow Sensor PNP N.O. FMS-2 Flow Sensor PNP N.C.
CALL TO ORDER:
47
Series AVU
AIR VELOCITY
8-55/64 [225.0]
2-1/4 [57.0]
The Series AVU Air Velocity Transmitter is ideal for a wide range of HVAC measurement and control applications, particularly in complete building control and energy management systems. The Series AVU offers 5% accuracy at a surprisingly low cost, with six units covering ranges from 0-785 fpm to 0-3150 fpm, with either 4-20 mA or 010 VDC output. The Series AVU Transmitter operates by measuring the heat loss from one of the two sensing elements in the air stream, then calculating the air velocity. Units are virtually immune to drift due to the design of the sensing element, which makes the transmitter accurate over the whole air velocity range. FEATURES 4-20 mA or 0-10 V Output Versions NEMA 6 (IP67) Enclosure Rating AC or DC Powered (Loop Version DC Only) 5% Accuracy APPLICATIONS Supply and exhaust fan tracking Clean room systems Medical rooms
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Clean air and compatible, non-combustible gases. Accuracy: 5% of full scale. Response Time (90%): 5 sec (typical). Temperature Limits: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Humidity Limit: 0-90% RH, non-condensing. Power Requirements: -A models 24 VDC +10% -15%; -V models 24 VDC or 24 VAC +10% - 15%. Output Signal: -A models 4-20 mA current loop; -V models 0-10 VDC. Loop Resistance: (-A models) 700 ohms. Current Consumption: 60 mA + output current. Max. Start Up Current: 85 mA; 10 V. Output Current Limit: (-V models) >10 mA. Electrical Connections: Screw terminal. Cable gland for 4-8 mm wire (16 gauge wire). Enclosure Rating: NEMA 6 (IP67) except sensing point. Probe Dimensions: 9.45 x .75 (240 x 19 mm). Mounting Orientation: Unit not position sensitive. Probe must be aligned with airflow. Weight: 8.8 oz (250 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
Model AVU-1-A AVU-2-A AVU-3-A AVU-1-V AVU-2-V AVU-3-V Range 0-785 fpm (0-4 m/s) 0-1575 fpm (0-8 m/s) 0-3150 fpm (0-16 m/s) 0-785 fpm (0-4 m/s) 0-1575 fpm (0-8 m/s) 0-3150 fpm (0-16 m/s) Output 4-20 mA 4-20 mA 4-20 mA 0-10 VDC 0-10 VDC 0-10 VDC
48
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 641
DWYER INSTRUMENTS, INC. 102 INDIANA HWY 212 MICHIGAN CITY, IN 46360
4-29/64 [113.11]
1/2-14 NPT
1/2-14 NPT
4-29/64 [113.11]
1/2 NPT
641 AVT WITH DISPLAY OPTION A DIMENSION B DIMENSION 7-63/64 9-13/16 [202.80] [249.24] 13/16 13-63/64 15-13/16 [20.64] [355.20] [401.64] 19-63/64 21-13/16 [507.60] [554.04] 26-63/64 28-13/16 [685.40] [731.84] 32-63/64 34-13/16 [837.80] [884.24] 37-63/64 39-13/16 [964.80] [1011.24] 641 AVT WITHOUT DISPLAY OPTION A DIMENSION B DIMENSION 7-7/16 9-9/32 25/32 [188.91] [235.74] 13-7/16 15-9/32 [19.84] [341.31] [388.14] 19-7/16 21-9/32 [493.71] [540.54] 26-7/16 26-9/32 [671.51] [718.34] 29-7/16 34-9/32 [747.71] [870.74] 37-7/16 39-9/32 [950.91] [997.74]
AIR VELOCITY
The new Series 641 Air Velocity Transmitter is the ideal instrument for monitoring air flow. This transmitter uses a heated mass flow sensor which allows for precise velocity measurements at various flow rates and temperatures. The 641s 16 field selectable ranges provides it the versatility to be selected for several air flow applications. The optional LED produces a complete, lowcost solution for local indication of air flow. FEATURES Ranges to 15,000 FPM or 75 MPS Optional Bright LED Display Easy Push Button Set-up Compact Housing 4-20 mA Output Digital Filter for Signal Damping APPLICATIONS Clean room fresh air supply HVAC air velocity measurements Fan supply and exhaust tracking Ensure proper lab hood exhaust flow rates
Model Number 641-6 641-6-LED 641-12 641-12-LED 641-18 641-18-LED 641-24 641-24-LED 641-30 641-30-LED 641-36 641-36-LED
Probe Length* 6 (152.4 mm) 6 (152.4 mm) 12 (304.8 mm) 12 (304.8 mm) 18 (457.2 mm) 18 (457.2 mm) 24 (609.6 mm) 24 (609.6 mm) 30 (762 mm) 30 (762 mm) 36 (914 mm) 36 (914 mm)
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Clean air and compatible, non-combustible gases. Accuracy: 3% FS Process gas: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). 4% FS Process gas: -40 to 32F & 122 to 212F (-40 to 0C & 50 to 100C). Response Time: Flow: 1.5 seconds to 95% of final value (Output filter set to minimum). Temperature Limits: Process: -40 to 212F (-40 to 100C). Ambient: 32 to 140F (0 to 60C). Pressure Limit: 100 psi (6.89 bar) maximum. Humidity Limit: Non-Condensing. Power Requirements: 1235 VDC, 1016 VAC. 1.5A rating required on supply due to initial power surge drawn by transmitter. Output Signal: 4-20 mA, isolated 24V source, 3 or 4-wire connection. Output Filter: Selectable 0.5 15 (seconds). Loop Resistance: 600 ohms max. Current Consumption: 300 mA max. Electrical Connections: Screw terminal. Process Connections: 1/2 male NPT. Enclosure Rating: Designed to meet NEMA 4X (IP66) for non LED models only. Mounting Orientation: Unit not position sensitive. Probe must be aligned with airflow. Weight: 12.6 oz (357.2 g). Agency Approval: CE. OPTIONAL DISPLAY VERSION: Display: 4-1/2 digit 1/2 red LED. Resolution: 1 FPM, 0.01 MPS (10 FPM @ 10,000 and 15,000 FPM ranges). Weight: 13.3 oz (377 g). ACCESSORIES A-156 Universal Mounting Plate 1/2 female NPT A-158 Split Flange Mounting Kit A-159 Duct Mounting Gland
DWYER INSTRUMENTS, INC. 102 INDIANA HWY 212 MICHIGAN CITY, IN 46360
CALL TO ORDER:
49
Series 641RM
AIR VELOCITY
1-39/64 [40.88]
1-25/32 [45.24]
31/64 [12.30]
The Series 641RM is the ideal instrument for monitoring air flow. This transmitter uses a heated mass flow sensor, which allows for precise velocity measurements at various flow rates and temperatures. The 641RMs 16 field selectable ranges from 0-250 to 15,000 FPM (0-1.25 to 75 MPS) provide it the versatility to be selected for a multitude of applications. The units 6 cable which connects the sensing probe with the electronic enclosure allows the enclosure to be mounted where it can be more easily accessed. Longer cable lengths are available for ducts that are at very high elevations from the plant floor. The optional LED produces a complete, compact solution for local indication of air flow. APPLICATIONS Clean room fresh air supply HVAC air velocity measurements Fan supply and exhaust tracking Ensure proper lab hood exhaust flow rates Model 641RM-12, Air Velocity Transmitter with 6 cable Model 641RM-12-LED, same as above with LED display
ACCESSORIES A-156 Universal Mounting Plate, 1/2 female NPT A-158 Split Flange Mounting Kit A-159 Duct Mounting Gland
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Clean air and compatible, non-combustible gases. Accuracy: 3% FS Process gas: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). 4% FS Process gas: -40 to 32F & 122 to 212F (-40 to 0C & 50 to 100C). Response Time: Flow: 1.5 seconds to 95% of final value (output filter set to minimum). Temperature Limits: Process: -40 to 212F (-40 to 100C). Ambient: 32 to 140F (0 to 60C). Pressure Limit: 100 psi (6.89 bar) maximum. Humidity Limit: Non-Condensing. Power Requirements: 1235 VDC, 1016 VAC. 1.5A rating required on supply due to initial power surge drawn by transmitter. Output Signal: 4-20 mA, isolated 24V source, 3 or 4-wire connection. Output Filter: Selectable 0.515 (seconds). Loop Resistance: 600 ohms max. Current Consumption: 300 mA max. Electrical Connections: Screw terminal. Mounting Orientation: Unit not position sensitive. Probe must be aligned with airflow. Weight: 13.2 oz (374.26 g). Cable Length: 6 ft (1.82 m). Probe Length: 12 (30.48 cm) standard. Probe Diameter: 5/16 (0.79 cm). OPTIONAL DISPLAY VERSION: Display: 4-1/2 digit 1/2 red LED. Resolution: 1 FPM, 0.01 MPS (10 FPM @ 10,000 and 15,000 FPM ranges). Weight: 13.9 oz (394.16 g).
50
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 160
StainlessDifferential Pitot Tubes & Transmitters Steel Pressure Gages, Switches Use with Dwyer
1/2 (12.70) TOTAL PRESSURE CONNECTION 1/4 (6.35) 1/4 (6.35) 13/16 (20.62) INSERTION LENGTH 1/2 (12.70) SQ 2-5/8 (66.68) 5 (127.00) (8) .040 (1.02) STATIC PRESSURE HOLES EQUALLY SPACED 5/16 (7.94)
AIR VELOCITY
160 Series
1 [25.40]
5 [127.00]
3/4 [19.05] FOR 96 OR 120 1 [25.4] FOR 168 OR 216 3-5/8 [92.08]
1/4 [6.350]
2-1/2 [63.5]
STATIC PRESSURE (8) .040 [1.02] HOLES EQUALLY SPACED TOTAL PRESSURE 1/8 [3.18] HOLE
No calibration needed. Precisely located, burr-free static pressure holes. Hemispherical tip design, best for accuracy if imperfectly aligned and nearly impossible to damage. Long lasting 304 SS construction. Silver soldered connections for leak-proof operation. Coefficient of 1. 5/16 models rated to 1500F. Extended static connection helps guide tip within recommended 15 of air flow direction. Inch graduations on sides of 160 series to quickly determine exact insertion depth. Dwyer Air Velocity Calculator, direct reading flow charts and instructions included. Use 1/8 models in ducts as small as 4, 5/16 models in ducts 10 or larger. Optional mounting gland or split flange make permanent installation fast and simple. Series 160 is designed to meet: ASME Fluid Meters 6th Ed. ANSI/AMCA 210-99 ANSI/ASHRAE 51-1999 British Standard 1042 APPLICATIONS Monitor or control static or differential pressure when combined with differential pressure gage, switch or transmitter.
36-5/8 [930.28]
3 [76.20]
5 [127.00]
2-1/2 [53.5]
TOTAL PRESSURE CONNECTION 6 [152.4] 3/4 SCHEDULE 40 PIPE 1/4 COMPRESSION 5/16 SUPPLIED BY CUSTOMER FITTING [7.94] 3/4-12 REDUCING COUPLING SUPPLIED BY CUSTOMER NOTE: STATIC PRESSURE CUSTOMER MUST SUPPLY 1/4 TUBING IN APPROPRIATE (8) .040 [1.02] HOLES EQUALLY SPACED LENGTHS TO THE STATIC AND TOTAL PRESSURE CONNECTIONS. TUBING AND CONNECTIONS WILL FIT INSIDE STANDARD SCHEDULE 40 PIPE. TOTAL PRESSURE 1/8 [3.18] HOLE 1/2 NPT
Model 160-U
6-1/2 OR 12-1/2
1/8 [3.18] MODEL 166 2 [50.8] MODEL 167 1 [25.4] STATIC PRESSURE (8) .020 [.51] HOLES EQUALLY SPACED TOTAL PRESSURE 3/64 [1.19] HOLE
166/167 Series
1/8 [3/18]
ACCESSORIES
No. A-158 Split Flange Mounting can be added to any Dwyer No. 160 Standard Pitot Tube. Cadmium plated steel. Gasket is pattern for mounting holes. Secure flange loosely to tube, adjust tube depth and tighten screws. Gasket of 1/16 Neoprene fits tightly around tube and against duct for leak-proof seal. Nuts, washers included. No. A-159 Mounting Gland No. A-159 Mounting Gland Versatile adapter slips on any Series 160, 5/16 standard Pitot tube made after Dec. 1990. Two-part stainless steel fitting slides over tube and provides permanent, secure mounting. Where duct interior is accessible, use the washers and jam nut supplied. For blind applications or in thicker materials, use model A-156 flange mounting plate. Once tube is adjusted to proper depth and angle, tighten smaller hex bushing to lock position. Graphite bushing inside assures leak-proof seal even at higher temperatures. TFE bushing also available. NOTE: For full insertion with this fitting, order next longer Pitot tube. No. A-397 Step Drill. For fast, convenient installation of Pitot tubes in sheet metal ducts. No center punch needed; automatic de-burring. Drills six sizes from 3/16-1/2 in 1/16 increments.
A-159 Mounting Gland is used for both duct mounting and flange mounting. To flange mount, the A-159 must be used with the A-156 flange mounting plate.
A-159 Duct A-156 Flange Mounting Gland Mounting Plate with 1/2 male NPT with 1/2 female NPT
160-96 96 160-8 8-5/8 160-120 120 160-12 12-5/8 160-168 168 160-18 18-5/8 216 160-216 160-24 24-5/8 Pocket Size 1/8 Dia. 160-36 36-5/8 160-48 48-5/8 166-6 6 160-60 60-5/8 166-12 12 Universal Model for 3/4 Pipe 6 167-6 167-12 12 160-U * Accessories & Options A-156 Flange Mounting Compression Fitting mounting option for Plate 1/2 female NPT 166/167 Series. Add -CF suffix (166-6-CF). A-158 Split Flange A-159 Mounting Gland A-397 Step Drill
*Universal model for permanent installation and connection to metal tubing. Make any length Pitot tube with 3/4 schedule 40 pipe, 3/4 to 1/2 reducing bushing and 1/4 metal tubing.
CALL TO ORDER:
51
Series FAFM
AIR VELOCITY
FAFM-D-xxxx
7/8 [22.23]
A INLET FLOW VIEW SECTION A-A APPLICATION DIAGRAM 1 12 [25.40] [304.80] 1/16 [1.63]
B INLET FLOW VIEW SECTION B-B APPLICATION DIAGRAM 4 [101.60] 1/16 [1.98] L L = Fan Inlet Dia.
FAFM-S-xxxx
3-1/8 [79.38]
3-5/8 [92.20]
R3/16 [4.76] 3/8 [9.53] MOUNTING PLATES TO BE BENT TO FIT INLET MODEL FAFM-S 3/4 [19.05]
The Model FAFM Fan Inlet Air Flow Measuring Probes use evenly distributed total and static pressure measuring points to deliver an accurate measurement of flows in a fan inlet. The Air Flow Measuring Probes can be completely installed from outside of the fan making it ideal for when proper duct locations are unavailable. With its lightweight and durable construction in addition to its ease of installation, this product lends itself to being used in the HVAC industry. There are two versions of the model FAFM fan inlet air flow probes to choose from depending on the depth of the fan inlet. For fan inlets with depth less than 3-1/2 (8.89 cm): Please order a fan inlet probe with an S suffix. This probe has a diameter of .375 (.95 cm). It employs one total flow measuring tube and one static measuring tube. Each probe is covered with an extruded aluminum anodized coat. Each measuring tube has multiple sensing points. For fan inlets with depth greater than 3-1/2 (8.89 cm): Please order a fan inlet probe with a D suffix. This probe has a diameter of 3-1/2 (8.89 cm). It employs extruded aluminum anodized coated probes with both total and static sensors on each tube. Please Note: One model number is for a set of two fan inlet air flow measurement probes. A set is necessary in order to ensure an accurate reading. No more than two air flow measurement probes will be needed to obtain an accurate reading
SPECIFICATIONS Wetted Materials: Aluminum with clear anodized finish. Accuracy: 2% (Note: Field Calibration May Be Required). Max. Temperature: 400F (204C). Minimum Design Flow: 400 fpm (2.03 m/sec). Maximum Design Flow: 12,000 fpm (60.96 m/sec). Process Connections: 1/4 NPT female.
FAFM -
S - Fan inlet depth less than 3-1/2 D - Fan inlet depth greater than 3-1/2
Fan inlet diameter in inches where the boxes represent the tens, ones, tenths, and hundredths digits of the diameter respectively. i.e. __ __ . __ __ go to the corresponding box in the sequence.
Example: For a fan inlet that is exactly 12 in diameter and has a depth of more than 3-1/2 the model number will be: FAFM-D-1200. Example: For a fan inlet that is 23.89 in diameter and has a depth of less than 3-1/2 the model number will be: FAFM-S-2389. Example: For a fan inlet that is 6.24 in diameter and has a depth of less than 3-1/2 the model number will be: FAFM-S-0624.
52
CALL TO ORDER:
Series AFG
AIR VELOCITY
A B
The Series AFG Flow Grid is an outstandingly simple yet accurate and cost effective alternative to other duct mounted pressure sensors. Once installed and connected to a suitable measuring instrument, the device will provide years of trouble free monitoring of both air and gas flow. Installing the AFG Flow Grid is quick and easy, the AFG is supplied in kit form to allow both workshop and on-site installation into a wide range of square and circular ducts up to approximately 60. The AFG Flow Grid is a fundamental pressure-sensing device designed to transmit a continuous differential pressure signal. When this output is connected to a suitable measuring instrument (i.e. manometer, pressure transducer, etc.) it may be used to determine air velocity and volume flow rate. HOW THE AFG FLOW GRID WORKS The AFG Flow Gird consists of two tubes mounted diagonally across a square or rectangular duct, or diametrically across a round duct. The tubes are drilled with a series of equi-spaced holes. The holes in one tube face directly upstream and sense total pressure, while the pairs of holes in the second tube also face forward but at an included angle of 79 degrees, sensing static pressure. The total and (sub) static pressures are averaged along the length of each tube and provide pressure signals at connectors outside the duct wall. The pressure differentials across these connectors constitute the output signal.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Monitor air or compatible gas flow. Wetted Materials: 304 SS, PVC, Polyurethane, acetyl plastics, and neoprene rubber. Accuracy: 5%. Maximum Temperature: 176F (80C). Velocity Range: 295.2 ft/min to 5904 ft/min (1.5 to 30 m/sec). Diameter of Tubes: 5/16 (8 mm) or 5/8 (16 mm). Max Duct Diagonal: 60.4 (153.4 cm). Max Duct Diameter: 59.4 (150.9 cm). Process Connections: 5/16 barbed. Weight: AFG-1: 1 lb (454 g); AFG-2: 3 lb (1361 g).
APPLICATIONS The AFG Flow Grids will give useful and reliable readings in a wide variety of in duct locations often where other flow rate measuring devices are found to be unsatisfactory. The signal from an AFG Flow Grid can be used in a variety of ways, for example: To display differential pressure, velocity or volume flow using a micro manometer, gage or transmitter. To give a warning of over or under flow rate using a pressure switch. To control air supply in a system by connecting the grid to a pressure transmitter with an electrical output which can be used to feed into a control system. To display differential pressure on a simple fluid manometer to give visual indication of changes in volume flow rate in the duct. Model AFG-1 AFG-2 Diameter Tube A 5/16 (8 mm) 5/8 (16 mm) Length B 27 (688 mm) 59-4/5 (1518 mm)
CALL TO ORDER:
53
Series FLST
AIR VELOCITY
CIRCULAR STYLE TOTAL PRESSURE TAKEOFF 1/4 COMPRESSION FITTING .25 RADIUS BEADING EDGE [TYP]
DIMENSIONS CIRCULAR FLANGE STATION FLANGE SIZE D 8 - 15 16 - 44 45 - 72 .064 .064 .188 FLANGE CASING 1 1-1/2 1-1/2 2 6 6 10 12
L L + 2.5
W F
FLANGE CASING WIDTH W THICKNESS SIZE LENGTH L UP TO 48 .064 6 1-1/2 OVER 48 .188 1-1/2 FLANGE SIZE F 1-1/2 2 8 RECTANGULAR FLANGE STATION SIZE H OR W 8 - 72 73 & OVER
RECTANGULAR STYLE
The Series FLST Airflow Measurement Station is easy to install simply connect the tubing to the station fittings, then to a differential pressure manometer, gage, transmitter or switch. Single or multiple airflow elements are factory mounted and pre-piped in a casing designed for flanged connection to the ductwork. Standard materials consist of a G90 galvanized casing and 6063-T5 anodized aluminum flow sensors, suitable for most HVAC applications. The Series FLST utilizes an airflow averaging element in a head-type device, generating a differential (velocity) pressure signal similar to the orifice, venturi, and other head producing primary elements. Strategically located sensing ports continually sample the total and static pressures when inserted normal to flow. Total pressures sensed by the upstream ports are continually averaged within the airflow element in an isolated chamber. The static sensing ports are averaged in a second isolation chamber. Multiple elements are joined together for connection to a differential measurement device (gage, transmitter, etc.) for flow measurement and indication purposes. FEATURES Low signal-to-noise ratio. Multiple total and static pressure sensing ports along the length of the element. Factory mounted and pre-piped in a flanged duct section (casing). 2% accuracy throughout velocity ranges of 100 fpm and over. Standard construction includes galvanized casing and 6063-T5 anodized aluminum flow sensors. Standard airflow stations can be operated (in air) continuously in temperatures up to 350F or intermittently in temperatures up to 400F. All airflow stations can be operated in humidity ranges of 0 to 100%. Standard airflow stations have good salt air resistance and are suitable for most HVAC applications. APPLICATIONS Sensing fan, blower, and air handler output Determine duct flow rates in various zones in building
SPECIFICATIONS Accuracy: Within 2% of actual flow when installed in accordance with published recommendations. K-Factor: 0.97. Velocity Range: 100 to 10,000 fpm (0.51-51 m/s). Wetted Material: Elements 6063-T5 anodized aluminum; Casings 16 ga G90 galvanized steel. Coatings: Imron 333 polyurethane enamel. Temperature Limits: Galvanized Casings and Aluminum Elements 350F (177C) continuous operation (in air) 400F (204C) intermittent operation (in air). Humidity: All Airflow Stations 0 to 100% non condensing. Process Connections: 1/4 compression fittings. How To Order: Rectangular or Oval Models FLSTR - Rectangular O - Oval
Circular Models FLST-C Diameter (in) Note: When ordering rectangular or oval flow stations, pressure taps will always be located on the longer of the two dimensions.
54
CALL TO ORDER:
AIR VELOCITY
44 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
48 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
52 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
56 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
60 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
66 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
72 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
78 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
84 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
90 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
96 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
102 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
108 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
114 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
120 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
NOTE: When ordering rectangular or oval flow stations, pressure taps will always be located on the longer of the two dimensions.
CALL TO ORDER:
55
Series SSS-1000
AIR VELOCITY
3-1/2 [88.90]
MOUNTING HOLES 2X 3/16 [4.76] PUSH-ON CONNECTIONS FOR 3/8 POLY TUBING [9.53] 2-3/4 [69.85] 7/16 [11.11] 1-1/4 [57.15]
The Series SSS-1000 Lightweight Flow Sensor is ideal for sensing differential pressure in the inlet section of variable air volume terminal units and fan terminal units. Units can also be used to sense differential pressure at other locations in the main or branch duct systems. The H port senses total pressure and the L port senses static pressure. The difference between these signals is the differential, or velocity pressure. Up to four sensing points and lengths of 3-5/32 to 9-29/32 (8.02 to 25.26 cm) to accommodate box size diameters of 4 to 16 (10.16 to 40.64 cm) are available. APPLICATION Variable air volume terminal units. Fan terminal units Duct velocities Zone control in HVAC systems
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and compatible gases. Wetted Materials: ABS/Polycarbonate (UL94-5V). Temperature Limits: Operating: 40 to 120F (4 to 49C); Storage: -40 to 140F (-40 to 60C). Connection: 1/4 (6 mm) I.D. tubing for 3/8 (10 mm) O.D. tubing. Mounting Orientation: Integral flange with gasket. Weight: 1 oz (28 g).
Model SSS-1002 SSS-1003 SSS-1004 SSS-1005 SSS-1006 SSS-1007 SSS-1008 SSS-1009 SSS-1010 SSS-1011 Length (Dimension A) 3-5/32 (8.02 cm) 5-13/32 (13.73 cm) 7-21/32 (19.55 cm) 9-29/32 (25.26 cm) 12-1/2 (31.75 cm) 14-3/4 (37.47 cm) 17-1/8 (43.50 cm) 19-13/32 (49.29 cm) 21-21/32 (55.01 cm) 23-29/32 (60.72 cm)
56
CALL TO ORDER:
Model 530
AIR VELOCITY
The Model 530 air flow switch provides excellent sensitivity and reliability at a very reasonable price. Quality features include a rugged die cast body, stainless steel vane and SPDT snap switch. Unit is field adjustable from 400-1600 FPM. Mounting is fast and simple, with only two screws needed. Vane fits 6 in. or larger ducts. APPLICATIONS Low air flow condition duct alarm Model 530, Air Flow Switch Range 400-1600 FPM mounted on top of horizontal duct.
CAUTION: FOR USE ONLY WITH AIR OR NON-COMBUSTIBLE NON-CORROSIVE GASES. UNIT IS NOT SEALED AGAINST DUST.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible gas flow. Wetted Materials: Contact factory. Vane: Stainless Steel. Temperature Limit: 180F (82C). Switch Type: SPDT. Electrical Rating: 125 VAC - 9.8 amp full load 58.8 amp locked rotor. 250 VAC - 4.9 amp full load 29.4 amp locked rotor. Pilot Rating: 470 VA at 125, 250 VAC. Resistive: 15 amp at 125, 250, or 480 VAC. Electrical Connections: Screw type terminal. Conduit Connection: 7/8 conduit hole. Mounting Orientation: Horizontal duct flow Set Point Adjustment: Screw type. Weight: 1 lb, 1 oz (481.94 g) Agency Approvals: UL, CSA, CE.
Model 660
CENTER OF HOLE 4 (101) BELOW BOTTOM OF FULL OPEN SASH TUBING AIR VELOCITY MONITOR
2-53/64 [71.83]
1-13/64 [30.56]
7/32 [5.56]
2-3/4 [69.85]
Model 660 Air Velocity Monitors are a practical, affordable way to continuously monitor for safe airflows through laboratory fume hoods. They are typically installed in the fume hood side fascia and connected to the interior sidewall via 1-1/8" flexible tubing. As the exhaust fan draws air through the device, a sensitive constant temperature thermistor measures flow and lights a green (normal), yellow (high) or red (low) LED. An audible alarm also warns of low flow and requires manual resetting. Mounting holes fit standard single gang electrical box. APPLICATIONS Warns user if insufficient fume hood face velocity is encountered Model 660 Air Velocity Monitor. Includes 3 flexible tubing, pre-fittings and 90 elbow, 120 VAC to 24 VAC power transformer.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible, non-corrosive gases. High Setpoint Range: 0-275 FPM (0-1.397 m/s). Low Setpoint Range: 0-150 FPM (0-.792 m/s). Repeatability: 7% of full span, 0-50 and 150-275 FPM; 5% of full span, 50-150 FPM. Compensated Temperature Range: 50 to 90F (10 to 32.2C). Operating Temperature Range: 32 to 120F (0 to 48.9C). Power Supply: 24 VAC, 3 watts maximum. Response Time: 6-10 seconds. Warm-Up Time: 3-5 minutes (no flow). Audible Alarm: 75 dB between 3-10 feet. Weight: 3 oz (85 g). Mounting Hardware: (2) #6 x 1" sheet metal screws, (2) 6-32 x 7/8" machine screws.
CALL TO ORDER:
57
Series TTE
4-9/32 [108.74]
TEMPERATURE
10-23/64 [263.13] 4-15/32 [113.51] 1/2 NPT 2-23/32 [69.06] 1/2 NPT 3-29/32 [99.22] 1/4 [6.35]
1/2 NPT
The Series TTE Explosion-Proof RTD Temperature Transmitter is the ideal product for hazardous temperature measurement applications. The TTE series has seven preprogrammed temperature ranges that are selectable via an internal dip switch. For those applications that need a custom range, the transmitter can be easily configured for any range between -30 to 250F with a minimum span of 40F. The span and zero can be quickly adjusted with a simple push button design. The compact housing allows for the transmitter to be mounted in virtually any application. Model Number TTE-104-W TTE-106-W TTE-109-W TTE-112-W Probe Length 4 6 9 12
Note: Add -LCD to end of model for LCD option. Other probe lengths available. Consult factory for details.
SPECIFICATIONS Temperature Sensor: Pt1000, 0.00385 DIN. Output Temperature Ranges: User selectable any range between 30 to 250F with a minimum span of 40F. Temperature Limits: Ambient: 0 to 158F (-18 to 70C). Process: -30 to 250F (-34.4 to 121.1C). Accuracy: Transmitter 0.1% F.S. Probe 0.3% F.S. Thermal Drift Effects: 0.02%/C Max. Response Time: 250 ms. Wetted Materials: 316 Stainless Steel. Process Connection: 1/2 male NPT. Conduit Connection: 1/2 female NPT. Probe Length: 2 to 18 (Depending on model). Pressure Limits: 2000 psi (137 bar). Power Requirements: 10 to 35 VDC. Output Signal: 4-20 mA (two wire loop powered). Optional Display: 2 Lines X 8 Character LCD. Enclosure Rating: Weatherproof and Explosion-proof for Class I, Groups B, C, D; Class II, Groups E, F, G; Class III. Weight: 2 lb 8 oz (1134 g). Agency Approvals: FM, CE.
Field Selectable Ranges 40 to 90F (4.4 to 32.2 C) -20 to 140F (-28.9 to 60C) 0 to 100F (-17.8 to 37.8C) 30 to 240F (-1.1 to 115.6C) 32 to 212F (0 to 100C) 32 to 122F (0 to 50C) -30 to 65C (-1.1 to 18.3C) Custom range between -30 to 250F (-34.4 to 121.1C)
APPLICATIONS Temperature transmitters used with RTD to monitor water temperature temperature for boilers or air temperature ducts.
58
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 651
Temperature Transmitter
RTD or Thermocouple Input, Zero and Span Adjust, Linearized 4-20 mA Signal
TEMPERATURE
Linearized output for precise temperature monitoring or control is combined with small size and quick, easy mounting. Rugged Series 651 transmitters are designed for use with 2 or 3 wire Pt100 RTDs (to DIN standard 43760 or BS1904) or ungrounded Type K thermocouples. Thermocouple models 651TC are cold junction compensated, automatic 32 to 160F (0 to 70C) with upscale burnout. These economical devices provide the accuracy and reliability you need at the lowest possible cost. APPLICATION Temperature transmitters used with RTD to monitor water temperature for boilers or air temperature for ducts Model No. 651A-10 651A-20 651A-40 651TC-01 651TC-02 651TC-04 651TC-06 Input Type Pt100 RTD Pt100 RTD Pt100 RTD Type K Thermocouple Type K Thermocouple Type K Thermocouple Type K Thermocouple Range,F (C) 32-212 (0-100) 32-392 (0-200) 32-752 (0-400) 32-212 (0-100) 32-392 (0-200) 32-752 (0-400) 32-1112 (0-600)
SPECIFICATIONS Input: 2 or 3 -wire Pt100 RTD (models 651A), or ungrounded Type K thermocouple (models 651TC). Output: 4-20 mA DC, linearized. Transmitter Type: 2-wire. Output Impedance: 700 @ 24 VDC. Power Requirements: 10-32 VDC, reverse connection protected. Accuracy: 0.2C plus 0.2% reading (models 651A), 0.1% FS plus cold junction errors (models 651TC). Temperature Drift: ZERO drift typical 0.02%/C (0.09F), SPAN typical 0.005%/C (0.0036F). Temperature Limits: Ambient: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Maximum Storage Temperature: 160F (70C). Response Time: 10-90% in 200 ms (models 651A), 70% in 2 ms (models 651TC). Agency Approvals: CE. ACCESSORY A-709, Optional enclosure for Series 651Transmitters. NEMA 1 protective housing is 3 x 2 1/8 (76 x 54 mm). Supplied with mounting hardware, strain relief fitting and assembly instructions (See page 366)
Series 659
29/32 [23.02] Series 659 Push-Button Temperature Transmitters accept thermocouple (J, K, T), RTD (Pt100) or thermistor input and provide a linearized 4 to 20 mA output. The transmitter is quickly ranged and calibrated by using a single on-board switch. An LED provides visual indication of sensor fault and programming mode. Models feature reverse polarity protection. Thermocouple models are also galvanically isolated and cold junction compensated. The compact transmitter can be mounted directly within any standard thermal head for connection to the sensor. The Series 659 Transmitters are ideal for temperature measurement in boilers, burners, ducts, furnaces, refrigeration systems, food processing, tanks, chemical processing, steam generators or any other process application. APPLICATION Temperature Transmitters used with RTD to monitor water temperature for boilers or air temperature for ducts
SPECIFICATIONS Input Range: Type J T/C: -328 to 2192F (-200 to 1200C); Type K T/C: -328 to 2498F (-200 to 1370C); Type T T/C: -328 to 752F (-200 to 400C); Pt100 RTD: -328 to 1562F (-200 to 850C); Thermistor: -13 to 257F. Accuracy: T/C models: 0.04% F.S., 0.04% of reading or 0.5C whichever is greater; RTD: 0.2C 0.1% of rdg; Thermistor: 0.25F (0.1C). Output: Linearized 4 to 20 mA, 2-wire loop powered. Sample Rate: 500 ms. Loop Resistance: T/C: 700 @ 24 VDC; RTD: 800 @ 24 VDC; Thermistor: 24 VDC. Output Thermal Drift: Zero: 0.2A/C; Span: 0.5A/C. Temperature Limits: Ambient: -4 to 158F (-20 to 70C), 80% RH max. Ambient Storage Temperature: -40 to 158F (-40 to 70C), 95% RH max. Burnout: Upscale 22 mA. Weight: 0.92 oz (26 g).
CALL TO ORDER:
59
Series BTO
7-1/8 (180.98)
TEMPERATURE
3-5/16 (84.14)
3-1/16 (77.79)
2-15/16 (71.61)
The Series BTO Bimetal Thermometer with Transmitter Output eliminates the need for a separate thermometer and transmitter. By only needing one connection, the BTO series reduces installation cost and saves space. The head-mount transmitter is located in a weatherproof thermal head located on the side of the stem. The BTO series is ideal for use on power generating boilers, skid mounted compressors, and thermal oxidation systems.
SPECIFICATIONS Thermometer Specifications Wetted Materials: 304 SS. Housing Material: 304 SS. Lens: Glass. Accuracy: 1% full scale. Temperature Limits: Ambient: -58 to 185F (-50 to 85C). Dial Size: 3 or 5. Process Connection: 1/2 NPT. Resolution: 2F (5F for 400F and 550F models).
Model Number BTO525101 BTO52551 BTO52561 BTO525121 BTO52571 BTO540101 BTO54051 BTO54061 BTO540121 BTO54071 BTO560101 BTO56051 BTO56061 BTO560121 BTO56071 BTO590101 BTO59051 BTO59061 BTO590121 BTO59071 BTO512101 BTO51251 BTO512061 BTO512121 BTO51271 Dial Size 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
Transmitter Specifications Temperature Limits: Ambient: -58 to 185F (-50 to 85C). Power Requirement: 10 to 33 VDC. Output Signal: 4 to 20 mA. Loop Resistance: 1045. Power Consumption: 38 mA. Enclosure Rating: NEMA 4X (IP65). Weight: 1.95 lb.
Model Number BTO325101 BTO32551 BTO32561 BTO325121 BTO32571 BTO340101 BTO34051 BTO34061 BTO340121 BTO34071 BTO360101 BTO36051 BTO36061 BTO360121 BTO36071 BTO390101 BTO39051 BTO39061 BTO390121 BTO39071 BTO312101 BTO31251 BTO312061 BTO312121 BTO31271
Dial Size 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
Range 0 to 200F 0 to 250F 50 to 300F 50 to 400F 50 to 550F 0 to 200F 0 to 250F 50 to 300F 50 to 400F 50 to 550F 0 to 200F 0 to 250F 50 to 300F 50 to 400F 50 to 550F 0 to 200F 0 to 250F 50 to 300F 50 to 400F 50 to 550F 0 to 200F 0 to 250F 50 to 300F 50 to 400F 50 to 550F
Range 0 to 200F 0 to 250F 50 to 300F 50 to 400F 50 to 550F 0 to 200F 0 to 250F 50 to 300F 50 to 400F 50 to 550F 0 to 200F 0 to 250F 50 to 300F 50 to 400F 50 to 550F 0 to 200F 0 to 250F 50 to 300F 50 to 400F 50 to 550F 0 to 200F 0 to 250F 50 to 300F 50 to 400F 50 to 550F
60
CALL TO ORDER:
Series BT
TEMPERATURE
Series BT Bimetal Thermometers offer accurate, reliable service even in the toughest environments. These corrosion resistant units are constructed from stainless steel and are hermetically sealed to prevent crystal fogging. The bimetal element directly drives pointer, eliminating gears and linkage. An external reset screw allows field calibration and easy-toread aluminum dial minimizes parallax error. Choose back connection, lower connection or adjustable angle for easy viewing and installation. Adjustable models can be rotated a full 360 and tilted over a 180 arc. NOTE: When using in pressurized applications, use a suitable thermowell. Bimetal thermometers are commonly used to measure water temperature on chillers and boilers. Model Number Back Connection Dial Size, Stem Length Temperature Range, F(C) Degree Div., F(C)
SPECIFICATIONS Wetted Materials: 304 SS. Housing Material: Series 300SS Lens: Glass Accuracy: 1% full scale. Response Time: 40 seconds. Temperature Limits: Head: 200F (93C). Stem: Not to exceed 50% overModel Dial Size, Number Stem Length Adjustable Angle Connection
range or 1000F (538C) or 800F (427C) continuously. Process Connection: 1/4 NPT on 2 dial size; 1/2 NPT on 3 or 5 dial size. Stem Diameter: 1/4 O.D. Immersion Depth: Minimum 2 in liquids, 4 in gas.
BTB22551* BTB2405D BTB2409D BTB32510D BTB3255D BTB3257D BTB34010D BTB3405D BTB3407D BTB3605D
2", 2-12" 2", 4" 2", 4" 3", 212" 3", 212" 3", 212" 3", 4" 3", 4" 3", 4" 3", 6"
0/250 0/250 (-20/120) 200/1000 (100/550) 0/200 (-20/100) 0/250 (-20/120) 50/550 (10/290) 0/200 (-20/100) 0/250 (-20/120) 50/550 (10/290) 0/250 (-20/120)
5", 4" 5", 4" 5", 4" 5", 6" 5", 6" 5", 6" 3", 2.5"
0/200 (-20/100) 0/250 (-20/120) 50/550 (10/290) 0/200 (-20/100) 0/250 (-20/120) 50/550 (10/290) 0/250(-20/120)
BTC3255D
Series DBT
2-1/4 [82.55]
1/4 [6.35]
The Series DBT Digital Solar-Powered Bimetal Thermometer takes the guesswork out of temperature measurement. The 3-1/2 digit LED display is easy to read and provides resolution to 0.1F. The adjustable angle can be mounted in virtually any position. The engineering units can be selected in the field by removing the back cover. APPLICATION Used to measure water temperature on hot and cold lines. Model No. DBTA3251 DBTA3252 DBTA3401 DBTA3402 DBTA3601 DBTA3602 DBTA3901 DBTA3902 Stem Length 2.5 2.5 4 4 6 6 9 9 Range -58 - 302F -58 - 158F -58 - 302F -58 - 158F -58 - 302F -58 - 158F -58 - 302F -58 - 158F Model No. DBTA3121 DBTA3122 DBTA3151 DBTA3152 DBTA3181 DBTA3182 DBTA3241 DBTA3242
SPECIFICATIONS Range: 14 to 302F (-10-150C). Wetted Materials: 304 SS. Housing Material: Series 300 SS. Lens: Acrylic. Accuracy: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C): 1C. Dial Size: 3. Stem Length 12 12 15 15 18 18 24 24 Range -58 - 302F -58 - 158F -58 - 302F -58 - 158F -58 - 302F -58 - 158F -58 - 302F -58 - 158F (-50 (-50 (-50 (-50 (-50 (-50 (-50 (-50 -
Process Connection: 1/2 NPTadjustable angle. Display: 3-1/2 digit LCD. Response Time: 15 seconds. Power Requirements: 3-Volt solar cell (minimum 35 LUX required). Weight: 12 oz (350 g).
CALL TO ORDER:
61
Series IT
Industrial Thermometer
9 Scale, Adjustable Angle Stem
2-3/8 [60.33]
1-1/32 [26.19]
10-5/16 [261.94]
8-3/4 [222.25]
TEMPERATURE
3-1/8 [79.38]
19/32 [15.08]
The Series IT Industrial Thermometer allows users to easily take accurate temperature measurements in any environment. The case of the IT series is made of die cast aluminum for extra durability in industrial environments. The glass lens is easily cleaned and resists scratches for better viewing of the scale. The stem can be adjusted 180 in order to achieve the best viewing angle. The blue organic fill is non-toxic and allows users to better see the temperature reading. The scales can be ordered with dual units, F, or C. 3-1/2 Stem Model Number ITA9351D ITA9352D ITA9353D ITA9354D ITA9355D ITA9356D ITA9357D ITA9358D Range -40 to 110F (-40 to 40C) 0 to 120F (-15 to 50C) 0 to 160F (-15 to 70C) 30 to 180F (0 to 80C) 30 to 240F (0 to 115C) 30 to 300F (0 to 150C) 50 to 400F (10 to 205C) 100 to 550F (40 to 300C) 6 Stem Model Number ITA9601D ITA9602D ITA9603D ITA9604D ITA9605D ITA9606D Range -40 to 110F (-40 to 40C) 0 to 120F (-15 to 50C) 0 to 160F (-15 to 70C) 30 to 180F (0 to 80C) 30 to 240F (0 to 115C) 30 to 300F (0 to 150C)
SPECIFICATIONS Wetted Material: Tapered cast aluminum with graphite fill. Housing Material: 9 (228 mm) aluminum. Lens: Glass. Accuracy: 1% accuracy. Scales: Aluminum painted white with black markings.
Process Connection: 1-1/418 NEF thread. Liquid Filling: Organic blue liquid filled tube. Mounting: Adjustable stem: vertical plane 180 horizontal plane 360. Weight: 1 lb 7 oz (0.65 kg).
APPLICATIONS Used on boilers and chillers to monitor temperature on hot and cold water lines.
Series IT-W
The Series IT-W Thermowells reduce installation cost and time by eliminating the need to drain the system when servicing industrial thermometers. The thermowells protect industrial thermometers from high pressure, flow and corrosive media. Series IT-W Thermowells are available with 2-1/2 and 5 insertion lengths and with the option of a 21/2 lagging extension. These cost efficient brass, 304 stainless steel, and 316 stainless steel thermowells with 3/4 NPT threads are compatible with most applications.
Model IT-WO1 IT-W11 IT-W21 IT-W04 IT-W14 IT-W24 IT-W07 IT-W17 IT-W27
Materials Brass 304 SS 316 SS Brass 304 SS 316 SS Brass 304 SS 316 SS
62
CALL TO ORDER:
Series I-1
1/4 OD (6.3)
TEMPERATURE
The Series I-1 Immersion Temperature Probes are designed with an adjustable insertion depth for greater application flexibility. The probe is constructed with a 6 (15 cm) 304 SS stem and a brass adapter with a compression sleeve. The probes include a 6 ft (1.8 m) plenumrated cable for remote termination. Probes are available with RTD or thermistor sensors. The Series I-1 probes are ideal for hot or chilled water, condensed water or low pressure steam applications that require an adjustable insertion length.
Model Number I-11062 I-12062 I-13062 I-14062 I-15062 I-16062 I-17062 I-18062 I-19062 I-1A062 Input Pt 100 RTD Pt 1000 RTD Ni 1000 RTD 1000 Balco RTD 10K NTC Thermistor 3K NTC Thermistor 5K NTC Thermistor 100K NTC Thermistor 20K Thermistor 2252 Thermistor
SPECIFICATIONS Accuracy: Platinum RTD: 0.1% at 32F (0C); Nickle RTD: 0.5F at 70F (21.1C); Balco: 0.5F at 70F (21.1C); Thermistor: 0.2C interchangeable at 77F (25C). Operating Temperature: -40 to 250F (-40 to 121C). Probe Diameter: 1/4 (6.3 mm). Probe Length: 6 (15 cm). Cable Length: 6 ft (1.8 m). Probe Material: 304 SS. Mounting: 1/4 NPT brass adapter.
Series I-2
1-1/4 (30.0)
2 (50.0)
2-1/2 (62.0)
The Series I-2 Immersion Sensor Assemblies are designed for immersion temperature applications and installations for building automation systems. The unit is constructed with a waterproof 6 (15 cm) length 304 SS probe and a polycarbonate enclosure. The assembly can be threaded directly into a 1/2 NPT well (sold separately) or 1/2 saddle fitting. Series I-2 immersion sensor assemblies are available with a Pt 100 or Pt 1000 RTD sensor. Model Number I-21063 I-22063 Input Pt 100 RTD Pt 1000 RTD
SPECIFICATIONS Accuracy: 0.1% @ 32F (0C), alpha 385 per DIN 43 760. Operating Temperature: -40 to 250F (-40 to 121C). Probe Diameter: 1/4 (6.3 mm). Probe Length: 6 (15 cm). Probe Material: 304 SS. Mounting: 1/2 male NPT. Enclosure Material: Polycarbonate. ACCESSORIES IW-162 6 brass well with 1/2 NPT IW-262 6 SS well with 1/2 NPT IW-C Thermowell compound
CALL TO ORDER:
63
Series I-4
2 (50.0)
TEMPERATURE
2-1/2 (62.0)
4 (100.0)
The Series I-4 Weatherproof Immersion Assemblies are designed for harsh environments where dust, condensation, vapor, oil and other contaminants may be present. The assembly combines a powder-coated steel enclosure with a fast response RTD sensor for immersion temperature applications. The probe is constructed of 304 SS in a 6 (15 cm) length. Use the brass adaptor supplied with each unit to adjust the immersion depth of the probe. The Series I-4 can be threaded directly into a 1/2 NPT well (sold separately) or 1/2 saddle fitting.
SPECIFICATIONS Accuracy: 0.1% @ 32F (0C). Operating Temperature: -40 to 250F (-40 to 121C). Probe Diameter: 1/4 (6.3 mm). Probe Length: 6 (15 cm). Probe Material: 304 SS. Mounting: 1/2 NPT male. Enclosure Material: Powder-coated steel, NEMA 4 (IP-65).
ACCESSORIES IW-162 6 brass well with 1/2 NPT IW-262 6 SS well with 1/2 NPT IW-C Thermowell compound
Series S
1/4 [6.3]
The Series S Surface Mount Temperature Sensors provide a cost effective and reliable solution for surface contact temperature measurement of conditioned water pipes, low pressure steam or refrigerant lines. The sensors are ideal for applications where immersion wells are not practical to install. Models are constructed with a 2 (50 mm) 304 SS probe and a 6 ft (1.8 m) plenum rated cable. Nylon ties are included to secure the sensor to the pipe.
Models S-11 S-12 S-13 S-14 S-15 S-16 S-17 S-18 S-19 S-1A Sensor Type Pt 100 RTD Pt 1000 RTD Ni 1000 RTD 1000 Balco RTD 10 k NTC Thermistor 3 k NTC Thermistor 5 k NTC Thermistor 100 k NTC Thermistor 20 k NTC Thermistor 2252 NTC Thermistor CALL TO ORDER: U.S. Phone 219 879-8000
SPECIFICATIONS Accuracy: Platinum RTD: 0.1% @ 32F (0C), alpha 385 per DIN 43760. Nickel RTD: 0.5F @ 70F (21.1C). Balco: 0.5F @ 70F (21.1C). Thermistor: 0.2C interchangeable @ 77F (25C). Operating Temperature: -40 to 250F (-40 to 125C). Probe Diameter: 1/4 (6.3 mm). Probe Length: 2 (50 mm). Probe Material: 304 SS.
64
Series S-2
2-1/2 (63.50)
TEMPERATURE
Monitor pipe surface temperatures using the Series S-2 Surface Temperature Assembly. The Series S-2 combines a low profile brass temperature sensor and a 30% glass-filled polycarbonate enclosure designed to withstand temperature extremes, mechanical shock and vibration. The unit includes a mounting bracket for pipe clamp installations. The Series S-2 are available with Pt 100 or Pt 1000 RTD sensors.
SPECIFICATIONS Accuracy: 0.1% @ 32F (0C). Operating Temperature: -40 to 250F (-40 to 121C). Probe Material: Brass. Enclosure Material: 30% glass-filled polycarbonate.
Series S-4
4 (107.60)
The Series S-4 Weatherproof Surface Temperature Assembly is designed for applications in unconditioned environments where the unit may be subjected to dust, condensation, oil, vapor and other contaminants. The rugged steel enclosure meets NEMA 4 (IP-65) requirements. The Series S-4 includes a fast response brass, Pt 100 or Pt 1000 contact sensor. The sensor is insulated from the enclosure to provide accurate pipe surface temperature measurement. The assembly includes a mounting bracket for quick installation. Model S-41 S-42 Input Pt 100 RTD Pt 1000 RTD
SPECIFICATIONS Accuracy: 0.1% @ 32F (0C). Operating Temperature: -40 to 250F (-40 to 121C). Probe Material: Brass. Enclosure Material: Powder-coated steel, NEMA 4 (IP65).
CALL TO ORDER:
65
Series AVG
2 [50] 4 [100]
TEMPERATURE
2-1/2 [62]
The Series AVG Averaging Temperature Sensor provides a cost effective solution for HVAC system temperature control. Measure average supply air temperature in large ducts or plenums with the Series AVG. The sensors are designed with a 3/8 (9 mm) diameter bendable aluminum casing terminating into a painted steel, NEMA 4 (IP65) enclosure. Four environmentally sealed sensor modules are evenly spaced throughout the length of the casing. Select platinum RTD or thermistor modules. APPLICATION Monitors air temperature in large ducts
SPECIFICATIONS Accuracy: RTD: 0.1% @ 0C, alpha 385; thermistor: 0.2C interchangeability @ 77F (0C). Operating Temperature: -40 to 250F (-40 to 125C). Probe Diameter: 3/8 (9 mm). Probe Length: 12 ft (3.6 m). Probe Material: Bendable aluminum Enclosure: Painted steel NEMA 4 (IP65).
Model No. AVG-31121 AVG-32121 AVG-35121 AVG-36121 AVG-37121 AVG-38121 AVG-39121 AVG-3A121
Sensor Type Pt 100 RTD Pt 1000 RTD 10 k NTC Thermistor 3 k NTC Thermistor 5 k NTC Thermistor 100 k NTC Thermistor 20 k NTC Thermistor 2252 NTC Thermistor
Series RTD
36.000 [914.4]
Precision RTD (Resistance Temperature Detector) offers excellent accuracy and stability over a wide temperature range. Industry standard 3-wire 100 ohm (DIN) probes are available in 6 (15 cm), 12 (30.5 cm), or 18 (46 cm) sheath lengths with 30 (76 cm) extension cable and spade lug terminals.
Model Number RTD-686 RTD-6812 RTD-6818 RTD-646 RTD-6412 RTD-6418 Length 6 (15 cm) 12 (30.5 cm) 18 (46 cm) 6 (15 cm) 12 (30.5 cm) 18 (46 cm) Diameter 1/8 1/8 1/8 1/4 1/4 1/4
SPECIFICATIONS Sensor Type: Wire wound, 100 ohm. Temperature Range: -328 to 1202F (-200 to 650C). Pressure Limits: 250 psig (17.2 bar). Probe Material: 316 SS. Extension Length: 30 (76 cm). Standard: DIN .00385 (Class B, 0.12%). APPLICATIONS Typical applications are: air ducts, bearing temperature, oil temperature indicator, environmental test chambers.
66
CALL TO ORDER:
Series AD
2 [50.80]
1 1/2 [38.10]
AD
1/4 [6.35] INSTALLATION * - Flange mount 1 3 (175 mm) wire leads 2 - Flange mount 6 ft (1.8 m) cable 3 - Bulkhead mount 3 (175 mm) wire leads 4 - Bulkhead mount 6 ft (1.8 m) cable PROBE LENGTH 04 - 4 (100 mm) 06 - 6 (150 mm) 08 - 8 (200 mm) 12 - 12 (300 mm)
3/8-24 UNF-2A
9/16 HEX BULKHEAD MOUNT Air/Duct Temperature Sensors are available in precision platinum, nickel, or balco RTDs and interchangeable NTC thermistors. Sensors are constructed with a hermetically sealed 304 SS sheath and are unaffected by high humidity, contamination, thermal shock or vibration. Flange mount sensors offer low profile mounting and quick installation directly into duct work. Select bulkhead mounting if an adjustable insertion depth is required. Rugged air/duct sensors are ideal for air handlers, fan coil units, ducts, furnaces, freezers, ovens and other through wall temperature sensing applications.
SENSOR TYPE 1 - Pt 100 RTD 2 - Pt 1000 RTD 3 - Ni 1000 RTD 4 - 1000 Balco RTD 5 - 10 k NTC Thermistor 6 - 3 k NTC Thermistor 7 - 5 k NTC Thermistor 8 - 100 k NTC Thermistor 9 - 20 k NTC Thermistor A - 2252 NTC Thermistor
TEMPERATURE
Series TSX
(3.000)
(2.375)
Panel Cutout 2-51/64 x 1-9/64 (71 x 29 mm) SPECIFICATIONS Probe Range: PTC: -58 to 302F (-50 to 150C); NTC: -58 to 230F (-50 to 110C). Input: PTC/NTC thermistor 1000 @ 25C. Output: All models include 16A SPST relay @ 250 VAC resistive, 5A inductive; Dual output units also have one 8A SPDT relay @ 250 VAC resistive, 3A inductive, 3 output models also have 5A SPDT @ 250 VAC and 8A SPST @ VAC. Horsepower Rating (HP): 16A: 1HP 240 VAC - 10FLA, 60LRA 250 VAC. Control Type: ON/OFF. ACCESSORIES TS2-K, Configuration Key TS-5, PVC Probe (PTC), 5 ft TS-6, Metal Probe (PTC), 5 ft TS-7, Plastic Probe (NTC), 3 ft APPLICATIONS Controls chiller operation up to 1HP. Power Requirements: 110 VAC; 230 VAC; 24 VAC/DC; (depending on model). Accuracy: 1% F.S. Display: 3-digit, red, 1/2 (12.7 mm) digits. Resolution: 0.1 (<100); 1 (100). Memory Backup: Nonvolatile memory. Temperature Limit: Ambient: 14 to 131F (-10 to 70C). Storage Temperature: -4 to 176F (-20 to 80C). Weight: 2.3 oz (65 g). Front Panel Rating: IP64. Agency Approvals: CE, UL.
The microprocessor based Series TSX offers a low cost solution for cooling applications. Units are designed to accept up to two temperature probes selectable between PTC or NTC thermistor input. The probe temperature is displayed on the bright 3-digit LED. The Series TSX offers 23 programming parameters for specific application requirements. To quickly program multiple units with the same settings, use the configuration key TS2-K (sold separately). The user can define set point, hysteresis, probe error performance, and defrosting. The defrosting mode can also be initiated or interrupted manually by pressing the up arrow button. Units include password protection to secure from unwanted setting changes except for set point adjustment. If required, the keypad can be locked out so no adjustments can be made. Select from single output units with one 16A SPST relay dual output with one 16A SPST relay and one 8A SPDT relay for defrosting or three output models with one 16A SPST, 8A SPST and 5A SPDT. The temperature switch includes one NTC probe, gasket, mounting clips, and instruction manual.
DUAL INPUT, SINGLE OUTPUT Supply Voltage Model Number TSX-10140 TSX-11140 TSX-20140 TSX-21140 TSX-40140 TSX-41140 110 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC
Degrees F C F C F C Degrees F C F C F C
DUAL INPUT, DUAL OUTPUT Model Number Supply Voltage TSX-10240 110 VAC TSX-11240 110 VAC TSX-20240 230 VAC TSX-21240 230 VAC TSX-40240 24 VAC/DC TSX-41240 24 VAC/DC CALL TO ORDER: U.S. Phone 219 879-8000
DUAL INPUT, THREE OUTPUT Model Number TSX-10340 TSX-11340 TSX-20340 TSX-21340 TSX-40340 TSX-41340 Supply Voltage 110 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC Degrees F C F C F C
67
Series 16L
Limit Controls Large Dual Display, Universal Input FM Approved, Manual Reset,
5.24 [133] 0.45 [11.4] 1.76 [44.7] 1.89 [48]
ALL DIMENSIONS IN INCHES (MILLIMETERS). PANEL CUT OUT IS 1.77 +0.02 (45 + 0.6) SQUARE. STANDARD FEATURES FM Approved Limit Large Dual Display Universal Input Dedicated, Illuminated Reset Key Remote Reset Capability Standard Four Password Protected Security Levels The 16L Series Temperature/Process FM Approved Limit Controls set a new standard in 1/16 DIN Limit controls. The 16L offers universal input (10 thermocouple types, 4 RTD types, voltage, and current), single set point or dual set point. Standard features include Remote Reset capability, Peak/Valley indication, open sensor protection, input rate of change protection, and much more. Unit offers 1500 VAC resolution, selectable high or low input, programmable sensor break protection and adjustable differential. Outputs include normally open (form A) and normally closed (form B) relays. Form A and form B relays can be setup one for each set point output and logically linked to emulate a form C output. Designed and built in the USA, the 16L family of controls offers the highest levels of features, function, and quality available today. APPLICATIONS Boiler over temperature alarm Boiler shut down Used as a high limit temperature switch for boilers SPECIFICATIONS Selectable Inputs: 10 Thermocouple, 4 RTD, DC Voltage, or DC Current selectable. Display: Two 4 digit, 7 segment 0.3 (7.62 mm) high LEDs. Accuracy: 0.25% of span, 1 least significant digit. Supply Voltage: 100 to 240 VAC, nominal, +10 -15%, 50 to 400 Hz. single phase; 132 to 240 VDC, nominal, +10 -20%. Model No. 16L2030 16L2034 Output A N.O. Relays N.O. Relays
0.25 [6.35] MAX. PANEL THICKNESS Power Consumption: 5 VA maximum. Operating Temperature: 14 to 131F (-10 to 55C). Memory Backup: Nonvolatile memory. No batteries required. Control Output Ratings: Relay: SPST, 3A @ 240 VAC resistive; 1.5A @ 240 VAC inductive. Weight: 8 oz (227 g). Agency Approvals: UL, FM.
TEMPERATURE
OPTIONS Add as a suffix to model number. Example: 16L2030-992. 934, Process Signal Output, PV or SV. Isolated 0 to 20 mADC 936, Process Signal Output, Isolated 0 to 10 VDC 992, RS-485 Serial Communications 993, RS-232 Serial Communications
Series TSF
2-19/32 [65.88]
2-23/32 [69.06]
Panel Cutout 2-51/64 x 1-9/64 (71 x 29) The Series TSF Thermocouple FM Approved Limit Control provides audible alarm status along with a robust 16 amp relay output. Unit allows the user to easily select automatic or manual reset along with 10 other parameters. The TSF series has a built in reset button on the front panel or can accept an external reset. The ease of programming and low price make the TSF series the best value limit control on the market. The Series TSF can be used as a boiler shut down or over temperature alarm. Model Number TSF-4010 TSF-4011 TSF-4020 TSF-4021 TSF-4030 TSF-4031 TSF-4040 TSF-4041 Description Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type J/K/S J/K/S J/K/S J/K/S J/K/S J/K/S J/K/S J/K/S input, input, input, input, input, input, input, input, 110 V, F 110 V, C 230 V, F 230 V, C 12 VAC/VDC, 12 VAC/VDC, 24 VAC/VDC, 24 VAC/VDC, SPECIFICATIONS Probe Range: 0 to 700C (32 to 999F) for thermocouple J type. 0 to 999C (32 to 999F) for thermocouples K or S type. Input: Type J, K or S thermocouple. Output: 16 A SPDT relay @ 250 VAC resistive. Horsepower Rating (HP): 1 HP. Control Type: ON/OFF; manual/automatic reset. Power Requirements: 110 VAC, 230 VAC, 12 VAC/VDC or 24 VAC/VDC (depending on model). Power Consumption: 4 VA. Accuracy: 1% FS. Display: 3-digit, red, 1/2 (12.7 mm) digits, plus sign. Resolution: 1. Memory Backup: Nonvolatile memory. Temperature Limits: Ambient: 14 to 131F (-10 to 55C). Storage Temperature: -4 to 176F (-20 to 80C). Weight: 2.3 oz (65 g). Front Panel Rating: IP64. Agency Approvals: CE, FM, UL, ULc.
F C F C
ACCESSORIES TCS-J, J type thermocouple, 4 probe, 48 extension TCS-K, K type thermocouple, 4 probe, 48 extension TS2-K, Configuration Key
68
CALL TO ORDER:
Series TG
4.650 [118.1] MAXIMUM INTERNAL FOOTPRINT 6.890 [175] MAXIMUM INTERNAL FOOTPRINT
9.450 [240]
MAXIMUM INTERNAL FOOTPRINT 2.930 [74.4] 4.840 [122.9] MAXIMUM INTERNAL FOOTPRINT
6.750 [171.5]
The Series TG Polycarbonate Thermostat Cover prevents physical damage and unauthorized adjustments of thermostats. Two sizes of covers are available to fit most common thermostats and transmitters. The low profile design with ventilation slits allows exceptional air flow in order to obtain accurate measurements. Each cover comes with two keys and mounting hardware for drywall and concrete walls.
Model TG-1, Large Thermostat Cover Model TG-2, Small Thermostat Cover ACCESSORY Model TG-KEY, Replacement Keys
CALL TO ORDER:
69
Series RH/RHL
Humidity/Temperature Transmitter
Calibration-Free, 2% Or 3% Accuracy, Optional Display
OSA (Outside Air)
4-9/16 [115.89]
5-1/8 [130.18] 4-17/32 [115.09] 2-15/64 [56.75] 4-17/32 [115.09]
Wall Mount
2-3/4 [69.85]
61/64 [24.21]
3-1/8 [79.38]
3-1/8 [79.38]
Duct Mount
1-1/8 [28.58]
3-45/64 [94.06]
2-1/4 [57.15]
55/64 [21.83]
2-41/54 [67.07]
9 [228.60]
5-1/8 [130.18]
35/64 [13.89]
Demanding humidity/temperature applications require the Series RH/RHL Transmitter which offers high accuracy, long term stability, and reliable operation. The Series RH/RHL is designed for monitoring and controlling humidity or both humidity and temperature in building energy management systems, HVAC, commercial, residential, clean rooms, museums, climate chambers, and other space monitoring applications. The Series RH/RHL is a two-wire transmitter with a 4-20 mA loop powered output or 0 to 10 VDC output. The state of the art sensor recovers from 100% saturation and is calibration-free. A variety of mounting configurations are available including wall mount, duct mount, and OSA (outside air) models. Select humidity monitoring or humidity and temperature models. The combined humidity/temperature version (RHT) provides dual 4-20 mA or 0 to 10 VDC output signals to control both humidity and temperature with one sensor which reduces installation costs. The duct mount version is also available with an optional alpha-numeric LCD to provide local indication of humidity and temperature simultaneously. The displayed temperature is field selectable for F or C. Monitor humidity in ducts, rooms, and outside air. APPLICATIONS Room temperature/humidity monitoring Supply air temperature/humidity monitoring Exhaust air temperature/humidity monitoring Outside air temperature/humidity monitoring
SPECIFICATIONS Relative Humidity Range: 0 to 100% RH. Temperature Range: -40 to 140F (-40 to 60C). Accuracy: (RH): 2% @ 10 - 90% RH; (RHL): 3% @ 20-80% RH; 0.9F @ 72F (0.3C @ 25C). Temperature Limits: -40 to 140F (-40 to 60C). Storage Temperature: -40 to 176F (-40 to 80C). Compensated Temperature Range: -4 to 140F (-20 to 60C). Power Requirements: 10-35 VDC. Output Signal: 4-20 mA or 0-10 VDC, 2 channels for humidity/temperature models (loop powered on RH current models). Response Time: 5-15 seconds. Electrical Connections: Screw terminal block. Conduit Connection: Duct mount: 1/2 NPS; OSA: 1/2 (22.3 mm). Drift: <1% RH/year. RH Sensor: Capacitance polymer. Temperature Sensor: Solid state band gap. Housing Material: Wall Mount: ABS; Duct Mount: PBT; OSA: Polycarbonate. Enclosure Rating: NEMA 4X (IP65) for OSA mount only. Display: Optional 2-line alpha-numeric, 8 characters/line for duct mount only. Display Resolution: RH: 0.1%; 0.1F (0.1C). Weight: Wall Mount: 0.5 lb (0.25 kg); Duct Mount: 0.6 lb (0.3 kg); OSA: 1 lb (0.45 kg). Agency Approvals: CE.
70
CALL TO ORDER:
OUTSIDE AIR MODELS Model Number RHUL-O RHTL-O RHUL-O1 RHTL-O1 RHU-O RHT-O RHU-O1 RHT-O1 Accuracy 3% 3% 3% 3% 2% 2% 2% 2% Output 4 to 20 mA 4 to 20 mA 0 to 10 VDC 0 to 10 VDC 4 to 20 mA 4 to 20 mA 0 to 10 VDC 0 to 10 VDC
DUCT MOUNT MODELS Model Number RHUL-D RHTL-D RHUL-D1 RHTL-D1 RHU-D RHT-D RHU-D1 RHT-D1 RHT-D-LCD RHT-D1-LCD RHTL-D-LCD RHTL-D1-LCD Accuracy 3% 3% 3% 3% 2% 2% 2% 2% 2% 2% 3% 3% Output 4 to 20 mA 4 to 20 mA 0 to 10 VDC 0 to 10 VDC 4 to 20 mA 4 to 20 mA 0 to 10 VDC 0 to 10 VDC 4 to 20 mA 0 to 10 VDC 4 to 20 mA 0 to 10 VDC
SINTERED FILTER MODELS Model Number RHUL-S RHTL-S RHUL-S1 RHTL-S1 RHU-S RHT-S RHU-S1 RHT-S1 Accuracy 3% 3% 3% 3% 2% 2% 2% 2% Output 4 to 20 mA 4 to 20 mA 0 to 10 VDC 0 to 10 VDC 4 to 20 mA 4 to 20 mA 0 to 10 VDC 0 to 10 VDC
CALL TO ORDER:
71
Model CDD
3-1/32 [77] 1-1/4 [31.7] 1-1/8 [28.58] 4X KNOCKOUT 1/2 CONDUIT HOLE 2X 7/32 [2X 5.56]
The Model CDD Duct Mount Carbon Dioxide Transmitter monitors the occupancy in a room by detecting the concentration of carbon dioxide in the return air duct. The non-dispersive infrared sensing technology automatically updates the calibration of the transmitter using a proprietary logic feature which limits the amount of error due to drift. The Model CDD can measure up to 2000 PPM in duct air flows less than 1500 FPM. APPLICATION On demand room ventilation. Model CDD Carbon Dioxide Transmitter
SPECIFICATIONS Range: 0 to 2000 PPM. Accuracy: 40 PPM + 3% of reading @ 22C. Temperature Dependence: 0.2% FS per C. Stability: < 2% of FS over life of sensor. Non-Linearity: < 1% of FS. Pressure Dependence: 0.13% of reading per mm of Hg. Response Time: 3 minutes typical for 90% step change. Duct Air Velocity Range: 0 to 1500 FPM (7.63 m/s). Ambient Operating Temperature: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Storage Temperature: -4 to 158F (-20 to 70C). Power Requirements: 18 to 30 VAC RMS 50/60 Hz or 18 to 42 VDC. Power Consumption: 1.65 watts peak (0.65 watts average at 42 VDC). Outputs: 0 to 10 VDC. Housing: Flammability Classification UL rated 94V-5. Weight: 8 oz (230 g).
72
CALL TO ORDER:
Series CDW
C L
1-9/32 [32.51]
The Series CDW Wall Mount Carbon Dioxide/Temperature Transmitter combines accurate CO2 measurements with a passive temperature output. The Non-Dispersive Infrared (NDIR) sensor continuously updates the calibration through a proprietary logic feature which limits the amount of error due to drift. The CDW series is ideal for building automation systems to help control the fresh air intake in a room. APPLICATION On demand room ventilation. Model CDW, Wall Mount CO2/Temperature Transmitter Model CDW-LED, Standard Model with LED Option
SPECIFICATIONS Range: 0 to 2000 PPM CO2. Accuracy: 100 PPM @ 22C. Temperature Dependence: 0.2% FS per C Stability < 2% of FS mover life of sensor. Non-linearity: < 1% of FS. Pressure Dependence: 0.13% of reading per mm of Hg. Response Time: 3 to 5 minutes for 90% step change. Ambient Operating Temperature: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Storage Temperature: -4 to 158F (-20 to 70C). Power Requirements: 18 - 30 VAC RMS 50/60 Hz, 18 to 42 VDC polarity protected. Power Consumption: 1.75 VA average 3.25 VA peak. Sensor: Non-Dispersive Infrared Sensor. Output: 0 to 10 VDC for CO2; 20K Ohm NTC Thermistor for temperature. Weight: 0.5 lb (227 g). Agency Approval: CE.
CALL TO ORDER:
73
Series WD2
3 [76.2]
WD2-BP1
WD2-BP2
CABLE LENGTH
WD2-LP
Protect your equipment from water leaks. The WD2 Water Leak Detector detects leaking water and sounds an alarm before the leak turns into a costly mess. Simply place it on a flat surface under HVAC equipment, pumps, compressors, or electrical switchgear rooms. The WD2 relies on the electrical conductivity of water to change the resistance across the two contacts located at the base of the enclosure. When there is enough water to bridge the contacts, the resistance changes and triggers an alarm. The Model WD2-BP1 and WD2-BP2 are stand-alone battery powered units and are provided with audible and visual alarms, plus low battery warning. The Model WD2-BP2 includes a solid state relay output. Choose Model WD2-LP for application that requires an external 24 VAC/DC power supply. Unit features both audible and visual alarms with a SPDT relay output. FEATURES Visual and audible alarm Low battery warning on battery powered versions SPDT switch output on WD2-LP SSR switch output on WD2-BP2 Compact size
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Water. Switch Type: WD2-BP2: Solid state relay; WD2-LP: SPDT relay. Electrical Rating: WD2-BP2: Pilot duty rating max. 250 mA @ 24 VDC; WD2-LP: SPDT 1A @ 24 VAC/DC, 1A @ 120 VAC. Audible Alarm Function on WD2-BP1/WD2-BP2: 10 sec on, 30 sec off. LED Alarm Function on WD2-BP1/WD2-BP2: 10 sec off, 30 sec on. Power Requirements: WD2-BP1/WD2-BP2: 3V lithium battery (approximately 2 years battery life); WD2-LP: 11-27 VAC/DC. Power Consumption: WD2-BP1/WD2-BP2: 0.9 mA steady state non-alarm, 3.0 mA during audible alarm, 2.4 mA during LED illumination; WD-LP: DC 25 mA typical and 75 mA max, AC 30 mA typical and 85 mA max. Electrical Connections: WD2-BP2: Attached 22 AWG, PVC insulated cable (0.8 ft long); WD2-LP: Attached 22 AWG, PVC insulated cable (4.8 ft long). Enclosure: Acrylic, ABS plastic. Temperature Limits: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Weight: WD2-BP1: 2 oz; WD2-BP2: 3.5 oz; WD2-LP: 4.3 oz.
LEVEL/WATER DETECTION
Description Battery Powered Leak Detector Battery Powered Leak Detector With SSR Output Line Powered 24 VAC/DC Leak Detector With Relay Output
74
CALL TO ORDER:
Model WD
Water Detector and Sensor Tape Detects Low Levels Of Conductive Liquids
1/4 [6.35] 1-1/2 [38.10] 1/4 4-1/4 [6.35] [107.32]
AMBER LED LIGHT 1-3/4 GREEN [44.17] LED LIGHT
4-3/4 [120.02]
WD TEST
3 [76.38]
The small and discreet Model WD Water Detector is designed for dependable detection of low levels of conductive liquids. The module features a sturdy and reliable aluminum enclosure and is powered by 24 VAC or 24 to 30 VDC. Water sensing tape attaches to module and if any liquid comes in contact with the tape the resistance is changed and the alarm will be triggered. The tape is hydrophobic so it does not absorb any of the liquid it is detecting which makes for a faster drying time and faster return to service after a water leak. The sensing tape is 1 wide and can be bought in lengths of 5, 10, 15 and 25 feet. Multiple tapes can be connected together to extend the coverage area which makes it ideal for domestic as well as commercial applications. Typical uses include computer rooms, telecommunication facilities, in drip pans under HVAC equipment and around water pumps. APPLICATIONS Water detection in drip pans under HVAC equipment Leak detection around pumps FEATURES Alarm Output DPDT Relay Power and Alarm LEDs Alarm Test Switch Continuous Tape Integrity Self Check Easy Trouble Shooting Extendable Tape Sensor
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Conductive liquid. Switch Type: DPDT. Electrical Rating: 1A @ 24 VAC/VDC. Power Requirements: 24 VAC, 24 to 30 VDC. Power Consumption: 35 mA maximum. Electrical Connections: Screw terminals. Conduit Connections: Hole for 1/2 conduit. Enclosure: Extruded aluminum. Sensor Tape: 1 (25.4 mm) wide and 5, 10, 15 or 25 feet long. Weight: 8 oz (.23 kg).
LEVEL/WATER DETECTION
Description Water Module 5 (1.52 m) Tape 10 (3.05 m) Tape 15 (4.57 m) Tape 25 (7.62 m) Tape
CALL TO ORDER:
75
Series L8
L8-WP2
11-13/64 [284.56] 3-1/16 [77.79] 1-21/32 [42.07] 4-5/16 [109.52]
4-17/32 [115.09]
1 NPTM 1/2 NPTM 1-5/16 OCTAGON [33.32] 2-17/32 [64.29] 1-1/8 [28.58 ]
1-1/8 [28.58]
Model L8 Flotect Liquid Level Switch features a leak proof body and float constructed from tough, durable polyphenylene sulfide which has excellent chemical resistance. Because the liquid level snap switch is magnetically actuated, there is no direct mechanical linkage to leak or fail, assuring longer life and decreased maintenance costs. This inexpensive unit is ideal for liquid level alarm, indication or control. Installation is quick and easy simply install in a horizontal position with the index arrow pointing down. The L8 Flotect Liquid Level Switch is UL recognized as an industrial motor controller per UL standard 508, suitable for mounting in a protected environment. This lightweight switch can be used in numerous chemical process, industrial systems and similar applications where process conditions are compatible with polyphenylene sulfide, ceramic 8 and 316 SS. This liquid level switch provides accurate setpoint control of liquids with specific gravities as low as 0.6. This compact and reliable control is designed to handle temperatures up to 212F (100C) and pressures to 150 psig (10 bar).
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible liquids. Wetted Materials: Float and Body: Polyphenylene Sulfide (PPS). Pin and Spring: 316 SS or Inconel. Magnet: Ceramic 8. Temperature Limit: 212F (100C). Pressure Limit: 150 psig (10.34 bar). Enclosure Rating: General purpose. WP/WP2 option is weatherproof. Switch Type: SPDT snap switch. MV option is a SPDT gold contact snap switch. Electrical Rating: 5A @ 125/250 VAC, 5A resistive, 3A inductive @ 30 VDC. MV option: 1A @ 125 VAC, 1A resistive, 0.5A inductive @ 30 VDC. Electrical Connections: 18 AWG, 18 (460 mm) long. Conduit Connection: 1/2 male NPT, 1/2 female NPT on WP and WP2. Process Connection: 1 male NPT. Mounting Orientation: Horizontal with index arrow pointing down. Weight: 5 oz (0.142 kg). Agency Approvals: CE, UL 508 for US and Canada. Specific Gravity: 0.6 minimum.
LEVEL/WATER DETECTION
L8 Level Switch
APPLICATIONS HVAC and building automation systems that incorporate components that are located outside of the building and exposed to the elements are ideal applications. Perfect for level monitoring, especially in cooling towers and thermal storage systems.
Inconel is a registered trademark of Huntington Alloys Corporation.
OPTIONS: Gold Plated Contacts, for dry circuits. Rated 1A @ 125 VAC; 1A resistive, 0.5A inductive @ 30 VDC. To order add suffix -MV. Example: L8-MV Inconel Alloy Option. Inconel Alloy replaces standard 316 SS wetted parts. Wetted parts are Inconel Alloy, ceramic 8, and Polyphenylene Sulfide. To order add suffix -INC. Example: L8-INC Weatherproof Enclosure. Optional housing is phenylpolioxide and provides weatherproof protection for electrical wiring. To order add suffix -WP. (Not UL approved) Example: L8-WP Weatherproof Enclosure. Optional housing is aluminum and provides weatherproof protection for electrical wiring. To order add suffix -WP2. (Not UL approved) Example: L8-WP2
76
CALL TO ORDER:
Series F6
11-13/16 [300]
F6-MHS
F6-HPS-11
1/2 NPT
F6-HPS-21
1/4 [6.35]
1-13/32 [35.72]
1/8 NPT
9/32 [7.14] 1/2 NPT 1-23/32 [43.66] 21/64 [8.33] 11/16 [17.46] 15/16 [23.81] 33/64 [13.1] 2X 3/4 [19.05] 3/4 [19.05] 21/64 [8.33]
15 [381]
F6-HPS-31
21/64 [8.33]
LEVEL/WATER DETECTION
Series F6 Horizontal and Vertical Mount Level Switches provide a simple, inexpensive control of the liquid level within a tank. Switch ratings are suitable for many solid-state control systems and monitors or alarms. Hermetically sealed reed switches are actuated by magnets permanently bonded inside the float and can be easily adapted to open or close a circuit on rising or falling levels. Models F6-HPS-11, F6-SS are internally mounted and are secured to the wall of the tank or vessel from the inside while model F6-HPS-21 is mounted from the outside (externally). Model F6-HPS-31 can be installed by mounting either internally or externally.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible liquids. Wetted Materials: See model table. Temperature: F6-SS & F6-MHS: -4 to 275F (-20 to 125C). F6-HPS-11, 21, 31: 14 to 176F (-10 to 80C). Pressure Limit: F6-SS & F6-MHS: 218 psi (15 bar). F6-HPS-11, 21, 31: 116 psi (8 bar). Enclosure Rating: General Purpose. Switch Type: SPST Hermetically sealed reed switch, reversible for N.O. or N.C. Electrical Rating: 20VA: 0.17A @ 120VAC, 0.08A @ 240 VAC. Electrical Connection: 22 AWG, 11.811 (300mm) long. Process Connection: F6-SS: 1/8 NPT, HPS-21, 31: 1/2 NPT, F6-MHS, F6-HPS-11: M16*2. Mounting Orientation: F6-SS: vertical 20, F6-MHS/HPS: horizontal with index arrow pointing up or down. Weight: F6-HPS-11, 21: 1.23 oz (38 g), F6-MHS-31: 1.41 oz (40 g), F6MHS: 3.35 oz (95 g), F6-SS: 1.59 oz (45 g). Agency Approvals: CE. Specific Gravity: F6-SS: 0.65, F6-MHS: 0.85, F6-HPS-11, 21, 31: 0.6.
Horizontal Float Model Number F6-HPS-11 F6-HPS-21 F6-HPS-31 F6-MHS Vertical Float Model Number Wetted Materials Minimum Specific Gravity 0.65 F6-SS 316SS/316SS Weight oz (g) 1.59 (45) Wetted Materials Polypropylene/Polypropylene Polypropylene/Polypropylene Polypropylene/Polypropylene 304 SS/304 SS Minimum Specific Gravity 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.85 Weight oz (g) 1.23 (38) 1.23 (38) 1.41 (40) 3.35 (95)
CALL TO ORDER:
77
Series 123
A special snap action mechanism eliminates frequent operation due to surging water level. Visible operation adds convenience in servicing. Stainless steel trim and hand reset are available if required. Options include DPDT switch, two stage, and weatherproof housing. APPLICATIONS Boiler Low Water Cut-Off Boiler Feed-Water Control Condensate Tanks Deaerators
LEVEL/WATER DETECTION
Model Number
123-153 123-7000-153
Switch Type
SPDT Mercury SPDT Snap
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible liquids. Cast iron is not for use with lethal or flammable substances either liquid or gaseous. Wetted Materials: Body: Cast iron. Float and Trim: 304 SS. Packing Gland: Brass.Packing: Carbon. Body Gasket: Carbon. Temperature Limit: 365F (185C). Pressure Limit: 150 psig (10.34 bar). Enclosure Rating: General Purpose. Optional weatherproof. Switch Type: SPDT snap switch or mercury switch. Optional DPDT or two stage.
Electrical Rating: Snap Switch: 15A @ 120/240/480 VAC, 0.5A @ 120 VDC resistive, 0.25A @ 240 VDC resistive. Mercury Switch: 4A @ 120 VAC/DC, 2A @ 240 VAC/DC. Electrical Connections: Screw terminal. Conduit Connection: 7/8 (22.23 mm) hole for 1/2 (12.7 mm) conduit. Process Connections: 1 female NPT. Mounting Orientation: Vertical. Weight: 20 lb (9.1 kg). Agency Approvals: UL and CSA. (Snap switch is not rated). Deadband: Approximately 1-1/2 (38.1 mm). Specific Gravity: 0.88 minimum. Options: Manual Reset.
Series CFS
3 3/16 [81.03]
Control the level of liquids in filling or draining reservoirs and tanks with the Series CFS. The mercury-free switch is designed with an inverter microswitch housed in a polypropylene cover. The unit includes a counterweight to adjust the stop and start levels of pump up/pump down application. APPLICATIONS Sump pump control
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible liquids. Wetted Materials: Polypropylene housing, PVC cable. Temperature Limits: 140F (60C). Pressure Limits: 60 psi (4 bar). Enclosure Rating: NEMA 6 (IP68). Switch Type: SPDT. Electrical Rating: 10 A @ 250 VAC, resistive. Mounting Orientation: Vertical. Weight: CFS-2: 1.416 lb (.62 kg). CFS-10: 3.316 lb (1.48 kg). Agency Approvals: CE.
78
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 16B
AT
OUT 1
OUT 2
ALM
1-57/64 (48.00)
1-49/64 (44.75)
1-57/64 (48.00)
3/8 (9.50)
3-5/32 (80.00)
Monitor and control temperature or process applications with precision using the Series 16B controllers. The units offer two separate outputs for dual loop control in direct or reverse acting. Select relay, voltage, or current output combined with a second relay output. The Series 16B provides dual LED displays for local indication of process value and setpoint value. Output status, engineering scale, auto tuning and alarm status is also indicated on the front panel. Control methods include ON/OFF, PID, self-tune and manual tune. PID control is supported with 64 ramp/soak control actions. Two additional alarm outputs are standard on the Series 16B. The alarm outputs can be quickly configured by using the thirteen built-in alarm functions. The controller easily communicates with other external devices such as PCs and PLCs for data search and system integration using the builtin RS-485 interface. Up to 247 communication addresses are available with transmission speeds of 2400 to 38,400 bps. The Series 16B also features universal input, selectable F/C, selectable resolution and security functions. APPLICATIONS Control temperature for boilers, damper control based on temperature or pressure.
SPECIFICATIONS Inputs: Thermocouple, RTD, DC voltages or DC current. Display: Two 4-digit, 7 segment .25 H (6.35 mm) LEDs. PV: red; SV: green. Accuracy: 0.25% span, 1 least significant digit. Supply Voltage: 100 to 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz. Power Consumption: 5 VA max. Operating Temperature: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Memory Backup: Nonvolatile memory. Control Output Ratings: Relay: SPST, 5A @ 250 VAC resistive. Voltage Pulse: 14V, 10% to -20% (max 40 mA). Current: 4 to 20 mA. Communication: RS-485 Modbus A-5-11/RTU communication protocol. Weight: 4 oz (114 g). Agency Approvals: CE, UL, cUL. Front Panel Rating: IP66.
OUTPUT TRANSDUCERS
ACCESSORIES SCD-SW, Configuration Software A-277, 250 Ohm Precision Resistor MN-1, Mini-Node USB/RS-485 converter
Input Types Type K T/C Type J T/C Type T T/C Type E T/C Type W T/C Type R T/C Type S T/C Type B T/C Type L T/C Type U T/C Pt 100 RTD 0-50 mV 0-5 V 0-10 V 0-20 mA* 4-20 mA*
Range -328 to 2372F (-200 to 1300C) -148 to 2192F (-100 to 1200C) -328 to 752F (-200 to 400C) 32 to 1112F (0 to 600C) -328 to 2372F (-200 to 1300C) 32 to 3092F (0 to 1700C) 32 to 3092F (0 to 1700C) 212 to 3272F (100 to 1800C) -328 to 1562F (-200 to 850C) -328 to 932F (-200 to 500C) -328 to 1112F (-200 to 600C) -999 to 9999 -999 to 9999 -999 to 9999 -999 to 9999 -999 to 9999
CALL TO ORDER:
79
Series 4B
3-25/32 (96.00)
AT OUT1 OUT2 ALM1 ALM2 ALM3
3-27/32 (97.63)
3-9/16 (90.81)
LOVE CONTROLS
SERIES 4B
3-25/32 (96.00)
5/8 (15.80)
3-1/8 (79.2)
OUTPUT TRANSDUCERS
The Series 4B 1/4 DIN Temperature/Process Controller is designed to accept thermocouple, RTD, current or voltage input and provide dual outputs for control. Available outputs include relay/relay, voltage pulse/relay, current/relay, or linear voltage/relay. The units can be programmed for ON/OFF, PID, auto-tuning, or manual tuning control methods. The PID control is supported by 64 ramp/soak actions. The Series 4B also includes two additional alarm outputs. The second relay output can be reconfigured as a third alarm output. The alarm type can be selected from 13 different preprogrammed alarm functions. The controller features dual LED displays for local indication of process and setpoint values.
APPLICATIONS Control temperature for boilers, damper control based on temperature or pressure.
SPECIFICATIONS Inputs: Thermocouple, RTD, DC voltages or DC current. Display: Two 4-digit, 7 segment. PV: 3/4 H (19 mm) red; SV: 1/2 H (12.7 mm) green. Accuracy: 0.25% span, 1 least significant digit. Supply Voltage: 100 to 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz. Power Consumption: 5 VA max. Operating Temperature: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Memory Backup: Nonvolatile memory. Control Output Ratings: Relay: SPDT, 5A @ 250 VAC resistive. Voltage Pulse: 14V, 10% to -20% (max 40 mA). Current: 4 to 20 mA. Linear Voltage: 0-10V. Communication: RS-485 Modbus A-5-11/RTU communication protocol. Weight: 15 oz (425 g). Agency Approvals: CE, UL, cUL. Front Panel Rating: IP66.
Input Types Type K T/C Type J T/C Type T T/C Type E T/C Type W T/C Type R T/C Type S T/C Type B T/C Type L T/C Type U T/C Pt 100 RTD 0-50 mV 0-5 V 0-10 V 0-20 mA* 4-20 mA*
Range -328 to 2372F (-200 to 1300C) -148 to 2192F (-100 to 1200C) -328 to 752F (-200 to 400C) 32 to 1112F (0 to 600C) -328 to 2372F (-200 to 1300C) 32 to 3092F (0 to 1700C) 32 to 3092F (0 to 1700C) 212 to 3272F (100 to 1800C) -328 to 1562F (-200 to 850C) -328 to 932F (-200 to 500C) -328 to 1112F (-200 to 600C) -999 to 9999 -999 to 9999 -999 to 9999 -999 to 9999 -999 to 9999
ACCESSORIES SCD-SW, Configuration Software A-277, 250 Ohm Precision Resistor MN-1, Mini-Node USB/RS-485 converter
*Requires 250 Ohm Precision Resistor. Modbus is a registered trademark of Schnieder Automation
80
CALL TO ORDER:
3.880 [98.5]
Linearized and isolated RTD and Thermocouple transmitters are part of the Series SC4000 Iso Verter II Signal Conditioning Modules. These modules completely isolate the input from the output and from ground. Compatible with industry standard 35 mm DIN Rail mount transmitters and isolators, these modules are easily applied in new or existing installations. The SC4380 Process Signal Converter/Isolator accepts virtually all standard process signals as an input, and isolates and retransmits the signal in either the same units or virtually any other standard process signal. The SC4380 can be field programmed for reverse or direct action and can receive and transmit single sided or bipolar* signals. Low Voltage units (SCL) are also available. The SC4151 RTD Transmitters each offer a fixed scale range input (selected when ordered) and a linearized, isolated, field selectable 4 to 20 mA or 0 to 10 VDC output. Output is selected by simple switch settings. Low Voltage units (SCL) are also available. The SC4130 Thermocouple Transmitter offers a fixed scale range input (selected when ordered) and a linearized, isolated, field selectable 4 to 20 mA or 0 to 10 VDC output. Output is selected by simple switch settings. Low Voltage units (SCL) are also available.
*Note: The term bipolar refers to an input or output that crosses zero volts. Certain devices have ranges that run from minus to plus voltages (eg. -1 to +5 VDC, -10 to +10 VDC, etc.). The SC4380 Iso Verter II can be set up to accept a bipolar signal input or provide a bipolar output.
SPECIFICATIONS Isolation: 1500 VAC RMS. Linearity: 0.1% of full scale. Drift: 0.02%/C typical, 0.05%/ C maximum. Power Supply: SC: 85 to 265 VDC/VAC 50 to 400 Hz; SCL: 12 to 24 VDC/VAC 50 to 400 Hz. Output Loads: Current: 600 ohms maximum Voltage: 500 ohms minimum (20 mA maximum). Input Characteristics: SC4380: Voltage: 1 megohms impedance, Current: 10 ohms; SC4151: RTD Search current < 500 A; SC4130: 3 megohms impedance. Case Size: 0.866 W (22.5 mm) x 2.950 H (75.0 mm) 3 3.880 D (98.5 mm). Mounting: Mounts on industry standard 35 mm DIN Rail (DIN EN50022-35).
OUTPUT TRANSDUCERS
APPLICATIONS Signal conditioners used in panels for isolation and converting signals for boilers and controls systems. To Order Use Range Code as Suffix: SC4130 & SCL4130
Model SC4130 Range Codes Model SCL4130 Range Codes
A = DIN, -100 to 200C B = DIN, 0 to 100C C = DIN, 0 to 150C D = DIN, 0 to 200F E = DIN, 0 to 200C F = DIN, 0 to 400F G = DIN, 0 to 250C H = DIN, 0 to 500F J = DIN, 0 to 500C K = DIN, 0 to 1000F
A = DIN, -100 to 200C B = DIN, 0 to 100C C = DIN, 0 to 150C D = DIN, 0 to 200F E = DIN, 0 to 200C F = DIN, 0 to 400F G = DIN, 0 to 250C H = DIN, 0 to 500F J = DIN, 0 to 500C K = DIN, 0 to 1000F
A = J, -100 to 200C C = J, 0 to 100C D = J, 0 to 500F E = J, 0 to 250C F = J, 0 to 750C G = J, 0 to 1000F H = K, -150 to 350F J = K, -100 to 200C K = K, 0 to 500F L = K, 0 to 250C M = K, 0 to 1000F N = K, 0 to 500C P = K, 0 to 2000F R = K, 0 to 1000C S = T, -300 to 250F T = T, -200 to 200C
A = J, -100 to 200C C = J, 0 to 100C D = J, 0 to 500F E = J, 0 to 250C F = J, 0 to 750C G = J, 0 to 1000F H = K, -150 to 350F J = K, -100 to 200C K = K, 0 to 500F L = K, 0 to 250C M = K, 0 to 1000F N = K, 0 to 500C P = K, 0 to 2000F R = K, 0 to 1000C S = T, -300 to 250F T = T, -200 to 200C
Current 0 to 5 mA 0 to 10 mA 0 to 10 mA 0 to 20 mA 0 to 50 mA 0 to 100 mA 1 to 5 mA 4 to 20 mA 10 to 50 mA
Current 0 to 1 mA 0 to 5 mA 0 to 20 mA 1 to 5 mA 4 to 20 mA
Voltage 0 to 1 V 0 to 5 V 0 to 10 V 1 to 5 V 2 to 10 V
SC4130 & SCL4130* Thermocouple Transmitters SC4151 & SCL4151* RTD Transmitters SC4380 & SCL4380* Iso Verter II Process Signal Converter/Isolators
*SCL models are low voltage units.
CALL TO ORDER:
81
Model MN-1
3-13/64 [81.36]
57/64 [22.62]
The Model MN-1 Mini-Node Communication Signal Converter is a low cost device that converts half duplex RS-485 serial communications signals into a signal that can be read by any computer with a USB port. The integral USB connector and RJ-45 connector reduces set up time by eliminating extra wiring. The Model MN-1 is powered via the USB connection which eliminates the need for an external power source. The compact size is great for field installation, control panels, and lab testing.
OUTPUT TRANSDUCERS
SPECIFICATIONS Power Requirements: No external power required. Power Consumption: 0.4 W. Isolated Voltage: 3000 VDC. Input Impedance: 96 k. USB Connector: B-Type (Female). RS-485 Connector: RJ-45. Baud Rate: 75, 150, 300, 600, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, and 115200 bps. Compatibility: Full compliance with USB V.2.0 specification.
Series IP
1-7/16 [36.58]
1-1/2 [38.10]
The Series IP Current to Pressure Transducer converts a current input signal to a linearly proportional pneumatic output pressure. The features include built-in volume booster, low air consumption, field reversible (provides output which is inversely proportional to input signal) and flexible zero and span adjustments. The rugged NEMA 4X enclosure allows splashdown and outdoor installation. The IP can be used for applications that require operation of valve actuators, pneumatic valve positioners, damper and louver actuators, final control elements and relays. Model Number IP-42 IP-43 IP-44 Input Ranges 4-20 mA 4-20 mA 4-20 mA Output Range kPa psi 20-100 3-15 20-185 3-27 40-200 6-30
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Oil free, clean dry air filtered to 40 microns. Input Signal: 4-20 mA. Input Impedance: IP-42: 180 ohms; IP-43 and IP-44: 220 ohms. Air Pressure: Minimum: 3 psig (21 kPa) above maximum output; Maximum: 100 psig (700 kPa). Linearity: <0.75% of span. Hysteresis: <1% of span. Repeatability: <0.5% of span. Supply Pressure Sensitivity: <0.1% of span per psig (<0.15% of span per 10 kPa). Power Requirements: Loop-powered.
Temperature Limits: -20 to 140F (-30 to 60C). Pressure Connections: 1/4 female NPT. Electrical Connection: 1/2 female NPT. Air Consumption: 0.03 SCFM (0.5 m3/h) typical. Output Capacity: 4.5 SCFM (7.6 m3/h ANR) at 25 psig (175 kPa) supply; 12 SCFM (20 m3/h) at 100 psig (700 kPa) supply. Relief Capacity: 2 SCFM (3.4 m3/h) at 5 psig (35 kPa) above 20 psig (140 kPa) setpoint. Weight: 2.1 lb (0.94 kg). Agency Approvals: CE, FM.
82
CALL TO ORDER:
Series EPTA
Electro-Pneumatic Transducer
Low Cost, Selectable Input/Output, Manual Override
1/2 [12.7] 27/32 [21.43]
3-27/64 [86.92]
3-1/4 [82.55]
PWR C Sig FB OV OV
EPTA-B
4-5/16 [109.54] 3-25/64 [86.12]
4-1/16 [103.19]
SPAN OFFSET
0-10 PSI 0-15 PSI 0-20 PSI 10V 15V 20mA
POWER
PWR C SIG FB OV OV MANUAL
0%
4-15/32 [113.5]
5V
100%
AUTO
MANUAL
23/64 [9.13]
1-23/64 [34.53]
OUTPUT TRANSDUCERS
EPTA-S
The Series EPTA is an electric to pneumatic transducer that converts an analog input signal to a linearly proportionate pneumatic output by modulating its control valves to regulate branch line pressure to the set point determined by the input signal. All models incorporate two low voltage valves, an integral inbarb filter, a 0 to 30 psi analog gauge, an anodized aluminum manifold, and brass barbed fittings. The EPTA offers adjustable span and offset as well as manual override. This unit has no air consumption and is immune to mounting orientation. Output pressure ranges include field selectable 0 to 10, 0 to 15, and 0 to 20 psig. Also included is an analog 0 to 5 VDC feedback signal indicating the resultant branch line pressure. Universal 24 VAC/24 VDC supply voltage and field selectable 4 to 20 mA, 0 to 5 VDC, 0 to 10 VDC, or 0 to 15 VDC inputs ensure single unit compatibility with most systems. The standard models maintain branch pressure on power loss while the Fail-Safe models will drop the branch pressure to 0 psi on power loss. Mounting configurations include a metal bracket mount in the EPTA-B models and a snap-track mount in the EPTA-S models. The A-400 accessory kit will allow the EPTA-S models to be mounted on a standard DIN rail. APPLICATIONS Operation of valve actuators, positioners, damper and louver actuators. SPECIFICATIONS Service: Clean dry air or any inert gas. Input Signal: DC Current (4-20 mA) or DC Voltage (0-5/0-10/0-15). Input Impedance: Current: 250 ohms. Voltage: Infinite. Output Signal: Jumper selectable 0-10 psig (0-69 kPa), 0-15 psig (0-103 kPa), or 0-20 psig (0-138 kPa). Feedback Output: 0 to 5 VDC. Air Supply: 25 psig (172 kPa) maximum. Air Flow: 750 scim. Air Consumption: 0 scim normal operation, Fail-Safe model vents to 0 psi on power loss. Accuracy: 1.0% Full Scale @ room temperature. 2.0% Full Scale @ 32 to 120F (0 to 48.8C). Supply Voltage: 24 VDC (+10%/-5%) or 24 VAC (10%) 50/60 Hz. Supply Current: 180 mA maximum, 200 mA maximum on Fail-Safe model. Temperature Limits: Operating: 32 to 120F (0 to 48.8C). Storage: -20 to 150F (-6.7 to 65.6C). Operating Humidity Range: 5 to 95%, non-condensing. Pressure Connections: 1/4 O.D. (polyethylene tubing optimum). Electrical Connections: Plug-in Block Terminal type with 5mm pin spacing. Wire Size: Up to one 14 AWG per terminal. Weight: EPTA-S0: 6.9 oz. (196 g), EPTA-S1: 9.2 oz. (261 g), EPTA-B: 14.5 oz. (411 g).
Description Standard Snap-Track Mount Transducer Standard Metal Bracket Mount Transducer Snap-Track Mount Transducer with Fail-Safe Metal Bracket Mount Transducer with Fail-Safe
ACCESSORIES A-400, DIN Mounting Kit A-403, Replacement Integral Barb Filter
CALL TO ORDER:
83
Series 476A Single Pressure Digital Manometer & Series 478A Digital Manometer
Electronic Zeroing, 1.5% Accuracy
One-Button Auto-Zero Function Auto Power Off. Large, Easy-to-Read Display. Extruded Aluminum Case. Instant Selection from up to Eight English/Metric Units.
Ideal for field or laboratory use, the Model 476A Single Pressure Digital Manometer measures low pressures from -20 to 20 w.c. with 1.5% full scale accuracy. Designed especially for the HVAC contractor, the Model 476A can be used to set supply pressures, verify pressure switch operation, adjust regulators, check pneumatic systems and computer peripherals. The rugged, handheld unit is constructed with an extruded aluminum case for exceptional durability. The Series 478A manometer can be used to measure positive, negative, or differential pressures. The unit features selectable units, auto zero, hold and a Min/Max function. Press the Hold key to freeze the current pressure measurement on the display. The 478A manometer includes a zeroing button to null out any minor pressure differences.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and compatible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Accuracy: 1.5% F.S. at 72F (22.2C). Includes linearity and repeatability. Pressure Hysteresis: 0.1% of F.S. Pressure Limits: 5 psig (.74 bar). Temperature Limits: 0 to 140F (-17.8 to 60C). Compensated Temperature Limits: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C). Thermal Effect: 0.05% F.S./F. Display: 4 digit LCD (.425H x .234W digits). Power Requirements: 9V alkaline battery. Battery included but not connected. Process Connections: For use with 3/16 or 1/4 I.D. tubing. Weight: 10.8 oz (306 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
A-402A CARRYING CASE Tough gray nylon pouch protects any Series 476A/478A Manometer. Double zippered for quick and easy access. With belt loop that snaps closed. 7-1/2H x 3W x 2-1/4D (191 x 76 x 57 mm)
TEST EQUIPMENT
Available Pressure Units Model Range Resolution Maximum Number in w.c. Pressure in Hg kPa in w.c. mm Hg mbar mm w.c. in w.c. bar psi 476A-0 -20.0 to 20.0 .0498 0.723 1.471 4.98 20.00 37.4 5 psig 49.8 508 0.02
Model Number 478A-0 478A-1
Available Pressure Range in Hg kPa in w.c. mm Hg mbar psi bar in w.c. 7.47 9.96 .1445 .294 0.996 4.00 -4.00 to 4.00 112.1 149.5 -60.0 to 60.0 .1495 2.168 4.41 14.95 60.0
Units
mm w.c. Pa 996 101.6 1524
84
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 475
New LOW Range Option 0-1.000 in. w.c. Measures Positive, Negative and Differential Pressures Rugged, Extruded Aluminum Case Lightweight, Fast and Easy to Use Selectable English/Metric Units FM Approved
The Dwyer Series 475-FM Mark III Handheld Digital Manometer is ideal for field calibration, monitoring or trouble shooting HVAC systems, clean rooms, or a wide range of other low pressure pneumatic systems. This handy instrument measures positive, negative or differential pressures of air and natural gases in ranges from 1 in. w.c. (0.249 kPa) to 150 psid (10.34 bar). The Series 475-FM is approved and is intrinsically safe for hazardous locations, Class 1, Div. 1, Group A, B, C, D, T4. Its simple operation and easy to read digital display make it an indispensable test instrument for the plant engineer, industrial hygienist and HVAC technician. When used with a Dwyer Pitot tube (see Flow and Air Velocity), the Series 475-FM Mark III can also be used as an air velocity gage. See the complete 475-1-FM-AV kit described below. The Series 475-FM Mark III is housed in a durable extruded aluminum case with its solid state circuitry mounted on a tough fiberglass epoxy circuit board. To meet the most demanding applications and to provide stability of instrument reading, the 1 in. w.c. range is compensated for position sensitivity through the use of a unique patented dual sensor system. A standard 9 volt battery provides up to 100 hours of operation. Dual push pads on the front panel control on-off, auto zero, and pressure unit selection. No set-up or leveling. The large 0.42 LCD display is easy to read, minimizing data collection errors. Units include a low battery indicator. The pressure sensor used is a highly stable silicon piezoresistive device. Standard connections are dual sized for 1/8" or 3/16" I.D. vinyl or rubber tubing. Complete instructions are conveniently printed on rear of housing.
APPLICATIONS Field calibration Monitoring or trouble shooting HVAC systems Clean room checks Air velocity monitoring with Dwyer Pitot Tube Natural gas appliance line pressure
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and compatible combustible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Accuracy: 0.5% F.S., 60 to 78F (15.6 to 25.6C); 1.5% F.S. from 32 to 60F and 78 to 104F (0 to 15.6C and 25.6 to 40C). Pressure Hysteresis: 0.1% of full scale. Pressure Limits: See chart. Temperature Limits: 0 to 140F (-17.8 to 60C). Compensated Temperature Limits: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C). Storage Temperature Limits: -4 to 176F (-20 to 80C). Display: 0.42 (10.6 mm) 4 digit LCD. Resolution: See chart. Power Requirements: 9 volt alkaline battery. Battery not connected. Weight: 10.8 oz (306 g). Connections: Two barbed connections for use with 1/8 (3.18 mm) or 3/16 (4.76 mm) I.D. tubing. Two compression fittings for use with 1/8 (3.18 mm) I.D. x 1/4 (6.35 mm) O.D. tubing for 475-7-FM & 475-8-FM only. Agency Approvals: FM, CE.
TEST EQUIPMENT
A-402A Carrying Case Tough gray nylon pouch protects any Series 475 Manometer. Double zippered for quick and easy access. With belt loop that snaps closed. 7-1/2H x 3W x 2-1/4D (191 x 76 x 57 mm)
Model Number
475-000-FM 475-00-FM 475-0-FM 475-1-FM 475-2-FM 475-3-FM 475-4-FM 475-5-FM 475-6-FM 475-7-FM 475-8-FM
English Range
0-1.000 in w.c. 0-4.000 in w.c. 0-10.00 in w.c. 0-20.00 in w.c. 0-40.00 in w.c. 0-200.0 in w.c. 0-10.00 psi 0-20.00 psi 0-30.00 psi 0-100.0 psi 0-150.0 psi
Metric Range
.2491 kPa 0.996 kPa 2.491 kPa 4.982 kPa 9.96 kPa 49.82 kPa .6895 bar 1.379 bar 2.069 bar 6.895 bar 10.34 bar
Maximum Pressure
5 psig 5 psig 5 psig 10 psig 10 psig 30 psig 30 psig 60 psig 60 psig 150 psig 200 psig
475-AV AIR VELOCITY KIT Includes the Series 475-FM Manometer, two A-303 static pressure tips two 9 ft. lengths 3/16 I.D. rubber tubing, no. 166-6CF Pitot tube, A-397 step drill, A-532 air velocity slide chart and instruction bulletin H-11, all packed in a tough, molded plastic carrying case with die cut foam liner. To order, add AV suffix to any standard 475 model no. Example: 475-1-FM-AV
CALL TO ORDER:
85
Series 477
Selectable Pressure Units, 0.5% Accuracy, FM Approved Intrinsically Safe for Hazardous Locations, Class 1, Div. 1, Group A, B, C, D, T4
New Low Pressure Ranges USB Option Comes with Cable and Software for Easy Data Downloading. Instant Selection from up to Nine English/Metric Units. Stores 40 Readings in Memory for Later Reference. Measure Positive, Negative or Differential Pressures. Large Easy-to-Read 0.4" LCD Display Includes Switchable Backlight for Great Visibility Anywhere! Both Audible and Visual Overpressure Alarms. Includes + and - Indicators plus Low Battery Warning. Operates up to 100 Hours on a Single 9 Volt Battery. Series 477 Handheld Digital Manometers are packed with features you need to make pressure measurement and recording faster, easier and more accurate than ever. First, you can instantly select from up to nine of the most widely used pressure units without having to waste time and risk mistakes with tedious conversions. Next, a non-volatile memory function enables storage of up to 40 readings perfect for HVAC technicians making Pitot tube traverses of airflow readings across a duct. The FM approved models are intrinsically safe for hazardous locations, Class 1, Div. 1, Group A, B, C, D, T4. When working in poorly lighted areas, just switch on the handy backlight feature. It automatically shuts itself off after 20 minutes to minimize battery drain. Electronic zeroing means you simply touch a single key to perfectly null out any minor pressure differences. A display HOLD key freezes the current pressure for those all-too-common situations where readings fluctuate. We even included an audible alarm to warn you of overpressure plus a visual alarm warning in case ambient noise levels are too high to hear the alarm. Audible alarm also confirms a value has been stored, eliminating the need to observe display during a duct traverse. A new option for the Series 477 is a USB interface. Combined with the 477s datalogging capability, a user can now quickly and conveniently download the stored readings to any USB compatible device. Data manipulation can be easily accomplished in a multitude of word processing or spreadsheet programs. USB models come with a USB cable and a software CD.
APPLICATIONS Field calibration Monitoring or trouble shooting HVAC systems Clean room checks Air velocity monitoring with Dwyer Pitot Tube Natural gas appliance line pressure
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and compatible gases. FM models air and compatible combustible gases. Wetted Materials: Consult factory. Accuracy: 0.5% F.S., 60 to 78F (15.6 to 25.6C); 1.5% F.S. from 32 to 60F and 78 to 104F (0 to 15.6C and 25.6 to 40C). Pressure Hysteresis: 0.1% of full scale. Pressure Limits: See chart. Temperature Limits: 0 to 140F (-17.8 to 60C). Compensated Temperature Limits: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C). Storage Temperature Limits: -4 to 176F (-20 to 80C). Display: 0.42 (10.6 mm) 4 digit LCD. Response Time: 1 seconds. Resolution: See chart. Power Requirements: 9 volt alkaline battery. Battery included but not connected. Weight: 10.2 oz (289 g). Connections: Two barbed connections for use with 1/8 (3.18 mm) or 3/16 (4.76 mm) I.D. tubing. Two compression fittings for use with 1/8 (3.18 mm) I.D. x 1/4 (6.35 mm) O.D. tubing for 477-7-FM & 477-8-FM only. Agency Approvals: CE and FM, USB models are not FM approved Intrinsically safe.
A-402A Carrying Case Tough gray nylon pouch protects any Series 477 Manometer. Double zippered for quick and easy access. With belt loop that snaps closed.
TEST EQUIPMENT
Model Number*
kPa
.2491 0.996 2.491 4.982 9.96 49.82 68.95 137.9 206.9 689.5 1034
in w.c.
1.000 4.000 10.00 20.00 40.00 200.0 276.8 553.6 830.4 2768 4152
mm Hg
1.868 7.473 18.68 37.36 74.73 373.6 517.1 1034 1551 5171 7757
mbar
2.491 9.96 24.91 49.82 99.6 498.2 689.5 1379 2069 6895
mm w.c.
25.40 101.6 254.0 508.0 1016 5080 7031
Pa
249.1 996 2491 4982 9964
Maximum Pressure
5 psig 5 psig 5 psig 10 psig 10 psig 30 psig 30 psig 60 psig 60 psig 150 psig 200 psig
0-1.000 in w.c. 477-000-FM .1445 0-4.000 in w.c. 477-00-FM .3613 0-10.00 in w.c. 477-0-FM .0498 .7225 0-20.00 in w.c. 477-1-FM .0996 1.445 0-40.00 in w.c. 477-2-FM .4982 7.225 0-200.0 in w.c. 477-3-FM .6895 10.00 0-10.00 psi 477-4-FM 1.379 20.00 0-20.00 psi 477-5-FM 2.069 30.00 0-30.00 psi 477-6-FM 6.895 100.0 0-100.0 psi 477-7-FM 10.34 150.0 0-150.0 psi 477-8-FM *Note: USB models include a software CD and cable.
Change FM to USB. Example: 477-2-FM becomes 477-2-USB U.K. Phone (+44) (0)1494-461707 Asia Pacific Phone 61 2 4272-2055
86
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 477A
Measure Positive, Negative, or Differential Pressures. Instant Selection from up to Nine English/Metric Units. Stores 40 Readings in Memory for Later Reference. Both Audible and Visual Overpressure Alarms. Operates up to 100 Hours on a Single 9 Volt Battery. New Adjustable Damping Feature for Averaging Fluctuating Reading. The Popular Model 477 is now available with 0.1% full scale accuracy in the new Series 477A. The 477A contains a highly accurate differential pressure sensor that offers a 0.1% full scale accuracy on air ranges from 20 w.c. to 100 psid. Series 477A Handheld Digital Manometers are packed with features needed to make pressure measurement and recording faster, easier and more accurate than ever. Instantly select from up to nine of the most widely used pressure units without having to waste time and risk mistakes with tedious conversions. A non-volatile memory function enables storage of up to 40 readings perfect for HVAC technicians making Pitot tube traverses of airflow readings across a duct. The 477A is also ideal for maintenance personnel or technicians that require a highly accurate standard to check their instrumentation or equipment to ensure proper performance. When working in poorly lighted areas, just switch on the handy backlight feature. The manometer automatically shuts itself off after 20 minutes to minimize battery drain. Electronic zeroing means you simply touch a single key to perfectly null out any minor pressure differences. A display HOLD key freezes the current pressure for those all-too-common situations where readings fluctuate. Included is an audible alarm to warn of overpressure plus a visual alarm warning in case ambient noise levels are too high to hear the alarm. Audible alarm also confirms a value has been stored, eliminating the need to observe display during a duct traverse. Clear, concise operating instructions for all functions are printed on the rear of the rugged extruded aluminum case for quick reference. Onepiece front membrane fully protects all keys from dust and moisture; wipes clean in seconds. Detailed written instructions, a wrist strap and 9 volt alkaline battery are included. SPECIFICATIONS Service: Air and non-combustible compatible gases. Wetted Parts: Consult factory. Accuracy: 0.10% of full scale from 60 to 78F (15.6 to 25.6C); 1% of full scale from 32-60 and 78-104F (0-15.6 and 25.6-40C). Pressure Hysteresis: 0.1% of full scale. Pressure Limits: See chart. Temperature Limits: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C). Storage Temperature Limits: -4 to 176F (-20 to 80C). Display: 0.42 (10.6 mm) 4 digit LCD. Resolution: See chart. Power Requirements: 9 volt alkaline battery. Battery included but not connected. Weight: 10.2 oz. (289 g). Connections: Two barbed connections for use with 1/8 (3.18 mm) or 3/16 (4.76 mm) I.D. tubing for 477A-1, 477A-2, 477A-3, 477A-4 and 477A-5 only. Two compression fittings for use with 1/8 (3.18 mm) I.D. x 1/4 (6.35 mm) O.D. tubing for 477A-6 and 477A-7 only.
Maximum Pressure 3 psig 3 psig 15 psig 30 psig 60 psig 100 psig 200 psig
TEST EQUIPMENT
CALL TO ORDER:
87
Model BTK
The Model BTK Backflow Prevention Test Kit is capable of testing hydronic systems with test procedures including those recommended by ASSE, AWWA, CSA, FCCC, HR-USC and NEWWA. It possesses a quick release latch pin mechanism and a new manifold design. The tests can be performed with the gage mounted in the case or removed from the case. The BTK is comprised of five valves and is specially designed for testing backflow prevention assemblies. The 90micron filters protect the test kit to minimize plugging with scale and sand. Filter elements can be cleaned or replaced. The kit includes a diaphragm differential pressure gage (4.5, 0-15 psid), a line pressure gage (1.5, 0-200 psig), a 4 foot long bleed tube, three 5 foot long hoses (color-coded), three sets of brass adapter fittings provided for hookup to all standard size test cocks, and a durable molded polyethylene carrying case with removable lid.
SPECIFICATIONS Service: To test water systems for backflow. Wetted Materials: Gage: EP Elastomers, Brass and 316 SS Metal Parts; Hose: Buna-N jacket and liner; Fittings: Brass. Housing Material: Gage: Glass Reinforced Engineered Thermoplastic; Case: Polyethylene. Accuracy: 0.2 psid (Descending). Pressure Limits: Working pressure: 200 psig. Temperature Limits: Maximum 150F (65C). * Freezing Temperatures must be avoided. Size: Dial: 4.5; Case: 16 H x 14 W x 8 3/4 D (406.4 mm H x 355.6 mm W x 222.25 mm D). Weight: Gage: 3.6 lb (1.6 kg); Gage & Case combined: 11.6 lb (5.2 kg).
TEST EQUIPMENT
Description Professional Test Clock Cleaning Tool 90 Swivel Quick Connection Test Clock Adapter with 1/4 NPT x 1/4 flare quick connect fittings, 1/2 NPT x 1/4 female NPT and 3/4 NPT x 1/4 FNPT quick connect fittings , and O-rings.
88
CALL TO ORDER:
Series 490
Series 490 Digital Manometers are versatile, hand-held, battery operated manometers available in several basic ranges for positive or positive differential pressure measurement and can tolerate most liquid media compatible with 316LSS. A memory function allows storage of up to 40 readings for later recall and a backlight provides auxiliary lighting for hard-to-see locations. Standard are a hold feature and both visual and audible overpressure alarms. A new feature added to the Series 490 is a field adjustable damping. This allows the user to choose the level of display averaging rate corresponding to the fluctuation level common in many applications. A 9V alkaline battery is included that provides up to 100 hours of operation.
APPLICATIONS Balance hydronic heating or cooling water loops Check pump or chiller performance Determine pressure head loss from valves and pipe reduction
OPTIONS -3V, 3-way Valve Package Note: Option only available on ranges up to 100 psi.
A-402A Carrying Case Tough gray nylon pouch protects any Series 490 Wet/Wet Handheld Digital Manometer. Double zippered for quick and easy access. With belt loop that snaps closed. 7-1/2H x 3W x 2-1/4D (191 x 76 x 57 mm)
Range 0-15.00 psi 0-30.00 psi 0-50.00 psi 0-100.0 psi 0-500.0 psi 0-200.0 psi
Available Pressure Units in Hg kPa FTWC in w.c. mm Hg mbar 30.54 103.4 34.60 415.2 775.7 1034 61.08 206.9 69.20 830.4 1551 2069 101.8 344.7 115.3 1384 2585 3447 203.6 689.5 230.7 2768 5171 6895 1018 3447 1153 407.2 1379 461.3 5536
Maximum Pressure 30 psig 60 psig 100 psig 200 psig 1000 psig 400 psig
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible gases & liquids. Wetted Materials: Type 316L SS. Accuracy: 0.5% F.S., 60 to 78F (15.6 to 25.6C); 1.5% F.S. from 32 to 60F and 78 to 104F (0 to 15.6C and 25.6 to 40C). Pressure Hysteresis: 0.1% of full scale. Pressure Limits: See chart. Temperature Limits: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C). Storage Temperature Limits: -4 to 176F (-20 to 80C). Display: 0.42 (10.6 mm) 4 digit LCD. Resolution: See chart. Power Requirements: 9 volt alkaline battery. Battery included but not connected. Weight: 14.1 oz (400 g). Connections: Two 1/8 (3.18 mm) female NPT. Agency Approvals: CE.
TEST EQUIPMENT
CALL TO ORDER:
89
3-11/16 (93.66)
The Series DPGA is the only economic digital pressure gage with selectable engineering units on the market. With its 1% accuracy and digital push-button zero, the DPGA is the perfect choice for digitally monitoring the pressures of air and compatible gases. The Series DPGW is the only economic digital pressure gage for liquids with the ability to select engineering units on the market. With its 1% accuracy and digital push-button zero, the DPGW is the perfect choice for digitally monitoring the pressures of compatible liquids and gases. APPLICATIONS Ideal for checking line pressures at system startup
SPECIFICATIONS Service: DPGA: Air and compatible gases; DPGW: Liquids and compatible gases. Wetted Materials: DPGA: 316L SS, Silicone sensor; DPGW: 316L SS. Housing Materials: ABS plastic. Accuracy: 1.0% F.S. (Includes linearity, hysteresis, repeatability). Pressure Limits: 2X pressure range. Vacuum range max. pressure is 30 psig. Temperature Limits: 30 to 120F (-1 to 49C). Thermal Effect: 0.05% FS/F. Size: 2.62 O.D. x 1.52 deep. Process Connections: 1/4 male NPT. Display: 4-digit LCD (.425 H x .234 W digits). Power Requirements: 9 volt alkaline battery. Battery included but not connected. Auto Shut-off: 20 minute auto shut-off. Weight: 5.6 oz (160 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
Model Number DPGA-00 DPGA-01 DPGA-02 DPGA-03 DPGA-04 DPGA-05 DPGA-06 DPGA-07 DPGA-08 DPGA-09 DPGA-10 DPGA-11 Model Number DPGW-00 DPGW-04 DPGW-05 DPGW-06 DPGW-07 DPGW-08 DPGW-09 DPGW-10 DPGW-11
Range 30 Hg to 0 (vac) 0 to 20 w.c. 0 to 1 psi 0 to 2 psi 0 to 5 psi 0 to 15 psi 0 to 30 psi 0 to 50 psi 0 to 100 psi 0 to 200 psi 0 to 300 psi 0 to 500 psi
psi -14.70 0.722 1.000 2.000 5.000 15.00 30.00 50.00 100.0 200.0 300.0 500.0
kg/cm4 -1.033 .0508 .0703 .1406 .3515 1.055 2.109 3.515 7.03 14.06 21.09 35.15
bar -1.013 .0498 .0689 .1379 .3447 1.034 2.068 3.447 6.89 13.79 20.68 34.47
in Hg -29.93 1.471 2.036 4.072 10.18 30.54 61.1 101.8 203.6 407.2 611 1018
ft wc -33.94 1.667 2.307 4.614 11.53 34.60 69.2 115.3 230.7 461.3 692 1153
Pressure Ranges kPa oz/in4 in wc -101.4 -235.2 -407.3 4.980 11.55 20.00 6.89 16.00 27.68 13.79 32.00 55.4 138.4 34.47 80.0 103.4 240.0 415.2 206.8 480.0 830 1384 344.7 800 2768 689 1600 1379 3200 2068 4800 3447
Resolution psi 0.01 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.002 0.01 0.01 0.02 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.2 Resolution psi 0.01 0.002 0.01 0.01 0.02 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.2
TEST EQUIPMENT
Range 30 Hg to 0 (vac) 0 to 5 psi 0 to 15 psi 0 to 30 psi 0 to 50 psi 0 to 100 psi 0 to 200 psi 0 to 300 psi 0 to 500 psi
psi -14.70 5.000 15.00 30.00 50.00 100.0 200.0 300.0 500.0
kg/cm4 -1.033 .3515 1.055 2.109 3.515 7.03 14.06 21.09 35.15
Pressure Ranges oz/in4 in Hg ft wc kPa bar -1.013 -29.93 -33.94 -101.4 -235.2 .3447 10.18 11.53 34.47 80.0 1.034 30.54 34.60 103.4 240.0 206.8 480.0 2.068 61.1 69.2 3.447 101.8 115.3 344.7 800 6.89 203.6 230.7 689 1600 13.79 407.2 461.3 1379 3200 2068 4800 20.68 611 692 34.47 1018 1153 3447
30 Hg-0-100 psi
90
CALL TO ORDER:
Series DPG-100
3-5/8 [91.39]
1/4 NPT
Replace your outdated analog gages with the new Series DPG-100 Digital Pressure Gage. The Series DPG-100 has a high 0.25% full scale accuracy. The 4 digit digital display will reduce the potential for errors in readings by eliminating parallax error commonly produced with analog gages. Series DPG-100 is battery powered and has an auto-shut off to conserve battery life. Battery life, on average, will last 2000 hours. A 4 button key pad allows easy access to features without the need to work through complex menus or difficult key combinations. These features include backlight, peak and valley, tare or auto zero and conversion of the pressure units. APPLICATIONS Line pressure verification Confirm proper performance of installed analog gages
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible liquids and combustible gases (for FM listing see Agency Approvals below. Some ranges not FM approved. See model chart). Wetted Materials: Type 316L SS. Housing Materials: Black Polycarbonate front & back cover, anodized aluminum extruded housing with recessed grooves, Polycarbonate overlay, Buna-N O-rings, 316L SS sensor construction. Accuracy: 0.25% F.S. +/- 1 least significant digit @ 70F (21C) (Includes linearity, hysteresis, repeatability). Pressure Limit: 2x pressure range for models 1000 psi; 5000 psi for 3000 psi range; 7500 psi for 5000 psi range. Enclosure Rating: Designed to meet NEMA 4/4X (IP66). Temperature Limits: 0 to 130F (-18 to 55C). Thermal Effect: Between 70 to 130F is 0.016%/F. Between 32 to 70F is 0.026%/F. Between 10 to 32F is 0.09%/F. Size: 3.00 OD x 1.90 deep (max). Process Connection: 1/4 male NPT. Weight: 8.84 oz (275 g). Display: 4 digit (.425 H x .234 W digits). Power Requirements: Two AAA batteries. Battery Life: 2000 hours typical; Low battery indicator. Auto Shut-Off: Gage: 60 minute auto shut off. Auto shut-off may be disengaged. Backlight: 2 minute auto shut-off. Agency Approvals: CE, FM approved to be intrinsically safe for Class I, Division I, Groups A, B, C and D, for ranges 0-15 to 0-3000 psi.
TEST EQUIPMENT
Model Number DPG-100* DPG-102 DPG-103 DPG-104 DPG-105 DPG-106 DPG-107 DPG-108 DPG-109 DPG-110 DPG-111*
Range psi -14.70-0 15.00 30.00 50.00 100.0 200.0 300.0 500.0 1000 3000 5000
kg/cm2 -1.033 1.055 2.109 3.515 7.03 14.06 21.09 35.15 70.3 210.9 351.5
bar -1.013 1.034 2.069 3.448 6.895 13.79 20.69 34.48 68.98 206.9 344.8
in Hg -29.93 30.54 61.08 101.8 203.6 407.2 610.8 1018 2036 6108
Pressure Ranges ft wc oz/in2 kPa -33.94 -235.2 -101.4 34.61 240 103.4 69.21 480 206.9 115.4 800 344.8 230.7 1600 689.5 461.4 3200 1379 692.1 4800 2069 1154 8000 3448 2307 6895 6921
Compound Ranges Available: DPG-120* Range: 30 Hg-0-15 psi; DPG-121* Range: 30 Hg-0-30 psi; DPG-122* Range: 30 Hg-0-45 psi; DPG-123*: Range 30 Hg-0-60 psi; DPG-124*: 30 Hg-0-100 psi.
* Models DPG-100, DPG-111, DPG-120, DPG-121, DPG-122, DPG-123 and DPG-124 are not FM approved.
CALL TO ORDER:
91
Model PHP
Model PHP-1, Pneumatic Hand Pump ACCESSORIES Model PHP-1K, Service Kit Model PHP-1C, Hard Case
SPECIFICATIONS Output Ranges: -28.5 Hg to 600 psi (-0.960 to 40 bar). Process Connection: 1/4 female NPT (quick fit). Gage Connection: 1/4 female NPT. Materials: Nickel plated brass, anodized aluminum, and nylon. Weight: 1.4 lb (0.65 kg).
Series CHP
TEST EQUIPMENT
The Series CHP Pneumatic Hand Pump is the most dependable and rugged pump for applications up to 100 psi or 28.8 Hg Vacuum. The durable Acetel plastic and anodized aluminum construction prevents body heat transfer, resulting in drift-free, accurate readings. The Series CHP is equipped with oversized check valves in order to provide smooth and controlled operation. Dual O-Rings on all pistons ensure the pump to be leak-free. The unit includes a 2 foot long hose, 1/8 female NPT gauge fitting, and 1/8 NPT pipe plug. An optional hose kit is available so that a tee is not required when connecting a sensor and a calibrator. The Series CHP is ideal for checking calibration of pressure or vacuum gauges, switches, or transmitters.
SPECIFICATIONS Output Range: CHP-P: 0 to 100 psi; CHP-V: 0 to -28.8 Hg. Process Connection: Two 1/8 female NPT ports, one with a removable plug. Materials: Acetel plastic and anodized aluminum. Pressure Limit: 150 psig (10.34 bar). Temperature Limit: Not to exceed 150F (65.6 C). Displaced Volume: Approximately 4 in3. Dimensions: 9 length x 1.5 diameter. Weight: 1.5 lb (680 g).
Model CHP-P, Pressure Calibration Pump Model CHP-V, Vacuum Calibration Pump
92
CALL TO ORDER:
Model 475-1T-FM-AV
Convenient all-in-one kit is small, light and easy to use. No set-up or leveling needed. Digital manometer reads from 0-19.99 in. w.c. with 0.5% F.S. accuracy and minor divisions to 0.01. Large 12" LCD readout is easy to see in poorly lighted areas and has low battery warning. Kit includes convenient telescoping Pitot tube, Model 166T, fully adjustable from 11.5 to 36 inches (29.2 to 91.4 cm). Also, two static pressure tips with magnetic mounting measure pressure drop across filters, condenser coils, etc. Kit comes complete with rubber tubing, 9V battery, step drill, AV calculator slide rule, and custom fitted carrying case. An indispensable test kit for the plant engineer, and HVAC technician that must balance system air flows at start-up.
475-1T-FM-AV Air Velocity Kit
Complete Kit Includes: Model 475-1 Digital Manometer, range 0-19.99 in. w.c. Model 166T, 36" Telescoping Stainless Steel Pitot Tube Two No. A-303 Static Pressure Tips with Magnetic Mounting Two 4 1/2 Ft. Lengths 3/16" I.D. Rubber Tubing No. A-397 Step Drill for 3/16"-1/2" Holes in 1/16" Increments No. A-532 AV Slide Chart 9 Volt Battery Fitted Polyethylene Case
TEST EQUIPMENT
Model 477-1T-FM-AV
Convenient all-in-one kit is small, light and easy to use. No set-up or leveling needed. Digital manometer reads from 0-20 in. w.c. with 0.5% F.S. accuracy. The Series 477 stores up to 20 readings in memory for later reference, instantly selecting up to nine English/Metric pressure units that are visible on a large, backlit 0.4" LCD readout. Both audible and visual overpressure alarms and a low battery warning are standard features. Each kit includes convenient telescoping Pitot tube, Model 166T which is fully adjustable from 11.5 to 36 inches (29.2 to 91.4 cm). In addition, two static pressure tips with magnetic mountings measure pressure drop across filters, condenser coils, etc. Kit comes complete with rubber tubing, 9V battery, step drill, AV calculator slide rule, and custom fitted carrying case. An indispensable test kit for the plant engineer, and HVAC technician that must balance system air flows at start-up..
477-1T-FM-AV Air Velocity Kit
Complete Kit Includes: Model 477-1 Digital Manometer, range 0-20 in. w.c. Model 166T, 36" Telescoping Stainless Steel Pitot Tube Two No. A-303 Static Pressure Tips with Magnetic Mounting Two 4 1/2 Ft. Lengths 3/16" I.D. Rubber Tubing No. A-397 Step Drill for 3/16" - 1/2" Holes in 1/16" Increments No. A-532 AV Slide Chart 9 Volt Battery Fitted Polyethylene Case
CALL TO ORDER:
93
Series 471
Digital Thermo-Anemometer
Three Models, Four Field Selectable Ranges, 3% F.S. Accuracy
Model 471-1
TEST EQUIPMENT
The Series 471 Digital Thermo Anemometers are versatile dual function instruments that quickly and easily measure air velocity in four field selectable ranges, in either feet per minute or meters per second, plus air temperature in F or C. High contrast LCD display shows both range selected and present velocity. Convenient backlight provides perfect visibility in low light conditions. Light automatically shuts off after 2-1/2 minutes to prolong battery life. Low battery warning is included. Stainless steel probe with comfortable hand grip is etched with insertion depth marks from 0-8 inches and 0-20 cm on the Model 471-1. When fully extended, the probe length on models 471-2 and 471-3 reach 33 inches (83 cm). Model 471-3 features a telescoping bendable probe for easy access in hard-to-reach locations. Extruded aluminum housing fully protects electronics, yet is lightweight and comfortable to hold even when taking multiple readings as part of duct traverses. An integral sliding cover protects sensors when not in use. Standard accessories are 9 volt alkaline battery, wrist strap, custom fitted carrying case and step drill for making duct holes from 3/16 to 1/2.
SPECIFICATIONS AIR VELOCITY SPECIFICATIONS: Service: Air. Range: Field Selectable 0-500, 0-1500, 0-5000, 0-15000 FPM (see chart for Metric Conversions). Accuracy: Depending on range (See chart) @ 59 to 86F (15 to 30C). Outside this range add 0.11% per F (0.2% per C). Temperature Limits: Probe: 0 to 200F (-18 to 100C). Ambient: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C). Display: 4-1/2 Digit 0.4 High. Resolution: 1 FPM / 0.1 MPS. Response Time: 15 Seconds. Power Requirements: 9 volt alkaline battery, included. Probe: 5/16 (8.13 mm) diameter probe with integral hand grip and 6 ft. (15.2 cm) coiled cord. Length of probe: Model 471-1 = 10 (25.4 cm); Models 471-2 and 471-3 = 33 (83 cm) extended. Weight: 12 oz (340 g). TEMPERATURE SPECIFICATIONS: Range: 0 to 200F (-18 to 100C). Accuracy: 2F (1C). Temperature Limits: Probe: 0 to 200F (-18 to 100C). Ambient: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C). Display: 4-1/2 Digit 0.4 high. Resolution: 0.1. Response Time: 30 Seconds. Model 471-1 Digital Thermo Anemometer includes battery, wrist strap, 6-step drill, carrying case and instructions. Model 471-2 Digital Thermo Anemometer with telescoping probe includes battery, wrist strap, 6-step drill, carrying case and instructions. Model 471-3 Digital Thermo Anemometer with telescoping bendable tip includes battery, wrist strap, 6-step drill, carrying case and instructions.
APPLICATIONS Air flow readings in ducts Room or zone air flow and temperature balancing Fan performance Check register or diffuser face velocities
Velocity, FPM
0-500 0-1500 0-5000 0-15000
Velocity, MPS
0-3.0 0-7.0 0-30 0-75
Accuracy
3% F.S. 3% F.S. 4% F.S. 5% F.S.
94
CALL TO ORDER:
Model VT120
1.400 [35.56]
THERMO-ANEMOMETER
3.000 [76.20]
2.600 [66.04]
VT 120
Simultaneously measure air velocity and temperature with the Model VT120 Integral Vane Thermo-Anemometer. Easily view readings on the large 1.25 (31.75 mm) dual display. User-selectable air velocity ranges include ft/min, m/sec, mph, knots, and km/hr. Built-in thermistor records ambient temperature in F or C. Model VT120 features include data hold and record/recall minimum, maximum and average readings. Also, units have the ability to record and average up to 2 hours of data while displaying the continuous running average. If desired, sleep mode automatically shuts down the meter after 20 minutes of non-use. Model VT120 includes hard carry case, one 9V battery, and instruction manual. Model VT120 Integral Vane Thermo-Anemometer Model VT120-N includes NIST certification APPLICATIONS Air duct measurement and analysis, fume hood analysis, ionizer flow output monitoring, positive pressure reading in clean rooms, or ventilation system inspection.
SPECIFICATIONS Air Velocity Ranges: 80 to 5900 ft/min, 0.4 to 30 m/sec, 0.9 to 68 mph, 0.8 to 58 knots, 1.4 to 108 km/hr. Temperature Range: 14 to 122F (-10 to 50C). Accuracy: Air velocity: 3%, Temperature: 1F (0.6C). Resolution: 1 ft/min, 0.01 m/sec, 0.1 mph, 0.1 knots, 0.1 km/hr, 0.1F, 0.1C. Temperature Sensor: Thermistor.
ON-OFF
SET-UP
UNITS
Temperature Limits: 14 to 122F (-10 to 50C) max 80% RH. Power Supply: One 9V battery. Battery Life: 100 hours continuous (with 20 min sleep mode enabled). Display: Large 1.25 x 1.62 (37 x 42 mm) LCD, 9999 count. Housing: ABS plastic. Sensor Diameter: 2.87 (70 mm). Weight: 1.5 lb (680 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
Model VT-200
Vane Thermo-Anemometer
Measures Air Volume, Air Velocity, and Temperature, Built-in Datalogging
TEST EQUIPMENT
2.375 [121] 6.400 [162.56] 5.00 [127]
3.206 [81.4]
Model VT-200 Vane Thermo-Anemometer is ideal for balancing air conditioning and heating ducts or checking the operation of fans and blowers. Model VT-200 measures air volume in cubic feet per minute and cubic meters per minute. Air velocity measurements can be viewed in ft/min, m/s, knots, km/hr, and mph with 3% accuracy. The multifunction LCD can simultaneously display air velocity and temperature in selectable units or air flow and air area. Built-in datalogger can store up to 1000 measurements or transfer the data to a PC via RS-232 communication. Additional features include data hold and record/recall minimum, maximum and average readings. Model VT-200 includes RS-232 interface, PC Windows software, cable, 9V battery, carrying case, and instruction manual.
APPLICATIONS Verify fume hood flow performance Check diffuser of register face velocities
Model VT-200 Vane Thermo-Anemometer CALL TO ORDER: U.S. Phone 219 879-8000
SPECIFICATIONS Air Velocity Ranges: 0.3 to 45 m/s; 0.7 to 100 mph; 0.6 to 88.0 knots; 1 to 140.0 km/hr; 60 to 8,800 ft/min. Temperature Range: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Air Volume Ranges: CFM (ft3/min) or CMM (m3/min). Accuracy: Air Velocity: 3% of reading 0.1, whichever is greater; Temperature: 1.5 F (0.8C). Resolution: 0.1 knots, m/s, km/hr, and mph; 0.1/1 ft/min; 0.1C.
Temperature Sensor: Type K thermocouple. Temperature Limits: 32 to 140F (0 to 60C). Display: Dual line, 4-digit, 1.1 (27.9 mm) height. Power: 9V alkaline battery (included). Battery Life: Approx. 50 hours. Output: RS232 serial interface via DB9 female connector. Housing: ABS plastic, 1 (25 mm) diameter. Weight: 12.3 oz (350 g). Agency Approval: CE.
95
Model IR2
The Model IR2 Infrared Temperature Thermometer allows users to economically take accurate measurements in hard to reach areas. Measurements can be taken at a safe distance with a 12:1 Distance to Target Ratio. The IR2 easily takes measurements within 2% accuracy using a built-in laser sighting. The fixed emissivity of 0.95 is perfect for measuring surface temperatures of concrete, asphalt, rubber or oxidized metals. Besides reading the process temperature, the back lit display also reads the maximum temperature seen. Excellent for monitoring surface temperatures of air ducts, boilers, engines or light fixtures.
SPECIFICATIONS Measurement Range: -76 to 932F (-60 to 500C). Operating Range: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Accuracy: 2% of reading or 4F (2C), whichever is greater. Resolution: 0.1F/0.1C. Response Time: 1 second. Distance to Target: 12:1. Emissivity: 0.95 fixed. Battery Life: 2 AAA, 180 hours continuous use (auto power off after 15 seconds). Dimensions: 6.90 x 1.54 x 2.83 in (175.2 x 39.0 x 71.9 mm). Weight: 3.61 oz (102 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
Model IR4
TEST EQUIPMENT
For those long range applications, the IR4 Non Contact Infrared Thermometer is the perfect instrument. It has a distance to target ratio of 20:1 and laser sighting to accurately measure within 1% of reading. The adjustable emissivity allows this thermometer to measure the temperature of virtually any surface. There is no guessing when the battery is low as the IR4 has a battery indicator on its back lit display. This useful hand held has programmable low and high audible alarms built in. The IR4 accepts any K-type thermocouple to display both a IR and a contact reading simultaneously. MAX, MIN, DIF, and AVG can be displayed with a push of a button. Excellent for monitoring surface temperatures of air ducts, boilers, engines or light fixtures.
SPECIFICATIONS Measurement Range: -76 to 1400F (-70 to 760C). Operating Range: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Accuracy: 1% of reading or 1.8F (1C) whichever is greater. Resolution: 0.1F/0.1C. Response Time: 1 second. Distance to Target: 20:1 optics ratio. Emissivity Range: 0.95 default adjustable 0.05 to 1.00 emissivity. Additional Input: K-type thermocouple. Battery Life: 2 AAA typical, 180 hours continuous use (auto power off after 15 seconds). Dimensions: 6.9 x 1.54 x 2.83 in (175.2 x 39.0 x 71.9 mm). Weight: 6.31 oz (179 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
96
CALL TO ORDER:
Series IR6/IR7
9-1/8 [231.78]
5-59/64 [150.42]
The Series IR6/IR7 Dual Laser Extended Range Infrared Thermometer is ideal for accurately measuring surface temperatures from long distances. This feature packed handheld device allows the user to read the maximum, minimum, average, and differential readings. The high and low alarms give audible and visual indication of the process temperature. When taking measurements in dark areas, a built-in white light can be used to illuminate the measurement area. For long term measurements, the unit includes a dual magnetic base attachment that allows hands-free measurements. The IR6/IR7 monitors temperature of air ducts and lights in large rooms. NIST Certificate Model Number Distance to Target Ratio No IR6 30:1 No IR7 50:1 Yes IR6-NIST 30:1 Yes IR7-NIST 50:1
SPECIFICATIONS Measurement Range: IR6: -76 to 1600F (-60 to 900C); IR7: -76 to 1832F (-60 to 1000C). Operating Range: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Accuracy: 2% of readings or 4F (2C) whichever is greater. Resolution: 0.1F (0.1C). Response Time: 1 second.
Distance to Target: IR6: 30:1, IR7: 50:1. Emissivity: 0.95 Default adjustable 0.10 to 1.00 in 0.01 steps. Battery: 2 AAA, 180 hours continuous use. Units: User selectable F or C. Weight: 13.62 oz (386.1 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
Model TC10
3-1/2 [88.90]
2-1/32 [51.58]
Quickly and accurately measure temperature with the Model TC10 Digital Thermocouple Thermometer. The TC10 accepts any type K thermocouple and connects via a standard mini-connection. View temperature readings in F or C (field selectable) on the large 3-1/2 digit LCD. The 0.8 (20 mm) display is backlit for dark or low light conditions. Choose either 0.1 or 1 resolution each with the basic accuracy of 0.3%. Thermometers respond quickly to environmental changes by updating the readings 2.5 times every second. Rugged, water resistant design comes with a protective holster and standideal for field use. Additional features include low battery indication, MAX and HOLD functions. Units include protective holster, Type K thermocouple bead wire temperature probe, 9V battery and instruction manual. Model TC10 Digital Thermocouple Thermometer Model TC10-N includes NIST certification
SPECIFICATIONS Input: Type K (4 type K thermocouple bead probe included). Temperature Range: -58 to 2000F (-50 to 1300C). Accuracy: -58 to 2000F: (0.3% of reading + 2F); -50 to 1000C: (0.3% of reading + 1C); 1000 to 1300C: (0.5% of reading + 1C). Display: 0.8 (20 mm) height, 3 1/2 digit LCD with switchable back light. Resolution: Selectable 1 or 0.1. Response Time: 1 second.
Temperature Limits: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C) max 80% RH. Storage Temperature: -4 to 140F (-20 to 60C) max 70% RH. Power Requirements: Standard 9V battery (included). Battery Life: 200 hours typical. Input Protection: 24V rms. Thermocouple Connection: Standard (F) mini-connector. Housing: ABS plastic. Weight: 12.9 oz (365 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
CALL TO ORDER:
97
Series 485
Digital Hygrometer
Measures % RH and Temperature
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Humidity & temperature detection in air. Range: Relative Humidity: 0 to 100% (non-condensing); Temperature: 22 to 185F (30 to 85C). Accuracy: Relative Humidity: 2%; Temperature: 1F (0.5C). Display: Dual 4.5 digit LCD. Temperature 0.4 High, RH: 0.2 High. Temperature Limits: Probe: -22 to 185F (30 to 85C). Ambient: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C). Resolution: Relative Humidity: 0.1%; Temperature: 0.1. Power Requirements: 9V alkaline battery (included). Probe: 485-2 only 8-5/8 (219 mm). Weight: 12 oz (340 g).
Model 485-2
Model 485-1
Model 485 Digital Hygrometer is a versatile, compact, hand-held instrument for measuring percentage of relative humidity and temperature in F or C. Dew point and wet bulb temperature is derived from relative humidity and temperature measurements and displayed on the 0.4 LCD display. Hold key freezes the current temperature and relative humidity readings for situations where readings fluctuate. Store up to 25 readings with the nonvolatile memory function ideal for technicians needing to take multiple readings for later analysis.
Model 485-1 Digital Hygrometer Model 485-2 Digital Hygrometer w/Remote Probe
ACCESSORY A-402A Carrying Case Tough grey nylon pouch protects Series 485 Digital Hygrometer. Double zippered for quick and easy access. With belt loop that snaps closed. 7-1/2H x 3W x 2-1/4D (191x76x57 mm)
Series TH
Thermohygrometer Pen
Dual Display, Compact Design
1.20 [30.5] 6.50 [165] 0.50 [14]
TEST EQUIPMENT
Simultaneously measure temperature and relative humidity with the Series TH Thermohygrometer Pen. This unit features a dual LCD, user selectable units of measure, MAX/MIN functions, reset and display hold. A built-in self calibration utility allows for field calibration using the optional relative humidity calibration reference. The Model TH-10 includes a pocket clip, battery and instruction manual. The optional kit, Model TH-10K, includes thermohygrometer pen with 33% and 75% RH calibration standards and a hard vinyl carrying case.
SPECIFICATIONS Range: RH: 10 to 90%, Temp: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Accuracy: RH: 5%, Temp: 1.5F or C. Display: Dual 3 digit LCD. Resolution: RH: 1%; Temp: 0.1F or C. Response Time: Temp: 1 sec; RH: 1 min 80% of change. Compensated Temperature Range: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Power Requirements: 3V Lithium (CR2032) battery (included). Weight: 2.3 oz (65 g). Agency Approvals: CE. Model TH-10 Thermohygrometer Pen Model TH-10K Thermohygrometer Pen Kit
ACCESSORIES Model TH-CAL, 33% and 75% RH Calibration Standard
APPLICATIONS Measure temperature and humidity in greenhouses, clean rooms, drying rooms, HVAC, food, pharmaceutical, and textile industries.
98
CALL TO ORDER:
Model CSG
POWER BUTTON
BACKLIGHT BUTTON
5-1/2 [139.7]
PROGRAMMING BUTTONS
The pocket size CSG Current and Voltage Signal Generator is an ideal tool for troubleshooting transmitters, transducers, motors, and actuators. The unit generates a 0 to 10 VDC signal in increments of 1 volt or a 0 to 20 mA signal in increments of 1 mA. The Model CSG features a large LCD display with a blue backlight for use in dimly lit areas. The Model CSG continuously ramps the output using user selected minimum, maximum, and ramp interval timing parameters. Units are furnished with a 9V battery, 120 VAC plug-in power supply, test leads with alligator clips, carrying case, and instruction manual.
SPECIFICATIONS Impedance: Voltage: 1000 min. Current: 300 max. Output: 0 to 20 mA (1 mA increments). 0-10 VDC (1 VDC increments). Resolution: 1 mA (current); 1 VDC (voltage). Ramping Time Intervals: 1 to 20 sec (1 sec increments). Ambient Operating Temperature: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Power Requirements: 9-Volt battery or 120 VAC (provided). Auto Power Off: 1 to 20 min. Electrical Connections: 6 ft (1.8 m) with alligator clips. Weight: 6 oz (170 g).
Model ASG
VOLTAGE OUTPUT
55/64 [21.6]
The pocket size model ASG Analog Signal Generator is an ideal tool for troubleshooting transmitters, transducers, motors and actuators. The unit generates a 0 to 10 VDC signal in increments of 1 volt or a 4 to 20 mA signal in increments of 2 mA. An LED bar graph visually indicates analog signal level. The model ASG will also continuously ramp to user defined maximum and minimum values with user defined ramp interval timing. Units are furnished with 6 ft (1.8 m) leads with alligator clips, 120 VAC plug in adapter protective carrying case and instruction manual. Model ASG Analog Signal Generator
SPECIFICATIONS Impedance: Voltage: 1000 min. Current: 300 max. Output: 0 to 20 mA (2 mA increments). 0-10 VDC (1 VDC increments). Resolution: 2 mA (current). 1 VDC (voltage). Ramping Time Intervals: 2 to 20 sec (2 sec increments). Ambient Operating Temperature: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Power Requirements: 9-Volt battery or 120 VAC (provided). Auto Shutoff Times: 2 to 20 min. (2 min. increments) (6 minute default). Electrical Connections: 6 ft (1.8 m) with alligator clips. Weight: 3.2 oz (without battery). Agency Approvals: CE.
CALL TO ORDER:
99
Model MM10
Digital Multimeter
Measures DC /AC Voltage, DC Current and Resistance, Overload Protection
DISPLAY 2.750 [69.85]
2m 200K 20K 2K/ + 200/ 2 20m OFF 600 ACV 200 DCV 600 200 20
E B C E
5.000 [127.0]
V mA
COM
10A
Our compact, low cost Model MM10 Digital Multimeter is ideal for general electrical testing and troubleshooting. This full function multimeter measures DC and AC voltage to 600V, DC current to 10A and resistance to 20M. In addition to volts, amps and ohms, this meter includes audible continuity, diode, LED and transistor hFE tests. The 3-1/2 digit LCD features automatic polarity correction, low battery and overload indication. Rugged, high impact case comes equipped with built-in tilt-stand for versatile, hands-free operation. Overload protected to 600VAC/600VDC for voltage ranges and to 500VAC/500VDC for resistance, diode and continuity test ranges. Current ranges are protected by 0.5A/250V, replaceable fuse. Multimeter is furnished with 22 test leads, 9V battery and instruction manual.
SPECIFICATIONS DC VOLTAGE Ranges: 2V, 20V, 200V, 600V. Resolution: 1 mV, 10 mV, 100 mV, 1V. Accuracy: 2V: (0.5% + 1 digit); 20 to 600V: (1.5% + 1 digit). AC VOLTAGE Ranges: 200V, 600V. Resolution: 100mV, 1V. Accuracy: 200V: (2% + 3 digits); 600V: (2.5% + 3 digits). RESISTANCE Ranges: 200, 2k, 20k, 200k, 2M, 20M. Accuracy: 200: (2% + 2 digits); 2k to 2M: (1.5% + 2 digits); 20M: (2.5% + 2 digits). DC CURRENT Ranges: 2 mA, 20 mA, 200 mA, 10A. Resolution: 1A, 10A, 100A, 10 mA. Accuracy: 2 to 200 mA: (1.5% + 1 digit); 10A: (2% + 1 digit).
CONTINUITY TEST Range: < 30. Resolution: 0.1. DIODE TEST Resolution: 1 mV. Test Current: 1 mA. TRANSISTOR (hFE) TEST Type: NPN, PNP. Range: 0-1000. LED TEST Test Voltage: < 3V. Range: 1.5 - 3V. GENERAL Display: 3-1/2 digit LCD with a maximum reading of 1999. Sampling Rate: 2.5 times per second. Ambient Operating Temperature: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C), 0 to 80% RH. Storage Temperature: 14 to 140F (-10 to 60C), 0 to 80% RH. Power Requirements: One 9V battery. Battery Life: 150 hrs. approx. Weight: 5.2 oz (150 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
TEST EQUIPMENT
Model A-800
Quickly check the operation of DC proximity sensors or level switches without dismounting. Designed to test any two-, three- or four-wire sensor with a solid state switch output. The A-800 provides visual and audible indication of whether the switch is operational. Switch status (NPN/PNP) indication is designated by a yellow LED. Power on is indicated by a bright green LED, low battery is indicated by a red LED. Unit can be used with capacitive, inductive, or photo electric sensors. The pocket sized A-800 is supplied with two 9 volt batteries.
SPECIFICATIONS Voltage Supply: 18 VDC. Batteries: Two 9 volt (included). Connections: Three spring loaded terminals. Housing Material: ABS plastic. Weight: 0.77 Ib (350 g). Agency Approvals: CE. Model No. A-800 DC Proximity Switch Tester
100
CALL TO ORDER:
Model 1205A-5
Handheld CO Analyzer
Dual-Line Alpha-Numeric Display, Auto Calibration
1-13/16 [46.04] RED PROTECTIVE SLEEVE DISPLAY 7-29/32 [200.82]
GREY CASE
3-1/2 [88.90]
Model 1205A-5 Handheld CO Analyzer provides a simple, cost effective answer to detecting and monitoring colorless, odorless, toxic carbon monoxide. The portable, battery operated unit measures CO from 0 to 2000 ppm and can record maximum CO values. Use a Type K thermocouple (sold separately) to measure temperatures. Simultaneously display two different functions on the large two-line alpha-numeric LCD. Quickly program time, date, engineering units, language and other display functions. The rotary dial allows easy function selections. The analyzer features auto zeroing, battery indication, infrared printer link, and a backlight display for low light areas. The Model 1205A-5 is ideal for ambient air monitoring in residential and commercial markets, flue testing in small boilers, and source investigation in areas where CO monitors have alarmed. The unit includes a stainless steel flue probe with filter and flexible tubing, batteries and instruction manual.
Model 1205A-5, Handheld CO Analyzer ACCESSORY 1718-0002, Type K Thermocouple with integral handle
SPECIFICATIONS Range: CO: 0 to 2000 ppm; Temperature: 32 to 1112F (0 to 600C). Accuracy: CO: 5% of reading; Temperature: 5F (2C). Display: Alpha-numeric LCD, dual digits. Ambient Operating Temperature: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C). Operating RH: 10 to 90% non-condensing. Response Time: 20 to 30 seconds. Sensor Type: Electrochemical cell. Calibration: Auto zero function.
Flexible Tubing: 9 ft (3 m) polyurethane tubing with quick fit connector. Max. temperature: 180F (82C). Flue Probe: 11.8 (30 cm) length, stainless steel with quick fit connector to aluminum handle. Max. temperature: 1100F (600C). Temperature Probe: Type K thermocouple with mini-connector (sold separately). Power Requirements: Four AA size alkaline batteries. Battery Life: 8 hours with alkaline batteries (continuous use without backlight). Weight: 1.5 lb (0.7 kg). Agency Approvals: CE.
Series 1207
TEST EQUIPMENT
5/16 DIA THERMOCOUPLE DEPTH STOP CONE 6-5/16 [7.937] [168.3] 2-21/32 OPTIONAL AC 5-5/16 [67.46] ADAPTER SOCKET [134.9]
Adjust boilers for optimum efficiency and conform to emission levels with Model 1207 Handheld Flue Gas Analyzer. The unit quickly measures and calculates all the parameters for accurate flue gas analysis. Simultaneously display eight different measurements in user selectable language. Model 1207 Analyzer can store up to 150 time/date stamped combustion tests and can transfer the data to a printer or IBM compatible PC for later analysis. Analyzer features 11 preprogrammed fuels, self calibration, and CO alarm preset at 1000 ppm. Measure Nitric Oxide with the optional NOx sensor. Unit includes probe, protective sleeve, 110 VAC power adapter, carrying case and manual. Model Number 1207, Flue Gas Analyzer Model Number 1207-NOx, Flue Gas Analyzer with NOx sensor ACCESSORIES No. 1206-1, Infrared Printer No. 1207-6, 220 VAC Adapter No. 1206-71, Replacement Filter Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation.
SPECIFICATIONS Ranges: O2: 0-21%; CO: 0-4000 ppm; CO2: 0-99.9%; NO: 0 to 5000 ppm; Temp. (Flue and nett): 32-1112F (0600C); Efficiency: 0-99.9%; Poison Index: 0-99.9%; Excess Air: 0-2885%. Accuracy: O2: 0.2%; CO: 20 ppm<400ppm, 5%>400ppm; CO2: 0.3% of rdg.; NO: 5ppm <100ppm, 5%>100ppm;Temp.: 5F (2C), 0.3% of rdg.; Efficiency: 1.0% of rdg.; Poison Index: 0.01; Excess Air: 0.2%. Resolution: O2: 0.1%; CO: 1 ppm; CO2: 0.1%; NO: 1ppm; Temp.: 1.0F/C; Efficiency and Excess Air: 0.1%; Poison Index; 0.01%. Ambient Operating Temperature: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C).
Power Requirements: 110 VAC adapter (220 VAC optional). Computer Requirements: IBM compatible 386 or above and Windows 3.1 or later with 2 MB RAM and 2 MB hard drive disk space, one serial port. Pre-Programmed Fuels: Natural gas, Town gas, Light oil, Heavy Oil, Coke, Coal, Anthracite, Propane, Butane, Kinsale gas, and Gascor. Probe: 11-1/4 (28.6 cm) length, stainless steel, Type K thermocouple, 9 ft (3 m) neoprene hose. Weight: 2.2 lb (1 kg). Agency Approvals: CE.
CALL TO ORDER:
101
Model BFA
The BFA Fuse Status Indicator shows normal or open fuse and also reports connection integrity. With a nominal 3-phase line voltage applied, the BFA Fuse Status Indicator flashes a normal LED green light that gives positive indication of a good fuse and integrity of the wire connection to each side of the fuse. The indicator flashes a red fault LED when a fuse is unconnected or open, if there is a lost connection to either side of the fuse, and if mismatched line and load wires are present. When phase loss occurs both fault and normal LEDs will extinguish. The indicator will continue to indicate the status of the fuse during a phase loss if a regenerated voltage is produced on the open phase from a rotating motor. The BFA Fuse Status Indicator mounts externally to a panel and can be mounted vertically or horizontally. It can be used for all UL Fuses Class H, J, K, R, RK. It can be viewed from a distance and has a universal input of 208-600 VAC.
Model BFA-100
SPECIFICATIONS Nominal Voltage: 208-600 VAC 10 %, Phase-to-Phase, 50/60 Hz. Max Continuous Voltage: 660 VAC, Phase-to-Phase. Rev. Connection Protected: Yes. Detection Threshold: 10-15 VAC Across Open Fuse. Maximum Detector Leakage Current: 0.5 mA @ 600 VAC (Approx). Indicators: Normal- (3) Green LEDs, 2 Flashes/Sec, Fault- (3) Red LEDs, 2 Flashes/Sec. Maximum Rated Voltage: 750 VAC/1000 VDC (LINE-TO-LINE or LINETO-GND). Detection Thresholds: 29 VAC 3Phase, 40 VAC SINGLE-phase, 27 VDC (TYP CUTOFF).
Power Required: 2.5 VA @ 208 VAC and 5.5 VA @ 480 VAC. Temperature Ratings: Operate: 32 to 131F (0 to 55C), Storage: -40 to 185F (-40 to 85C). Enclosure: 94 V-0 Flame Retardant Black ABS Plastic, Panel Mount with 1/2 Plastic, Electrical Conduit Adaptor; Encapsulated for Environmental Protection. Electrical Connections: (6) 2, 18 AWG, 600V, 105C PVC Stranded Wire w/Wire Pin. Terminations, Jacketed with 18 Silt Nylon Corrugated Tubing, .556 OD. Weight: NET: 3.52 oz (99.8 g) SHIPPING: 5.12 oz (145.1 g). Agency Approvals: UL
Model UPA-130
POWER MONITORING
1-3/16 [30.16]
3-3/64 [77.39]
1-1/4 [31.75]
The Model UPA-130 Power Alert reduces the risk of electrical arc flash by pre-verifying the electrical isolation from the outside of a control panel. The Universal Power Alert is hardwired to the circuit breaker or main disconnect and has an LED indication whenever voltage is present. It is engineered with redundant circuitry, which allows it to be powered by the same voltage that it indicates. The eight detector UPA-130 visually alerts to the presence of any dangerous AC or DC (stored energy) potentials occurring between any combination of the four input lines (L1, L2, L3, GND). The UPA-130 Universal Power Alert is designed to fit a 30mm knockout.
Model UPA-130
SPECIFICATIONS Operational Range: AC Single or 3-Phase: 40 to 750 VAC 50/60/400 Hz, (Line-To-Line or Line-To-GND [UL approved 50/60 Hz]). DC or Stored Energy: 30 to 1000 VDC, (Line-To-Line or Line-To-GND). Maximum Rated Voltage: 750 VAC/1000 VDC (Line-To-Line or Line-ToGND). Detection Thresholds: 29 VAC 3-Phase, 40 VAC SINGLE-Phase, 27 VDC (TYP CUTOFF). Power Consumption: 1.2 Watts at 750 VAC. Temperature Rating: Operate: -4 to 131F (-20 to 55C ) Storage: -40 to 185F (-40 to 85C ). Enclosure: Totally Encapsulated for Environment Protection. NEMA 4X (IP66). Electrical Connections: (4) 6 ft, 18 AWG 1000V, UL-1452. Weight: 7 oz (198.45 g). Agency Approvals: UL. Asia Pacific Phone 61 2 4272-2055
102
CALL TO ORDER:
Series CT40/50
Current Transformer
4-20 mA or 0-5 VDC Output, Split Core Case
Split Core-Top Terminals 2-5/32 [61] 23/64 [9.1] 3-17/32 [89.7] 2-13/62 [61] 55/64 [21.7] 1/8 [3.2]
33/64 [13]
2-1/4 [57.2]
23/32 [18.3]
1-3/16 [30.2]
Series CT40/50 combine current transformer and signal conditioner into a single package. Transformers feature jumper selectable ranges and split core case. Units are designed for applications on linear or sinusoidal AC loads.
Model Number CT40-100 CT40-102 CT50-100 CT50-102 Range 10/20/50 A 10/20/50 A 100/150/200 A 100/150/200 A Output 4-20 mA 0-5 VDC 4-20 mA 0-5 VDC Power Requirements 12-40 VDC, Loop Powered Self Powered 12-40 VDC, Loop Powered Self Powered
SPECIFICATIONS Output Signal: 0-5 VDC or 4-20 mA, depending on model. Power Requirements: See Table. Accuracy: CT40/50-102: 1.0% FS; CT40/50-100: 0.5% FS. Temperature Limits: -4 to 122F (-20 to 50C). Response Time: CT40/50-102: 100 ms; CT40/50-100: 300 ms. Isolation Voltage: 1270 VAC. Frequency: CT40/50-102: 50-60 Hz; CT40/50-100: 20-100 Hz (Sinusoidal waveforms only). Enclosure Rating: UL 94V-0 flammability rated. Agency Approval: CE.
Series CT60/70
2-1/4 [57.2]
23/32 [18.3]
POWER MONITORING
1-3/16 [30.2]
Series CT60/70 Current Transformers provide true RMS output on distorted AC waveforms ideal for nonlinear loads or noisy environments. Each model offers three jumper selectable ranges and 1270 VAC isolation. Split core case allows easy installation.
SPECIFICATIONS Output Signal: 4-20 mA, loop powered, true RMS. Power Requirements: 24 VDC nominal. Accuracy: 0.8% FS. Temperature Limits: -4 to 122F (-20 to 50C). Response Time: 600 ms to 90%. Isolation Voltage: 1270 VAC. Frequency: 10-400 Hz. Enclosure Rating: UL 94V-0 flammability rated. Agency Approval: CE.
CALL TO ORDER:
103
Series CS
Current Switches
Universal Output, Solid or Split Core Case
Solid Core-Front Terminals Split Core-Top Terminals
1-13/64 [31]
POT LED
1/8 [3.2]
1-1/16 [27]
2-1/4 [57.2]
Jumper
3-19/64 [83.8]
33/64 [13]
2-3/4 [69.9]
15/32 [12]
3-3/64 [77.3]
The CS Series Current Switches combine a current transformer, signal conditioner and limit alarm into a single package. The CS series has an extended current input range, universal solid-state outputs and a wide frequency response. Available in a split core or a solid core case. Switches feature LED indication for local display or switch status. Model Number CS20-100 CS20-220 CS40-220 CS50-100 Setpoint Range Adj. 1.75-150 A Adj. 1-150 A Selectable 1-6, 6-40, & 40-175 A Selectable 1-6, 6-40, & 40-175 A Core Split Solid Solid Split Voltage 240 VAC/DC 240 VAC/DC 240 VAC 240 VDC
SPECIFICATIONS Output: Isolated, normally open. Power Requirements: None, self powered. Temperature Limits: -58 to 149F (-50 to 65C). Hysteresis: 5% of output. Response Time: CS20: 0.120 sec; CS40/50: 0.04 to .120 sec. Isolation Voltage: 1270 VAC. Frequency: 6-100 Hz. Enclosure Rating: UL, V-O flammability rated, ABS plastic housing. Agency Approvals: CE.
POWER MONITORING
0.938 [24]
1.438 [37]
The Tell Tale Jr. is designed to indicate an open heater or other resistive load. Several models are available for various applications. The LED models light an LED when current is flowing in the circuit. If current stops flowing, the LED turns off. Solid state switch models provide either a logic output for DC applications or a triac output for AC applications. These models will satisfy those applications that need to send heater data to PLC or computer having an appropriate power supply. They are provided with 4 foot leads. If the triac output model is used to drive an inductive load (relay coil, etc.) then the 31380412 snubber network is required. While the Tell Tale Jr. is self-powered there is no power loss in the monitored load circuit when installed.
FEATURES Low cost current indication Easy installation Indicator or switch action Draws no power from process Compact size Isolated - no direct contact with power lines
Description Internal, Red LED, Indication Only Internal, Green LED, Indication Only External, Red LED, 4 ft (1.2 m) Cable, Indication Only External, Green LED, 4 ft (1.2 m) Cable, Indication Only Logic Output, No LED, 4 ft (1.2 m) Cable Triac Output, No LED, 4 ft (1.2 m) Cable
APPLICATIONS Indicates open heater Signal to PLC indicating loss of HVAC or other devices
104
CALL TO ORDER:
Series AN2
4-7/32 [107.16]
The Series AN2 Indicating Alarm Annunciator provides visible and audible alarms for up to eight inputs. The annunciator also has two SPDT relay outputs that can be used to initiate external alarms, buzzers, or paging devices. The Integral 24 VDC power supply can power most level, temperature, pressure, and flow switches. Audible alarm conditions can be acknowledged, reset, or silenced either via the front panel push buttons or the rear terminal block. The Series AN2 can be set to any common ISA sequences including FirstOut.
SPECIFICATIONS Inputs: NO or NC switches, Open Collector Transistor (Open circuit voltage = 3.3 VDC); Logic Levels: LO = 0 to 0.9 VDC, HI = 2.4 to 28 VDC (100 K input impedance). Outputs: Two SPDT relay (3 A @ 250 VAC or 30 VDC, resistive; 1/14 HP @ 125/250 VAC, inductive). Ambient Operating Temperature: -40 to 149F (-40 to 65C). Power Requirements: 85 to 265 VAC 50/60 Hz, 90 to 265 VDC; 12 to 36 VDC, 12 to 24 VAC (Depending on model).
Power Consumption: 20 W (6 W on low voltage models). Mounting: 1/8 DIN. Housing Material: UL rated 94V-0 high impact plastic. Enclosure Rating: NEMA 4X (IP65) Front Panel. Weight: 9.6 oz (272 g). Agency Approval: CE, UL.
Number of Outputs 4 4 8 8
Series DPMX
(1-63/64) [50.40]
(29/32) [23.02]
The Series DPMX Digital Panel Meter can easily be viewed from across a room or in dark areas. The 2.3 LED segments are available in red, green, or blue. These panel meters come equipped with a universal power supply and user selectable process inputs to fit most applications. The Series DPMX includes a mounting bracket that can be adjusted up to 180.
SPECIFICATIONS Inputs Ranges: Set Voltage: 200 mVDC, 2 VDC, 20 VDC. Adjustable Voltage: 200 mVDC, 5 VDC, 10 VDC. Adjustable Current: 0(4) to 20 mA DC. Inputs Impedance: Set Voltage: >1 M (>10 M on 200 mV range). Adjustable Voltage: 392 k. Adjustable Current: 300 nominal. Accuracy: (1% F.S. + 1 count). Power Supply: 90 to 250 VAC @ 12 VA or 10.5 to 30 VAC/DC @ 6VA (depending on model).
Display: 3-1/2 digits, 2.3 height, 7 segment LED. Sampling Rate: 3 readings per second. Operating Temperature: 14 to 122F (-10 to 50C). Storage Range: -40 to 167F (-40 to 75C). Warm Up: 10 minutes. Mounting: 180 gimbal mounting with 30 stops or bezel mount.
APPLICATION Used to display process values from pressure, humidity or temperature transmitters
CALL TO ORDER:
105
Series DPMA
1-49/64 [45.0]
1-59/64 [48.8]
4-29/64 [113.0]
Series DPMA Adjustable LCD Digital Panel Meter offers a 3-1/2 digit display for easy viewing in a standard 1/8 DIN package. Unit accepts 4-20 mA, 0 to 5 VDC, or 0 to 10 VDC inputs with a wide bipolar zero and span adjustment. Standard features include field selectable engineering units and decimal point positions. Choose from red, amber, or green segments for easy viewing at a distance. A 24 VDC power supply is required for the operation of the backlight. Model Number DPMA-401 DPMA-402 DPMA-404 DPMA-501 DPMA-502 DPMA-504 Input Current Current Current Voltage Voltage Voltage Backlighting Amber Segments Red Segments Green Segments Amber Segments Red Segments Green Segments
SPECIFICATIONS Input: 4-20 mA, 0-5 VDC, or 0-10 VDC. Input Impedance: 300 nominal. Accuracy: (0.05% FS + 1 count). Power Supply: 24 VDC or 12 VDC (DPMA-5XX). Current Consumption: 35 mA DC. 10 mA DC. backlight: 35 mA. Span and Zero: Adjustable. (1999 counts). Display: 3-1/2 digits, 7 segments, 1 (25.4 mm) H.
Decimal Points: 3-position, user selectable. Engineering Units: F, C, %, psi. Polarity: Automatic, - displayed. Operating Temperature: 14 to 122F (-10 to 50C). Storage Temperature: -40 to 167F (-40 to 75C). Mounting: Snap-in panel mount or clamp (gasket included). Connection: Screw terminals. Weight: 4 oz (113.4 g).
ACCESSORIES DPM-12P, Regulated 120 VAC to 12 VDC Power Supply DPM-24P, Regulated 120 VAC to 24 VDC Power Supply
APPLICATION Used to display process values from pressure, humidity or temperature transmitters
Series DPML
DPML-401
1.000 (25.4)
The Series DPML LCD Digital Panel Meter offers a large 4-1/2 digit LCD display with a choice of red, amber or green segments for easy viewing at a distance. The meter accepts loop powered 4-20 mA DC input, 0 to 5 VDC, or 0 to 10 VDC voltage input. Standard features include field engineering units and decimal point positions. A 24 VDC power supply is required for the operation of the back light. Model Number DPML-401 DPML-402 DPML-403 DPML-501 DPML-502 DPML-503 Input Current Current Current Voltage Voltage Voltage Backlighting Amber Segments Green Segments Red Segments Amber Segments Green Segments Red Segments
SPECIFICATIONS Inputs: 4-20 mA DC, 0-5 VDC, 0-10 VDC. Input Impedance: 300 nominal. Accuracy: (0.1% FS + 2 count). Power Supply: 24 VDC or 12 VDC (DPML-5XX)@ 35 mA typical. Span and Zero: Adjustable (19999 counts). Display: 4-1/2 digits, 7 segments, 0.45 (11.4 mm) H. Decimal Points: 4-position, user selectable. Annunciator: F, C, %, psi. Polarity: Automatic, - displayed. Operating Temperature: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Mounting: Snap-in bezel mount. Connection: Screw terminals. Weight: 2 oz (56.7 g). APPLICATION Used to display process values from pressure, humidity or temperature transmitters
ACCESSORIES DPM-12P, Regulated 120 VAC to 12 VDC Power Supply DPM-24P, Regulated 120 VAC to 24 VDC Power Supply
106
CALL TO ORDER:
Series DPMP
The Series DPMP LCD Digital Process Meter provides easy viewing on the 3-1/2 digit LCD display. The display segments are available in a choice of amber, red or green. The meter features user-selectable engineering units, adjustable zero and span and field-selectable decimal point position. The snap-in bezel mount eliminates mounting hardware for quick installation. A 24 VDC power supply is required for the operation of the backlight.
Backlighting Amber Segments Green Segments Red Segments Amber Segments Green Segments Red Segments
SPECIFICATIONS Inputs: 4-20 mA DC, 0-5 VDC or 0-10 VDC. Input Impedance: 300 nominal. Accuracy: (0.1% FS + 2 count). Power Supply: 24 VDC or 12 VDC (DPMP-5XX) @ 35 mA typical. Span and Zero: Adjustable. (1999 Counts). Display: 3-1/2 digits, 7 segments, 0.45 (11.4 mm) H. Decimal Points: 3-position, user selectable. Annunciator: F, C, %, psi. Polarity: Automatic, - displayed. Operating Temperature: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Mounting: Snap-in bezel mount. Connection: Screw terminals. Weight: 2 oz (56.7 g).
ACCESSORIES DPM-12P, Regulated 120 VAC to 12 VDC Power Supply DPM-24P, Regulated 120 VAC to 24 VDC Power Supply
APPLICATION Used to display process values from pressure, humidity or temperature transmitters
Series DPMW
1888
2.310 [58.4] PANEL CUTOUT FOR WINDOW MOUNTING .910 [22.9]
1.562 [39.67]
The Series DPMW LCD Digital Panel Meter is designed with a 3-1/2 digit, high contrast LCD display. The colored segments are available in red, amber, or green - ideal for viewing at a distance. The Series DPMW features user selectable engineering units, selectable decimal point position and adjustable zero and span. The meter accepts a 4 to 20 mA input signal for pressure, level, flow, and temperature transmitter. A 24 VDC power supply is required to illuminate the colored segments. The Series DPMW can be quickly installed in a window cutout.
SPECIFICATIONS Inputs: 4-20 mA DC. Input Impedance: 300 nominal. Accuracy: (0.1% FS + 2 count). Power Supply: 24 VDC @ 35 mA typical. Span and Zero: Adjustable. ( 1999). Display: 3-1/2 digits, 7 segments, 0.45 (11.4 mm) H. Decimal Points: 3-position, user selectable. Annunciator: F, C, %, psi. Polarity: Automatic, - displayed. Operating Temperature: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). Storage Temperature: -4 to 158F (-20 to 70C). Mounting: Window mount. Connection: Screw terminals. Weight: 2 oz (56.7 g). Conversion Rate: 3 per second. Warm-Up: 10 minutes typical. APPLICATION Used to display process values from pressure, humidity or temperature transmitters
CALL TO ORDER:
Series DL6
2.956 [75.1]
124036-00
MAGNETIC STRIP
.744 [18.9]
3.825 [97]
.644 [16.9]
3.375 [85.7]
.450 [11.4]
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Monitor and troubleshoot HVAC systems, verify energy management systems, or track performance of pneumatically controlled valves with Series DL6 Pressure/Temperature/RH Data Logger. Units include an on-board thermistor for ambient temperature measurement and pressure module. Remote humidity/temperature sensor and plug-in humidity sensor are sold separately. Loggers can store up to 32,768 readings and operate independently from any external power supply with built-in lithium battery. Use Model DL200 Windows software (sold separately) to quickly program the logger or upload data to a computer.
Pressure Range 0 to 5 psig (30 kPa) 0 to 30 psig (200 kPa) 0 to 100 psig (700 kPa)
ACCESSORIES DL200, Windows Software and Connecting Cable DL690, Remote Humidity/Temperature Sensor DL691, Plug-in Humidity Sensor Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation.
SPECIFICATIONS No. of Channels: Five; internal thermistor, pressure module (included), plug-in humidity sensor, remote humidity/temperature sensor. Internal Thermistor Range: 40 to 158F (40 to 70C). Compensated Temperature Range: 32 to 158F (0 to70C). Memory Size: 32,768 readings. Accuracy: 1% FS. Clock Accuracy: 8 sec/day plus one sampling interval. Thermal Accuracy: 1% FS. Drift: 0.2% FS/yr. Internal Thermistor Resolution: 0.7F (0.4C), R25 value equal to 10,000. Resolution: 8 bits (1 in 256). Sampling Methods: Continuous (Firstin, First-out) or Stop when full (Fill-thenstop).
Sampling Rates: Selectable from 8 seconds to once every 5 days. Ambient Operating Temperature/RH: 50 to 160F (45 to 70C), 0 to 95% RH, non-condensing. Connection: Removable screw terminal. Computer Requirements: IBM compatible 386 or above and Windows 3.1 or later with 2 MB RAM and 2 MB hard drive disk space, one serial port. Power Requirements: Built-in 3.6V Lithium battery. Power Consumption: 5-10 A. Service: Air and noncorrosive gases. Max. Pressure Rating: 4x rated pressure. Housing Material: Polypenylene Ether and Polystyrene. Weight: 5 oz (110 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
Series DL7
Monitor and Record low differential pressures and temperature with the Model DL7 Differential Pressure Data Logger. Unit includes an on-board thermistor for ambient temperature measurement. Sampling rates are user selectable from 0.04 seconds to 8 hours with First-in first-out or Fill-then-stop sampling options. Loggers can store up to 21,500 readings and operate totally independently from any external power supply with built-in lithium battery. Use Model DL200 Windows software (sold separately) to quickly program the logger or upload data to a computer. The Series DL7 logger is ideal for monitoring air duct velocity, testing and balancing HVAC systems, or verifying room pressure.
Model Number DL70 DL71 DL72 DL75 DL710 Pressure Range 0.5 w.c. (1.2 mbar) 1 w.c. (2.5 mbar) 2.0 w.c. (5.0 mbar) 5 w.c. (12.4 mbar) 10 w.c.(24.9 mbar)
ACCESSORIES DL200, Windows Software and Connecting Cable Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation.
TEMPERATURE SENSOR SPECIFICATIONS No. of Channels: Two; internal thermistor, and a differential pressure sensor. Internal Thermistor Range: -40 to 158F (-40 to 70C). Compensated Temp Range: 32 to 158F (0 to 70C). Memory Size: 21,500 readings. Accuracy: 0.05 w.c. (up to 2 range) 1 (5 and 10 range). Thermal Accuracy: 0.5% FS. Clock Accuracy: 2 sec/day plus one sampling interval. Resolution: 0.01 w.c. Internal Thermistor Resolution: 0.7F (0.4C), R25 value equal to 10,000 [10k @ 25C (77F)]. Resolution: 12 bits (1 in 4096). Nonlinearity: 0.05% FS (BFSL). Hysteresis and Repeatability: 0.05% FS. Drift: 0.5% FS/yr. Sampling Methods: Continuous (first-in, first-out: not available from 40 ms to 8 sec.), stop when full (fill-thenstop), or delayed start.
1/2 [12.70]
2-1/2 [62.29]
11/32 [8.730]
Sampling Rates: Selectable from 0.04 seconds to 8 hours. Ambient Operating Temperature/RH: -40 to 158F (-40 to 70C), 0 to 95% RH, non-condensing. Connection: Two 1/8 I.D. permanent protective tubing. Computer Requirements: IBM compatible 386 or above and Windows 3.1 or later with 2 MB RAM and 2 MB hard drive disk space, one serial port. Service: Dry air and noncorrosive gases. Max. Pressure Rating: 4X rated pressure. Power Requirements: Built-in 3.6V Lithium battery. Power Consumption: 5-10 A. Housing Material: Polyphenylene Ether and Polystyrene PPE & PS. Weight: 4 oz (110 g). Agency Approvals: CE.
108
CALL TO ORDER:
Series GV1
A GV1
The Series GV1 globe valves can be conveniently paired with the Series EVA1 electric actuators, creating a low cost and compact control valve package. The globe design allows for exceptional throttling control in a wide range of applications, including central heating and air conditioning, water handling, and industrial manufacturing systems. Valves are manufactured in a variety of sizes, and are available in either twoway or three-way body styles. The forged brass body and equal percentage flow characteristic are ideal for many flow control systems. FEATURES Low leakage rate (less than 0.05% of Cv) Equal percentage flow characteristic for excellent low flow control Forged brass construction Direct mounting actuator (Series EVA1) for compact control valve package
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible liquids and gases. Line Size: 1 to 2. Body Style: 2-way, push to open globe; 3-way globe. End Connections: Female NPT. Pressure Limit: 232 psi (16 bar). Wetted Materials: Body Material: Brass. Stem: 302 SS. Disc: Brass with Nitrile Gasket. Packing: Fluon filler with Nitrile O-ring. Temperature Limits: 35 to 201F (2 to 94C). Flow Characteristic: Equal percentage. Flow Leakage: Less than 0.05% of Cv factor. Stem Connection: M8 thread.
Type
Pipe Size 1
Cv 9.3
Max. Diff. Pres. Fit with EVA187 psi (6 bar) 58 psi (4 bar) 43 psi (3 bar) 29 psi (2 bar) 87 psi (6 bar) 58 psi (4 bar) 43 psi (3 bar) 29 psi (2 bar)
Stroke in. (mm) 19/32 (15) 3/4 (19) 3/4 (19) 3/4 (19) 19/32 (15) 3/4 (19) 3/4 (19) 3/4 (19)
APPLICATIONS Mixing or diverting services with three way models Control water flow in heating or cooling processes HVAC zone management
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
109
CALL TO ORDER:
The Series GV2 and GV3 globe valves can be conveniently paired with the Series EVA2 and EVA3 electric actuators, creating a low cost and compact control valve package. The globe design allows for exceptional throttling control in a wide range of applications, including central heating and air conditioning, water handling, and industrial manufacturing systems. Valves are manufactured in a variety of sizes, and are available in either two-way or three-way body styles. The forged brass body and equal percentage flow characteristic are ideal for many flow control systems. Series GV3 models incorporate a high intensity body casting for high temperature applications, including steam service. APPLICATIONS Mixing or diverting services with three way models Control water flow in heating or cooling processes HVAC zone management FEATURES Low leakage rate (less than 0.05% of Cv) Equal percentage flow characteristic for excellent low flow control Forged brass construction Direct mounting actuator (Series EVA2 and EVA3) for compact control valve package GV3: Higher temperature rating, capable of steam service Control flow in heating or cooling processes
SPECIFICATIONS Service: GV2: Compatible liquids and gases. GV3: Compatible liquids, gases, and steam. Line Size: 1 to 2-1/2. Body Style: 2-way, push to open globe; 3-way globe. End Connections: Female NPT. Pressure Limit: 232 psi (16 bar) WOG; GV3: 130 psi SWP (9.0 bar). Wetted Materials: Body Material: Brass. Stem: SS (1Cr18Ni9). Disc: GV2: Brass with Nitrile gasket. GV3: Brass with Fluon gasket. Packing: GV2: Fluon filler with Nitrile O-ring. GV3: Fluon filler with Fluorine O-ring. Temperature Limits: GV2: 35 to 201F (2 to 94C), GV3: 35 to 356F (2 to 180C). Flow Characteristic: Equal percentage. Flow Leakage: Less than 0.05% of Cv factor. Stem Connection: M8 thread.
SERIES GV2
Model Type GV221 GV222 Pipe Size Cv 1 1-1/4 9.3 18.6 29.0 46.4 73.1 9.3 18.6 29.0 46.4 73.1 Max. Diff. Pres. Fit with Fit with EVA2EVA3145 psi 203 psi (10 bar) (14 bar) 109 psi 160 psi (7.5 bar) (11 bar) 72 psi 116 psi (5 bar) (8 bar) 43 psi 72 psi (3 bar) (5 bar) 29 psi 50 psi (2 bar) (3.5 bar) 145 psi 203 psi (10 bar) (14 bar) 109 psi 160 psi (7.5 bar) (11 bar) 72 psi 116 psi (5 bar) (8 bar) 43 psi 72 psi (3 bar) (5 bar) 29 psi 50 psi (2 bar) (3.5 bar) Stroke in (mm) 19/32 (15) 3/4 (19) 3/4 (19) 7/8 (22) 7/8 (22) 19/32 (15) 3/4 (19) 3/4 (19) 7/8 (22) 7/8 (22)
SERIES GV3
Model Type GV321 GV322 Pipe Size Cv 1 1-1/4 9.3 18.6 29.0 46.4 73.1 9.3 18.6 29.0 46.4 73.1 Max. Diff. Pres. Fit with Fit with EVA2- EVA3116 psi 174 psi (8 bar) (12 bar) 87 psi 145 psi (6 bar) (10 bar) 58 psi 102 psi (4 bar) (7 bar) 29 psi 58 psi (2 bar) (4 bar) 29 psi 50 psi (2 bar) (3.5 bar) 116 psi 174 psi (8 bar) (12 bar) 87 psi 145 psi (6 bar) (10 bar) 58 psi 102 psi (4 bar) (7 bar) 29 psi 58 psi (2 bar) (4 bar) 29 psi 50 psi (2 bar) (3.5 bar) Stroke in (mm) 19/32 (15) 3/4 (19) 3/4 (19) 7/8 (22) 7/8 (22) 19/32 (15) 3/4 (19) 3/4 (19) 7/8 (22) 7/8 (22)
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
GV234 GV235
2 2-1/2
110
CALL TO ORDER:
Series EVA
Electric Actuator
Easily Installs Onto a Series GV Valve
3-3/16 SQ [97] KNOB POWER CONNECT CONNECTOR 4-3/4 [120] RED/BLUE INDICATOR ACTUATOR BRACKET 3-15/16 [100] U-TYPE CONNECTOR 4-1/32 [102.4]
3-25/64 [87]
7/16 [11.1]
4-57/64 [124.22]
NUT
EVA1
EVA2/EVA3
EVA1 SERIES
The Series EVA Electric Actuators are designed to mount directly onto the Series GV globe valves, creating a complete, low cost, and compact control valve package. Floating or modulating control inputs are available, and the 24 VAC synchronic motor includes a magnetic clutch to protect the motor in stall conditions. Actuators are ruggedly constructed with a fire-proof ABS housing and robust aluminum bracket. Features include a visual position indicator and manual override to make this actuator an excellent choice for any size area, large or small. FEATURES Manual Override Compact Size Floating Control or Selectable 0-10 VDC or 4-20 mA Proportional Control Reversible Direction on Proportional Models Magnetic Clutch Protects Motor in Stall Conditions
SPECIFICATIONS SERIES EVA1 Output Force: 112 lb (500 N). Power Requirements: 24 VAC. Power Consumption: EVA1F: 2.5 VA; EVA1M: 4.5 VA. Cycle Time: 262 sec/in. (10.3 sec/mm). Enclosure Rating: IP54. Housing Material: Fire-proof ABS plastic (UL94V-0). Bracket Material: Aluminum. Operating Temperature: 36 to 131F (2 to 55C). Storage Temperature: -4 to 149F (-20 to 65C). Humidity Limit: <90%, non-condensing. Electrical Connection: Screw terminal. Modulating Input: 0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA. Weight: EVA1F: 1.81 lb (0.8 kg); EVA1M: 1.92 lb (0.9 kg). SERIES EVA2, EVA3 Output Force: EVA2: 225 lb (1000 N); EVA3: 337 lb (1500 N). Power Requirements: 24 VAC. Power Consumption: EVA2F (EVA3F): 5.5 VA; EVA2M (EVA3M): 7.5 VA. Cycle Time: EVA2F (EVA2M): 97 sec/in. (3.8 sec/mm); EVA3F (EVA3M): 164 sec/in. (6.45 sec/mm). Enclosure Rating: IP40. Housing Material: Fire-proof ABS plastic (UL94V-0). Bracket Material: Aluminum. Operating Temperature: 36 to 131F (2 to 55C). Storage Temperature: -4 to 149F (-20 to 65C). Humidity Limit: <90%, non-condensing. Electrical Connection: Screw terminal. Modulating Input: 0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA. Weight: EVA2F (EVA3F): 2.43 lb (1.1 kg); EVA2M (EVA3M): 3.31 lb (1.15 kg).
OUTPUT FORCE 112 lb (500 N) 112 lb (500 N) 225 lb (1000 N) 225 lb (1000 N) 337 lb (1500 N) 337 lb (1500 N)
COMPATIBLE VALVE TYPE GV1__ GV1__ GV2__ or GV3__ GV2__ or GV3__ GV2__ or GV3__ GV2__ or GV3__
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
CALL TO ORDER:
111
Series BV2MB
C (Ref)
D (Ref)
1.800 2.000 2.070 2.360 2.950 3.370 3.740 4.290 5.650 6.180
3.800 3.800 3.800 3.800 4.350 5.470 5.470 6.380 8.720 8.720
.393 .393 .551 .748 .944 1.181 1.496 1.850 2.440 2.990
1.250 1.250 1.830 1.950 2.170 2.800 3.030 3.330 4.000 4.310
The Series BV2MB is an economical hand lever ball valve for commercial and general industrial use. The Series BV2MB is perfect as a manual shutoff valve for hot and cold water systems. Valve body, body cap, and ball are made of quality brass. Seats and stem packing are constructed of TFE for long lasting service. Blowout-proof stem provides safety in the event of overpressure. Full port design allows for maximum Cv and minimal pressure drop.
Model Cv Size Model Cv
SPECIFICATIONS
End Connections: 1/4 to 3 female NPT. Pressure Limit: 1/4 to 1: 600 psi (41.4 bar), 1-1/4 to 2: 400 psi (27.6 bar), 2-1/2 to 3: 200 psi (13.8 bar) WOG. Wetted Materials: Body and body cap: forged brass (ASTM B283C37700); ball and stem: brass; seat and packing: TFE. Temperature Limit: 10 to 200F (-12 to 93C). Other Materials: Body seal: rubber; handle: plated steel; nut and gasket: brass.
7.5 7.5 16 43 58
Series BV2L
BV2LT
BV2LS
Size 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/4 1 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/4 1 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4
Cv 6 7 10 24 45 6 7 10 24 45 6 7 10 24 45 90
Model Number BV2LQ00 BV2LQ01 BV2L902 BV2L903 BV2L904 BV2LR00 BV2LR01 BV2L702 BV2L703 BV2L704 BV2LS00 BV2LS01 BV2LT02 BV2LT03 BV2LT04 BV2L105
Supply Voltage 120 VAC 120 VAC 120 VAC 120 VAC 120 VAC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC
Spring Return Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No No No No No No
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
112
CALL TO ORDER:
Series ABFV
Pneumatic
Electric
*Please see website for dimensional drawings The ABFV Series is offered with standard 316 SS disc, a through shaft that does not come in contact with the media, and choices of EPDM, BUNA-N, or fluoroelastomer liners for great chemical compatibility. Valve design has integral ISO mounting for direct mount actuators creating a more compact automated package. Body is epoxy coated for durable and attractive finish. Liner fully covers the body and assures tight seal with mating flanges without additional gaskets. One-piece shaft ensures positive valve positioning and is an anti-blowout design. Series ABFV is perfect for flow control of water in chillers, cooling towers, and thermal storage systems. ABFV valves come in two-way and three-way packages. Three-way assemblies include valves and actuators mounted onto a 125# cast iron tee. When ordering you have the choice of valve arrangement for mixing or diverting applications. Valves come in lug or wafer style and wafer models have guide holes for bolts. ABFV is an economical automated valve package with either an electric or pneumatic actuator. Electrically actuated models are weatherproof, NEMA 4, powered by standard 115 VAC supply, and are available in either two-position or proportional control. Two-position actuators use the 115 VAC input to drive each of the valve ports open or closed, while the modulating actuator accepts a 4 to 20 mA input for infinite valve positioning. Actuator features include thermal overload protection to withstand stall conditions, visual position indication and a permanently lubricated gear train. The pneumatic double acting actuator uses an air supply to drive each of the actuator ports. Spring return pneumatic actuators use the air supply to drive the valve stem one direction, and internally loaded springs return the valve to its original position. Also available is the SV3 solenoid valve to electrically switch the supply pressure between the air supply ports. Actuators are constructed of anodized aluminum and are epoxy coated for years of corrosion free service.
SPECIFICATIONS Valve Body Service: Compatible liquids and gases. Body: 2-way or 3-way. Line Size: 2 to 12. End Connections: Wafer or lug pattern designed for flanges to ANSI B16.1, BS4504, DIN 2501. Pressure Limits: Up to 8: 225 psi (15.5 bar); 10 12: 150 psi (10.3 bar). Wetted Materials: Disc: 316 SS; Liner: EPDM BUNA-N, or Fluoroelastomer. Temperature Limits: EPDM: -30 to 275F (-34 to 135C); BUNA-N: 10 to 180F (-12.2 to 82.2C); Fluoroelastomer: 400F (204C). Other Materials: Shaft: 316SS; Bottom/Top Bushing: bronze; Body: cast iron; Shaft Seal: EPDM. ACTUATORS Electric U and V Series Power Requirements: 115 VAC, 50/60 Hz, single phase. Optional 220 VAC, 24 VAC, 12 VDC, and 24 VDC. Power Consumption: (Locked Rotor Current): U_1, V_1: .55A; U_2, 3, 4, V_2, 3, 4: 0.75A; U_ 5, 6, 7, V_5, 6, 7: 1.1A; U_ 8, V_8: 2.6A; U_9, V_9: 2.9A. (Only for 115 VAC, for other voltages contact the factory). Cycle Time: (sec. per 90): U_1, V_1: 2.5; U_2, 3, V_2, 3: 5; U_4, V_4: 10; U_ 5, 6, V_5, 6: 15; U_7, V_7: 30; U_ 8, V_8: 12; U_9, V_9: 14. (Only for 115 VAC, for other voltages contact the factory). Duty Cycle: U_1: 75%; U_2 to 7: 25%; U_8, 9: 100%; V_1 to 7: 75%; V_8, 9: 100%. Enclosure Rating: NEMA 4. Optional NEMA 7 (Class 1, Div. II Groups A, B, C, D). Housing Material: Aluminum with thermal bonding polyester powder finish. Temperature Limit: 0 to 150F (-18 to 65C). Conduit Connection: 1/2 female NPT. Modulating Input (V Series): 4 to 20 mA. Standard Features: Manual override and visual position indicator except modulating units. Pneumatic DA and SR Series Type: DA series is double acting and SR series is spring return (rack and pinion). Normal Supply Pressure: 80 psi (5.5 bar). Maximum Supply Pressure: 120 psig (8 bar). Air Connections: DA1 to 5 and SR2 to 5: 1/8 female NPT, all others: 1/4 female NPT. Air Consumption: (cu. in. per stroke) DA1: 2.32, DA2: 6.59, DA3: 12.14, DA4: 16.32, DA5: 30.2, DA6: 45.3, DA7: 61.0, DA8: 106.9, DA9: 137.9, DAA: 220.1, DAB: 348.1, DAC: 915.4, SR2: 7.7, SR3: 14.2, SR4: 17.2, SR5: 32.4, SR6: 54.4, SR7: 85.4, SR8: 122.1, SR9: 146.5, SRA: 215.1, SRB: 462.6, SRC: 945.9. Cycle Time: (sec. per 90): DA1: .03, DA2: .04., DA3: .08, DA4: .12, DA5: .19, DA6: 0.27, DA7: .47, DA8: .66, DA9: .93, DAA: 1.1, DAB: 1.7, DAC: 4.5, SR2: .09, SR3: .14, SR4: .22, SR5: .33, SR6: .46, SR7: .78, SR8: .90, SR9: .97, SRA: 1.34, SRB: 2.19, SRC: 6.20. Housing Material: Anodized aluminum body and epoxy coated aluminum end caps. Temperature Limit: -4 to 180F (-20 to 82C). Accessory Mounting: NAMUR standard. Standard Features: Visual position indicator.
Cv Values
Valve Size 2 2-1/2 3 4 5 6 8 10 12 10 0.1 0.7 0.3 0.5 0.8 2 3 4 5 20 5 8 12 17 29 45 89 151 234 30 12 20 22 36 61 95 188 320 495 40 24 37 39 78 133 205 408 694 1072 50 45 65 70 139 237 366 727 1237 1911 60 64 98 116 230 392 605 1202 2034 3162 70 90 144 183 364 620 958 1903 3240 5005 80 125 204 275 546 930 1437 2854 4859 7507 90 135 220 302 600 1022 1539 3136 5340 8250
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
CALL TO ORDER:
113
Series ABFV
Complete Model Chart - See next page for built model numbers
Example Construction Configuration Size
Arrangement
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
Options
For Electric U and V actuators middle term, V_1, is the power supply required. Model Code 1 is for 120 VAC, 2 is for 220 VAC, 3 is for 24 VAC and 4 is for 24 VDC. Example, U11, is 120 VAC two position. Consult factory for pricing.
114
CALL TO ORDER:
Series ABFV
For your convenience, sample model configurations are listed with the proper sized actuators. Models listed have cast iron body, 316 SS disc, and EPDM liner and o-rings. The 2-way models have a valve arrangement shown of normally closed, while the 3-way models have no valve arrangement code shown, please specify when ordering. All electric actuators shown are 115 VAC and NEMA 4. All pneumatic actuators are sized with an air supply pressure of 80 psi. Consult the factory for model number changes for electric actuator options of explosion-proof and other supply voltages.
Model Numbers shown are normally closed, change the model code at the end from C to A for normally open.
Model Numbers shown are normally closed, change the model code at the end from C to A for normally open.
*Complete model includes Valve Arrangement - see Model Chart on previous page.
Options:
Explosion Proof Electric Actuators -add -EX to model number Optional Electric Actuator Supply Voltages -Contact factory for model number change Solenoid Valve - Add suffix -SV
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
115
CALL TO ORDER:
Series BFV
Butterfly Valve
Low Cost, Lever Operated, Lug or Wafer Pattern, 225 psig
A A n = # of holes
B n = # of holes
LUG STYLE LT
WAFER STYLE WF
WAFER STYLE
DIMENSIONS (in)
Size 2 2-1/2 3 4 5 A 6.34 6.89 7.13 7.87 8.39 B 3.15 3.5 3.74 4.49 5 C 1-3/4 1-7/8 1-7/8 2-1/8 2-1/4 n, WF 4 4 4 4 8 n, LT 4 4 4 8 8 Cv 135 220 302 600 1022 Weight 5.5 7.05 7.93 10.8 15.43 Size 6 8 10 12 A 8.9 10.24 11.5 13.27 B 5.47 6.89 7.99 9.53 C 2-1/4 2-1/2 2-3/4 3-1/8 n, WF 8 8 12 12 n, LT 8 8 12 12 Cv 1579 3136 5340 8250 Weight 17.2 29.1 42.33 71.65
LUG STYLE
Series BFV Butterfly Valves Phenolic backed cartridge seat design for extended service and ease of replacement. Can be used for vacuum service. Extended neck for insulation no fabricated extensions required. Machined flats attach disc/stem no pins. Valve features a retainer lip for dead end service. Triple seal reduces possibility of external leakage. Silicone free from the factory no aftermarket cleaning required. The most critical aspect of the Series BFV Butterfly Valves is the cartridge seat design, which alleviates installation problems associated with common dove tail design seats. Valve torque is lower and more consistent because the seat dynamics do not rely on being mated between two flanges. Precision machining of the disc and body allow the cartridge design to maintain a tighter disc to seat tolerance, providing a perfect low torque seal each and every time the valve is cycled. Seat to disc seal is independent of flange support and capable of full rated dead end service. Select from wafer or lug patterns with either a 10-position locking handle lever or manual gear operator. Standard valves provide bubble tight sealing to 225 psi (15.5 bar) and are designed to comply with MSS-SP-67 and API-609. Cv VALUES DEGREE OPENING FULL OPEN 50 60 70 Size 10 20 30 40 80 90 12 24 45 2 0.1 5 125 64 90 135 20 37 65 2-1/2 0.2 8 204 98 144 220 22 39 70 3 0.3 12 275 116 183 302 36 78 139 230 364 4 0.5 17 546 600 61 133 237 392 620 5 0.8 29 930 1022 45 95 205 366 605 958 6 2 1437 1579 89 188 408 727 1202 1903 2854 3136 8 3 151 320 694 1237 2047 3240 4859 5340 10 4 234 495 1072 1911 3162 5005 7505 8250 12 5 Cv is the number of U.S. GPM of 60F water that will pass through the valve with a 1 PSI pressure drop.
SPECIFICATIONS VALVE BODY Service: Compatible liquids, gases, and steam. Line Size: 2 to 12. Body Style: 2-way, wafer or lug butterfly. End Connections: Flange, to be used with flanges that are ANSI Class 125 (B16.1) and ANSI Class 150 (B16.5) dimensions. Pressure Limit: 225 psi (15.5 bar) WOG. Wetted Materials:
Body Material: Ductile iron. Disc: 316 SS. Seat and O-ring: EPDM or PTFE. Stem: 410 SS. Temperature Limits: Disc: EPDM: -50 to 250F (-46 to 121C). PTFE: 0 to 300F (-18 to 149C). Bearings: Nylatron. Flow Rate: See Cv chart. Operator: 2 to 6: 10-position locking hand lever. 8 to 12: manual gear.
APPLICATIONS Perfect for on-off or throttling service Ideal for shut-off of water in chillers, cooling towers, and thermal storage systems Air dampers
OPERATING TORQUE VALUES (INCH LB) EPDM Seats Size (inches) Service Pressure 2 5 2-1/2 3 4 6 8 50 psi 86 126 179 295 540 750 1440 100 psi 108 144 195 310 610 780 1490 150 psi 126 150 210 335 699 847 1549 200 psi 150 198 297 400 725 940 1800 PTFE Seats Service Pressure 50 psi 100 psi 150 psi 200 psi 2 125 130 142 180 2-1/2 130 145 160 220 3 195 210 248 340
Size (inches) 5 4 6 8 390 650 890 1690 430 690 940 1710 443 720 974 1770 490 795 1020 1890
Liner EPDM PTFE 2 EPDM PTFE EPDM 2-1/2 PTFE EPDM PTFE EPDM PTFE 3 EPDM PTFE EPDM PTFE 4 EPDM PTFE EPDM 5 PTFE BFV202WFB311HL0 Size
Model BFV202WFB311HL0 BFV202WFB341HL0 BFV202LTB311HL0 BFV202LTB341HL0 BFV225WFB311HL0 BFV225WFB341HL0 BFV225LTB311HL0 BFV225LTB341HL0 BFV203WFB311HL0 BFV203WFB341HL0 BFV203LTB311HL0 BFV203LTB341HL0 BFV204WFB311HL0 BFV204WFB341HL0 BFV204LTB311HL0 BFV204LTB341HL0 BFV205WFB311HL0 BFV205WFB341HL0 WF=Wafer Pattern LT=Lug
Size Liner EPDM 5 PTFE EPDM PTFE 6 EPDM PTFE EPDM PTFE 8 EPDM PTFE EPDM PTFE 10 EPDM PTFE EPDM PTFE 12 EPDM PTFE Pattern
Model BFV205LTB311HL0 BFV205LTB341HL0 BFV206WFB311HL0 BFV206WFB341HL0 BFV206LTB311HL0 BFV206LTB341HL0 BFV208WFB312MG0 BFV208WFB342MG0 BFV208LTB312MG0 BFV208LTB342MG0 BFV210WFB312MG0 BFV210WFB342MG0 BFV210LTB312MG0 BFV210LTB342MG0 BFV212WFB312MG0 BFV212WFB342MG0 BFV212LTB312MG0 BFV212LTB342MG0
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
116
CALL TO ORDER:
Series ZV1
ZV1 Series Zone Valves are ideal for flow control in hot and cold water HVAC systems. Zone valves are typically used in conjunction with a thermostat to control room temperature. The ZV1 is electrically driven to open and spring to close. Units are available in 1/2, 3/4, and 1 sizes with 24 or 120 VAC power supply. Easy to install these units are direct replacements for competitor units. Manual override lever is easily accessible externally. Consult factory for 220 VAC power supply, optional auxiliary switches, and BSP or sweat connections. Model ZV1022 ZV1024 ZV1032 ZV1034 ZV1042 ZV1044 Cv 3.78 3.78 3.78 3.78 8.02 8.02 Size 1/2 1/2 3/4 3/4 1 1 Supply Voltage 120 VAC 24 VAC 120 VAC 24 VAC 120 VAC 24 VAC
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible fluids. Body: 2-way, normally closed. Line Size: 1/2 to 1. End Connections: Female NPT (optional BSP, sweat connections). Pressure Limits: Maximum: 300 psi (20.7 bar); Close-off: 1/2 to 3/4: 22 psi (1.5 bar), 1: 14.5 psi (1 bar). Temperature Limits: Ambient: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C); Process: 32 to 201F (0 to 94C). Wetted Materials: Brass, stainless steel, NBR.
Flow Characteristic: Quick opening. Power Requirements: 120 VAC or 24 VAC, 10%, 50/60 Hz. (Optional 220 VAC). Power Consumption: 6.5 W. Input: On/off. Electrical Connection: 22 AWG, 5 (127 mm) long. Cycle Time: Opening time: 11 seconds; Closing time: 5 seconds. Enclosure Rating: General purpose. Housing Material: Aluminum.
Series 3ZV1
3ZV1 Series Zone Valves are ideal for flow control in hot and cold water HVAC systems. The 3ZV1 is electrically driven to open and spring to close. Units are available in 1/2, 3/4, and 1 sizes with 24 or 120 VAC power supply. Easy to install these units are direct replacements for competitor units. Manual override lever is easily accessible externally. Consult factory for 220 VAC power supply, optional auxiliary switches, and BSP or sweat connections. Model 3ZV1022 3ZV1024 3ZV1032 3ZV1034 3ZV1042 3ZV1044 Cv 3.78 3.78 3.78 3.78 8.02 8.02 Size 1/2 1/2 3/4 3/4 1 1 Supply Voltage 120 VAC 24 VAC 120 VAC 24 VAC 120 VAC 24 VAC Close-off Pressure psi (bar) 22 (1.5) 22 (1.5) 14.5 (1.0) 14.5 (1.0) 10 (.70) 10 (.70)
SPECIFICATIONS Service: Compatible fluids. Body: 3-way. Line Size: 1/2 to 1. End Connections: Female NPT (optional BSP, sweat connections). Pressure Limits: Maximum: 300 psi (20.7 bar); Close-off: see model chart. Temperature Limits: Ambient: 32 to 104F (0 to 40C); Process: 32 to 201F (0 to 94C). Wetted Materials: Brass, stainless steel, NBR.
Flow Characteristic: Quick opening. Power Requirements: 120 VAC or 24 VAC, 10%, 50/60 Hz. (optional 220 VAC). Power Consumption: 6.5 W. Input: On/off. Electrical Connection: 22 AWG, 5 (127 mm) long. Cycle Time: Opening time: 11 seconds; Closing time: 5 seconds. Enclosure Rating: General purpose. Housing Material: Aluminum.
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
CALL TO ORDER:
117
3-25/64 (86.12)
21/32 (16.67)
63/64 (25.00)
9/64 (3.57)
DDA and DDC Series Direct Coupled Actuators are non-spring return actuators that are perfect for positioning of dampers and valves in HVAC systems. DDA actuators are designed to accept floating control signals and come in a variety of power supplies. DDC actuators are designed to accept 4 to 20 mA or 0 to 10 VDC modulating control signals and are 24 VAC powered. DDC units feature a 0 to 10 VDC feedback signal of damper position. Actuators produce 17 to 70 in-lb (2 to 8 Nm) of torque. Contact factory for optional internal auxiliary switch on DDA. FEATURES Direct mount. Actuator travel indicator. Overload protection. Manual override. Floating control signal on DDA. Modulating 4 to 20 mA or 0 to 10 VDC control signal on DDC. Position feedback signal on DDC. 60,000 cycles nominal.
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
Model Number DDA11 DDA13 DDA21 DDA23 DDA31 DDA33 DDA41 DDA43 DDC13 DDC23 DDC33 DDC43
Size/ Torque 17 in-lb 17 in-lb 35 in-lb 35 in-lb 53 in-lb 53 in-lb 70 in-lb 70 in-lb 17 in-lb 35 in-lb 53 in-lb 70 in-lb
[2 [2 [4 [4 [6 [6 [8 [8 [2 [4 [6 [8
Nm] Nm] Nm] Nm] Nm] Nm] Nm] Nm] Nm] Nm] Nm] Nm]
Supply Voltage 110 VAC 24 VAC 110 VAC 24 VAC 110 VAC 24 VAC 110 VAC 24 VAC 24 VAC 24 VAC 24 VAC 24 VAC
Input Floating Floating Floating Floating Floating Floating Floating Floating Modulating Modulating Modulating Modulating
SPECIFICATIONS Power Requirements: DDA: 110 VAC, 24 VAC, 10%, 50/60 Hz, single phase. Optional 230 VAC; DDC: 24 VAC, 10%, 50/60 Hz, single phase. Power Consumption: DDA: 110 VAC models: 5 VA, 230 VAC models: 5 VA, 24 VAC models: 3 VA; DDC: 4 VA. Control Input: DDA: Two-position, floating; DDC: 4-20 mA or 0-10 VDC. Overload Protection: Magnetic clutch. Angle of Rotation: 95 (mechanically adjustable). Fits Shaft Diameter: 0.4 (10 mm) or 0.5 (13 mm). Position Indication: Visual indicator. Direction of Rotation: CW/CCW. Running Time: 17 in-lb, 35 in-lb, 53 in-lb: 110 sec.; 70 in-lb:160 sec. Electrical Connection: Terminal block, 18 AWG. Manual Override: Push button. Temperature Limit: -22 to 122F (-30 to 50C). Sound: <45 dB. Life Expectancy: 60000 full cycles. Housing: NEMA 2 (IP40). Standard Accessories: (2) imitative baffles, (2) baffle setscrews, (1) actuator body setscrew, and (1) aluminum gasket. Weight: 1.72 lb (0.78 kg).
118
CALL TO ORDER:
D C E
Size 88 in-lb (10 Nm) & 132 in-lb (15 Nm) 177 in-lb (20 Nm) & 265 in-lb (30 Nm)
DDB and DDD Series Direct Coupled Actuators are non-spring return actuators that are perfect for positioning of dampers and valves in HVAC systems. DDB actuators are designed to accept floating control signals and come in a variety of power supplies. DDD Actuators are designed to accept 4 to 20 mA or 0 to 10 VDC modulating control signals and are 24 VAC powered. DDD units feature a 0 to 10 VDC feedback signal of damper position. Actuators produce 88 to 265 in-lb (10 to 30 Nm) of torque. Contact factory for optional internal auxiliary switches on DDB. FEATURES Direct mount. Actuator travel indicator. Overload protection. Manual override. Floating control signal on DDB. Modulating 4 to 20 mA or 0 to 10 VDC control signal on DDD. Position feedback signal on DDD. 60,000 cycles nominal.
Model Number DDB51 DDB53 DDB61 DDB63 DDB71 DDB73 DDB81 DDB83 DDD53 DDD63 DDD73 DDD83
Size/ Torque 88 in-lb [10 Nm] 88 in-lb [10 Nm] 132 in-lb [15 Nm] 132 in-lb [15 Nm] 177 in-lb [20 Nm] 177 in-lb [20 Nm] 265 in-lb [30 Nm] 265 in-lb [30 Nm] 88 in-lb [10 Nm] 132 in-lb [15 Nm] 177 in-lb [20 Nm] 265 in-lb [30 Nm]
Supply Voltage 110 VAC 24 VAC 110 VAC 24 VAC 110 VAC 24 VAC 110 VAC 24 VAC 24 VAC 24 VAC 24 VAC 24 VAC
Input Floating Floating Floating Floating Floating Floating Floating Floating Modulating Modulating Modulating Modulating
SPECIFICATIONS Power Requirements: DDB: 110 VAC, 24 VAC, 10%, 50/60 Hz, single phase. Optional 230 VAC. DDD: 24 VAC, 10%, 50/60 Hz, single phase. Power Consumption: DDB: 5.5 VA. DDD: 7.5 VA. Control Input: DDB: Two-position or floating. DDD: 4-20 mA or 0-10 VDC. Overload Protection: Magnetic clutch. Angle of Rotation: 95 (mechanically adjustable). Accuracy: DDD: 5%. Fits Shaft Diameter: 0.4 - 0.75 (10-20 mm). Position Indication: Visual indicator. Direction of Rotation: CW/CCW. Running Time: 88 in-lb: 66 sec., 132 in-lb: 90 sec., 177 in-lb: 110 sec.; 265 in-lb:143 sec. Electrical Connection: Terminal block, 18 AWG. Manual Override: Push button. Temperature Limit: -22 to 122F (-30 to 50C). Sound: <45 dB. Life Expectancy: 60000 full cycles. Housing: NEMA 2 (IP42). Standard Accessories: (2) imitative baffles, (2) baffle setscrews, (1) setting bracket. Weight: DDB: 2.87 lb (1.3 kg) 88, 132 in-lb models; 3.68 lb (1.67 kg) 177, 265 in-lb models; DDD: 2.98 lb (1.35 kg) 88, 132 in-lb models; 3.79 lb (1.72 kg) 177, 265 in-lb models. Agency Approvals: CE.
VALVES/ ACTUATORS
119
CALL TO ORDER:
Model A-464
The A-464 Mounting Kit provides a flush mounting solution for Magnehelic gage installations for applications such as clean rooms and mechanical equipment rooms. The A-464 can also be used as an alternative means to flush mount Magnehelic gages on control panel enclosures. The space pressure reference port eliminates the need to drill separate holes and run tubing long distances. Utilizing the A-464 for Magnehelic gage installations reduces installation time while also producing an aesthetically pleasing result.
Advantages and Specifications of the A-464 Kit Provides an innovative solution for flush mounting Magnehelic gages. Space pressure reference integral to mounting plate. Mounting applications include: Sheetrock walls, control panel enclosures and air handling equipment. Eliminates the need for special hole saws. Creates a professional look. Saves installation time and money. Outside dimensions: 6-1/2 x 6-1/2 x 1/4 inches (16.5 x 16.5 x 0.6 cm). Material: White ABS plastic.
Model A-464
Model A-465
3/4 [19.1]
1/4 [6.4]
2-3/4 [69.9]
The A-465 Space Pressure Sensor Kit provides a clean solution for sensing space pressure. Typical applications include: sensing the pressure in clean rooms, laboratories and building lobbies. The kink resistant tubing provided in the kit is connected to the tubing running to a pressure transducer, Magnehelic Gage, VAV unit or any other types of pressure sensing devices. The sensor can be mounted on sheetrock walls, single gang electrical boxes or on ceiling tiles. The block free pressure reference opening along with the kink resistant tubing ensure accurate readings at all times.
Advantages and Specifications of the A-465 Kit The professional way to sense space pressure. Mounting options include: Sheetrock walls, ceiling tiles or single gang electrical boxes. Non block reference opening prevents plugging. Saves time and money. Outside dimensions: 2-3/4 x 4-1/2 x 1/4 inches (6.9 x 11.4 x 0.6 cm). Attractive design blends in with building decor. Materials: White ABS plastic.
ACCESSORIES/ BOOKS
Model A-465
120
CALL TO ORDER:
A-417
A-418, Static Pressure Pickup. Room mount with Delta Style plastic enclosure fits 2 x 4 electrical box. Fine mesh screen hides static pressure pickup port. Clean connection to 1/8 to 5/32 I.D. tubing and pressure sensor. Sealed with foam gasket, screws included.
A-418
A-419
A-419, Static Pressure Pickup Ceiling Mount. Plate rests on top of standard 3/4 thick ceiling tile while 100 micron filter faces down through 5/8 hole in tile. Filter is barely noticeable in room being monitored. Screws included for optional mounting to junction box. Barbed brass fitting holds 1/8 to 5/32 I.D. tubing.
A-420
A-420, Static Pressure Pickup for Roof or Outside Wall Mount. Port especially reduces effects of wind gusts to keep pressure readings stable when plate is parallel to ground. NEMA 4X (IP66) rated structure withstands harsh environmental elements. Structure is 3-5/8 across and 2-1/2 deep. EMT Conduit fitting is 1/2. Pressure connection is brass barbed fitting for 1/4 tubing.
A-421
Surge Damper
A-421, Static Pressure Tip measures duct static air pressure. Assembly includes 6 probe, silicon rubber hose, and screws. Built-in surge damper ensures stable readings on pressure sensor. Pressure spike reducer can be added to end of tube to further smooth over pressure fluctuations. ACCESSORIES/ BOOKS
CALL TO ORDER:
121
A-301
A-302
A-303
A-306
A-304
A-305
A-307
A-308
A-345
A-414
Valves Connectors
Instrument valves for permanent installation. They mount in part A-316, A-317, type C manometer connections or Magnehelic gage and connect to metal tubing or 1/8 pipe. A-310A, 3-Way Vent Valve, plastic, 1/8 NPT to 1/4 metal tubing. Positions are: (1) Line: Gage connected to pressure source. (2) Off: Both gage and connection to pressure source closed. (3) Vent: Gage vented to atmosphere and connection to pressure source closed. 80 PSI rating. Replaces former model A310 (brass). A-310B, same as A-310A but with 10 psi rating. A-311, Shut Off Valve, brass, 1/8 NPT to 1/8 NPT. A-312, Shut Off Valve, brass, 1/8 NPT to 1/4 metal tubing. A-355, Porting Valve, acrylic plastic, 1/8 NPT inserts. Used for convenient indication of pressure at two points with a single gage. A-365, Dual Porting Valve, acrylic plastic, 1/8 NPT fittings. For monitoring three pressures, two at a time, with one gage. Gage Connectors for Manometers. Molded nylon construction, threaded .786 x 27 N.S., with O ring seal. A-315, Gage connector, Shut off type, for 3/16 rubber tubing. A-316, Gage connector, bushing, 1/8 pipe thread opening. A-317, Gage connector, 1/8 pipe thread opening, less O.D. thd., for slip fit in 3/4 dia. opening in 250 series A.F. gages. A-318, Gage connector 1/4 pipe thread opening. A-319, Flexible Red P.V.C. connector, 3/16 I.D. Rubber Tubing to 1/4 I.D. Plastic Tube for 1221,1222 and 1227 Manometers. A-321, Brass Safety Relief Valve Protects Magnehelic or Photohelic Gage against over pressure due to regulator failure etc. Opens at 10 psi. Mounts in tee fitting in sensing line or in unused gage port with addition of A-349 reducer. 1/4 male NPT (Use two for D.P. application). A-322, Gage connector for 1/4 tubing. Slip fits in 3/4 opening in 250 series A.F. gages (Compression nut and ferrule not included).
A-310A A-310B
A-311
A-312
A-355
A-365
A-315
A-316
A-317
A-318
ACCESSORIES/ BOOKS
A-319
A-321
A-322
122
CALL TO ORDER:
Fittings Filters
A-170, Stainless Steel Pigtail Siphon. A-323, Elbow Compression Fitting, brass 1/8 NPT to 1/4 metal tubing. A-324, Compression Fitting, brass 1/8 NPT to 1/4 metal tubing. A-326, Compression Fitting, brass 1/8 NPT to 3/8 tubing. A-327, 5/16 Nylon Tube Union. A-328, 1/4 Nylon Tube Union. A-329, 1/8 NPT Close Coupled Street Ell, Brass. A-330, 1/8 Pipe Plug, socket hex, plated steel. A-331, 1/8 NPT Filter Vent Plug, nylon and sintered metal. A-332, Bushing, brass, 1/8 to 1/4 NPT. A-333, Bushing, brass, 1/8 to 1/2 NPT. A-334, Close Nipple, brass, 1/8 NPT. A-336, 90 Street L, brass, 1/8 NPT. A-337, Coupling, brass, 1/8 NPT. A-338, Servel Adapter, brass 3/8 and 5/16 N.F. Threads for gas appliances to 1/8 and 3/16 I.D. rubber or plastic tubing. A-339, Adapter, brass, 1/8 NPT to 3/16 rubber and 1/8 I.D. plastic tubing. A-340, Adapter, nylon, 1/8 NPT to 3/16 I.D. rubber or 1/4 plastic tubing. A-342, T Assembly, plastic, for 3/16 I.D. rubber or 1/4 plastic tubing. A-343, T Assembly, plastic, for 3/16 plastic tubing. A-343-1, T Assembly, plastic, for 1/8 I.D. plastic tubing. A-344, Terminal Tube, Brass 1/4 diameter tube, 8" length (not shown). A-345, Flange, aluminum with gasket and sheet metal screws, 1/8 NPT. A-346, T Compression Fitting, brass, 1/4 metal tubing. A-349, Reducer, brass, 1/4 female NPT to 1/8 male NPT. A-385, 1/2 Plastic Hole Plugs 20/bag. A-386, 5/16 Metal Hole Plugs 20/bag. A-391, Line Filter for Capsuhelic gage,1/4 female NPT X 1/4 male NPT. A-392, Line Filter for Magnehelic gage, 1/8 female NPT x 1/8 male NPT. A-398, Probe Extension Adapter for series 640 air velocity transmitter. Brass, 1/2 female NPT x 5/16 compression. F222, Liquid/Particle Filter for compressed air. Removes dirt, water and oil. 22 scfm maximum flow, 1/4 female NPT inlet and outlet. 1201-2, Replacement Filter Element for F222 filter, package of 3. F451, Liquid/Particle Filter for compressed air. Removes dirt, water and oil. 45 scfm maximum flow, 1/4 female NPT inlet and outlet. 1201-3, Replacement Filter Element for F451 filter, package of 3.
A-324
A-326
A-327, A-328
A-329
A-330
A-331
A-332
A-333
A-334
A-336
A-337
A-338
A-339
A-340
A-342
A-345
A-346
A-349
A-391
A-392
A-398
F222
F451
Miscellaneous
A-298, Flat Aluminum Bracket for flush mounting Capsuhelic gage , 603A, 605, and 3000MR. A-299, Mounting Bracket, flush mount Magnehelic gage in bracket. Bracket is then surface mounted. Steel with gray hammertone epoxy finish. A-300, Flat Aluminum Bracket for flush mounting Magnehelic gage. A-351, Pinch Clamp to seal rubber tubing, as in a leakage test. A-352, Magneclip, slip on magnetic holder for acrylic plastic gages. Per pair. A-353, Magnetic Mounting. Flat style, secures to flowmeter, etc. with 6-32 machine screw and boots insert. A-354, Magnetic Mounting, Edge style, secures edge of acrylic mano-meter with 1032 machine screw and boots insert. A-356, Gage plug with retainer loop, polyethylene plastic. For 1/4 I.D. tubing. Slip loop over tubing O.D. and insert plug for seal. A-357, Thermometer and terminal tube holder. Stainless steel wire. A-362, Stand-Hang bracket, aluminum, for Minihelic II gage. A-363, Scale Clamp Bar for 1221 Manometer. A-364, Magnet Assembly for 1222 Manometers, 2 required (3 required for 1222-36 and M-1000). A-366, Manometer Cleaning Brush 1/4 O.D. x 2-1/8 Long. Attach to wire for use. A-368, Surface mounting plate, aluminum, for Magnehelic gage. A-369, Stand-Hang Bracket, aluminum, for Magnehelic gage. A-370, Mounting Bracket, Flush mount Capsuhelic gage or Series 600 Transmitter in bracket. Bracket is then surface mounted. Steel with gray hammertone epoxy finish. A-371, Surface Mounting Bracket. Use with Photohelic gage on horizontal or vertical surfaces. Also for Capsu-Photohelic gages on Vertical only. A-395, Surface Mounting Bracket for Series 602/603 transmitters and Series 4000 Capsuhelic gages. Steel with gray hammertone epoxy finish. A-397, Step Drill. Rugged Step Drill quickly provides true round holes in thin materials. Ideal for installation of Dwyer Pitot Tubes in sheet metal duct. No centerpunch needed to steel. Drills 3/16 through 1/2 holes in 1/16 increments. (Net Price, No Discount Allowed). A-464, Flush Mount Kit for Magnehelics gages. A-465, Flush Mount Space Pressure Sensor. A-497, Surface Mounting Bracket for MinihelicII gage. Steel with satin black finish.
A-351
A-352
A-353
A-354
A-356
A-357
A-363
A-364
A-362
A-368
A-369
A-370
ACCESSORIES/ BOOKS
A-371
A-395
A-497
A-300
CALL TO ORDER:
123
Pumps
A-350, Aspirator Bulb. Used as pressure source in calibration and leakage tests, to draw gas sample into CO2 Indicator or smoke gage A-394, Electric Air Pump. Provides convenient source of purge air in bubbler type liquid level systems. Dual diaphragm design allows operation of two systems simultaneously A-396A, Calibration pump. Serves as pressure source to calibrate gages and transmitters or to set pressure switches. Use with manometer or other pressure standard. Includes volume adjuster enabling fine pressure control and bleed valve. Generates pressures from a fraction of an inch w.c. to 72 psig (5 bar). Includes barbed fitting, tee connector and three 36" lengths of vinyl tubing
A-350
A-394
A-396A
SPECIFICATIONS AC Input: 100/120/220/230-240 VAC 10%, 47-63 Hz. DC Output: 24-28 VDC regulated. Maximum Current Output: 500 mA (derated to 450 mA @ 50 Hz. operation) Operating Temperature: 32 to 122F (0 to 50C). External Fuse Required: 0.5 Amp for 100-120 VAC, 0.25 Amp for 220-240 VAC. Weight: 2 lb.
A-527
ACCESSORIES/ BOOKS
A-532
A-534
A-533, Metric English Pressure and Flow Conversion Slide Chart A-534, International L.H.V. Combustion Efficiency Slide Chart A-536, Metric Air Velocity Calculator Slide Chart
124
CALL TO ORDER:
Series A-2000
A-2018
A-2019
A-2020
A-2021
A-2022
A-2023
A-2024
Model No. A-2024-1 A-2024-2 A-2024-3 A-2024-4 A-2024-5 A-2024-6 A-2024-7 A-2024-8 A-2024-9 A-2024-10 A-2024-11 A-2024-12 A-2024-13 A-2024-14 A-2024-15 A-2024-16 A-2024-17
Male NPT x Female NPT 1/4 x 1/8 3/8 x 1/4 1/2 x 1/4 1/2 x 3/8 3/4 x 1/4 3/4 x 1/2 1 x 1/2 1 x 3/4 1-1/4 x 3/4 1-1/4 x 1 1-1/2 x 3/4 1-1/2 x 1 1-1/2 x 1-1/4 2 x 1 2 x 1-1/4 2 x 1-1/2 3 x 2
ACCESSORIES/ BOOKS
CALL TO ORDER:
125
Series A-2000
A-2026 A-2025
1/8 x 1/8 1/4 x 1/4 3/8 x 3/8 1/2 x 1/2 3/4 x 3/4 1 x 1 1-1/4 x 1-1/4 1-1/2 x 1-1/2 2 x 2 3 x 3
A-2027
A-2028
1/8 x 3/4 1/8 x 1-1/2 1/8 x 2 1/4 x 7/8 1/4 x 1-1/2 1/4 x 2 3/8 x 1 3/8 x 1-1/2 3/8 x 2 1/2 x 1-1/8 1/2 x 1-1/2 1/2 x 2 3/4 x 1-3/8 3/4 x 1-1/2
Model No. A-2028-15 A-2028-16 A-2028-17 A-2028-18 A-2028-19 A-2028-20 A-2028-21 A-2028-22 A-2028-23 A-2028-24 A-2028-25 A-2028-26 A-2028-27
3/4 x 2 1 x 1-1/2 1 x 2 1-1/4 x 1-5/8 1-1/4 x 2 1-1/2 x 1-3/4 1-1/2 x 2 2 x 2 2 x 2-1/2 3 x 2-5/8 3 x 3 4 x 2-7/8 4 x 4
ACCESSORIES/ BOOKS
126
CALL TO ORDER:
HVAC Fundamentals Volume 2: Heating System Components, Gas and Oil Burners, and Automatic Controls
Fourth Edition By James E. Brumbaugh, 2004
Install and repair thermostats, humidistats, automatic controls, and oil or gas burner controls Review pipes, pipe fittings, piping details, valve installation, and duct systems Learn the best ways to handle hydronics and steam line controls Deal with solid fuels and understand coal firing methods This guidebook covers everything you need to know to install, maintain, and repair the components that run, regulate, and fuel both old and new systems. Order Number: BK-0006 ISBN: 0764542079, Pages: 655, Paperback
HVAC Fundamentals Volume 3: Air Conditioning, Heat Pumps, and Distribution Systems
Fourth Edition By James E. Brumbaugh, 2004
Learn to install and service todays popular electronic air cleaners and filters Service less common heating systems such as coal-fired furnaces Install, maintain, and repair humidifiers and dehumidifiers Handle radiators, convectors, and baseboard heating units This book provides a comprehensive, hands-on guide to installing, servicing, and repairing all basic air-conditioning systems. It also includes complete coverage of specialized heating units such as radiant heating systems, fans, exhaust systems, air filters, and more. Order Number: BK-0007 ISBN: 0764542087, Pages: 676, Paperback
ACCESSORIES/ BOOKS
CALL TO ORDER:
127
ACCESSORIES/ BOOKS
128
CALL TO ORDER:
CONVERSION FACTORS
NOTE: CONVERSION FACTORS ROUNDED
x x x x x
= = = = =
x x x x
DWYER INSTRUMENTS, INC. P.O. Box 373 Michigan City, IN 46361-9986 Return Service Requested
BUILDING Automation
Pressure Flow Temperature Air Velocity Humidity/Air Quality Level/Water Detection Output Transducers Test Equipment Power Monitoring Data Loggers/Indicators Valves/Actuators Accessories/Books
www.dwyer-inst.com